Italian Grammar Teach Yourself Italian - PDFCOFFEE.COM (2024)

TEACH

YOURSELF

From: http://www.geocities.com/f_pollett/iind.htm

ITALIAN

GRAMMAR AND

EXERCISES

~1~ ALPHABET AND PRONOUNCIATION 1.1 - THE ALPHABET AND THE BASIC SOUNDS 1.2 - SPECIAL CLUSTERS 1.3 - ENGLISH SPELLING OF ITALIAN SOUNDS 1.4 - DOUBLE CONSONANTS 1.5 - ACCENT (STRESS) ~2~ GENDER AND NUMBER OF NOUNS, ADJECTIVES, ARTICLES 2.1 - GENDER AND NUMBER: STANDARD INFLECTIONS 2.2 - GENDER AND NUMBER: STANDARD INFLECTIONS (PARTICULAR CASES) (see 2.2)

2.3 - GENDER AND NUMBER: NON-STANDARD INFLECTIONS 2.4 - ARTICLES 2.5 - THE POSITION OF ADJECTIVES ~3~ NUMBERS 3.1 - CARDINAL AND DECIMAL NUMBERS

(see 3.1)

3.2 - ORDINAL NUMBERS revised 3.3 - FRACTIONS AND ROUGH QUANTITIES enlarged exercises ~4~ PERSONAL PRONOUNS AND VERBS - part I

4.1 - PERSONAL PRONOUNS USED AS SUBJECTS - part I 4.2 - INDICATIVE TENSES OF ITALIAN VERBS 4.3 - THE VERB ESSERE (TO BE) - SIMPLE INDICATIVE TENSES 4.4 - THE VERB AVERE (TO HAVE) - SIMPLE INDICATIVE TENSES 4.5 - 1st CONJUGATION - SIMPLE INDICATIVE TENSES 4.6 - 2nd CONJUGATION - SIMPLE INDICATIVE TENSES 4.7 - 3rd CONJUGATION - SIMPLE INDICATIVE TENSES ~5~ OTHER BASIC ELEMENTS OF THE SENTENCE 5.1 - SIMPLE PREPOSITIONS 5.2 - COMPOUND PREPOSITIONS 5.3 - POSSESSIVE PRONOUNS AND ADJECTIVES 5.4 - INTERROGATIVE AND NEGATIVE FORMS 5.5 - DEMONSTRATIVE PRONOUNS AND ADJECTIVES enlarged ~6~ VERBS - part II - COMPOUND INDICATIVE TENSES 6.1 - THE VERB ESSERE - COMPOUND INDICATIVE TENSES 6.2 - THE VERB AVERE - COMPOUND INDICATIVE TENSES 6.3 - PAST PARTICIPLES 6.4 - 1st CONJUGATION - COMPOUND INDICATIVE TENSES 6.5 - 2nd CONJUGATION - COMPOUND INDICATIVE TENSES 6.6 - 3rd CONJUGATION - COMPOUND INDICATIVE TENSES revised ~7~ TIME AND DATES 7.1 - DAYS OF THE WEEK 7.2 - MONTHS AND SEASONS OF THE YEAR 7.3 - YEARS AND CENTURIES

7.4 - DATES 7.5 - WHAT TIME IS IT ? 7.6 - TIME ADVERBS AND DURATION FORMS ~8~ PERSONAL PRONOUNS - part II 8.1 - PERSONAL PRONOUNS AS DIRECT OBJECT 8.2 - PERSONAL PRONOUNS IN DATIVE CASE enlarged exercises 8.3 - PERSONAL PRONOUNS IN REFLEXIVE FORM enlarged exercises ~9~ VERBS - part III - SUBJUNCTIVE TENSES 9.1 - BASIC CONCEPTS AND PRESENT TENSE revised · enlarged 9.2 - PAST TENSE 9.3 - PRESENT AND PAST TENSES OF VERBS ESSERE AND AVERE 9.4 - PERFECT AND PLUPERFECT revised 9.5 - PERFECT AND PLUPERFECT OF VERBS ESSERE AND AVERE ~ 10 ~ DIMINUTIVE, AUGMENTATIVE, PEJORATIVE 10.1 - DIMINUTIVE 10.2 - AUGMENTATIVE 10.3 - PEJORATIVE ~ 11 ~ NOUNS, ADJECTIVES AND PREPOSITIONS USED WITH GEOGRAPHIC SITES 11.1 - ADJECTIVES RELATED TO GEOGRAPHIC SITES 11.2 - MORE ABOUT GEOGRAPHIC NAMES 11.3 - ARTICLES AND PREPOSITIONS WITH GEOGRAPHIC NAMES ~ 12 ~ COMPARATIVE AND SUPERLATIVE

12.1 - COMPARATIVE - part I 12.2 - COMPARATIVE - part II 12.3 - RELATIVE SUPERLATIVE enlarged 12.4 - ABSOLUTE SUPERLATIVE ~ 13 ~ VERBS - part IV - CONDITIONAL TENSES 13.1 - BASIC CONCEPTS - VERBS ESSERE AND AVERE 13.2 - REGULAR VERBS OF THE THREE CONJUGATIONS 13.3 - THE USE OF CONDITIONAL TENSES ~ 14 ~ VERBS - part V - IMPERATIVE TENSE 14.1 - IMPERATIVE INFLECTIONS 14.2 - IMPERATIVE WITH PRONOUNS - NEGATIVE - GENERAL USE ~ 15 ~ FORMAL LEVEL OF SPEECH 15.1 - THE BASICS 15.2 - PRONOUNS AND ADJECTIVES ~ 16 ~ OTHER PRONOUNS 16.1 - INTERROGATIVE AND EXCLAMATIVE PRONOUNS 16.2 - RELATIVE PRONOUNS - part I 16.3 - RELATIVE PRONOUNS - part II - COMBINING PREPOSITIONS 16.4 - RELATIVE PRONOUNS - part III - THE USE OF CHI 16.5 - RELATIVE PRONOUNS - part IV - THE USE OF CIÒ CHE ~ 17 ~ CAPITAL LETTERS, COLOURS, SYLLABLES 17.1 - THE USE OF CAPITAL (UPPERCASE) LETTERS 17.2 - COLOURS USED AS NOUNS AND AS ADJECTIVES

17.3 - DIVIDING WORDS INTO SYLLABLES ~ 18 ~ VERBS - part VI - THE GERUND AND THE PARTICIPLES - IRREGULAR VERBS 18.1 - THE GERUND TENSE, AND THE VERB STARE 18.2 - PRESENT AND PAST PARTICIPLES 18.3 - VERBS WHOSE INFINITIVE IS CONTRACTED 18.4 - OTHER IMPORTANT IRREGULAR VERBS ~ 19 ~ VERBS - part VII - PASSIVE TENSES, AND OTHER USEFUL EXPRESSIONS 19.1 - PASSIVE 19.2 - TO BE HUNGRY, THIRSTY, HOT, COLD, SLEEPY 19.3 - THE POSTPONED SUBJECT 19.4 - DOUBLE NEGATIVE revised 19.5 - THE USE OF ALCUNO ~ 20 ~ PARTITIVE AND THE USE OF THE PRONOUN NE

20.1 - PARTITIVE 20.2 - MORE WAYS OF USING THE PRONOUN NE 20.3 - THE VERB ANDARSENE

1.1 THE ALPHABET AND THE BASIC SOUNDS The modern Italian alphabet has less letters than the English one: J, K, W, X and Y do not occur in native terms. Nevertheless, these letters do appear in dictionaries, for archaic spellings, and for a few foreign and international terms officially adopted in Italian, as well. The following table includes these letters too, though showing them in deep green, to stress their less common use. Each entry shows the pronounciation of the letter in Italian, trying to make the closest match with English sounds. An important thing to remember is that all the Italian vowels are clipped, i.e. their duration, or sound length, is very short, compared to the average English vowels. For a better comprehension, each vowel has one or more icons like this one .WAV format.

, with links to audio files in

The last column on the right shows the "name" of each letter, i.e. what they are called in Italian.

BASIC SOUND TABLE LETTER A

PRONOUNCIATION

NAME

Always as an English a in cat, fact, or as an o in how, cloud, mouse. (audio sample A

)

a

B

Always as an English b.

bi

C

As an English k, except when the following vowel is e or i: in this case it sounds as the English cluster ch in chest, chip, chisel. The letter c also forms some special clusters, discussed in the following page.

ci

D

Always as an English d.

di

E

Depending on the word, it may have two slightly different sounds: either as an English a in hay, layer, may (this is popularly called a narrow "e" or closed "e"), or as an English e in send, tent, hen (this one is popularly called a wide "e" or open "e"). To mark this difference, two different accents are placed above the vowel: an acute accent, slanted rightwards (é), gives the "closed" sound , while the grave accent, slanted leftwards (è), gives the "open" sound. Unlike in French, in Italian accented vowels such as é and è are used very sparingly: most words are spelled with an ordinary e. Obviously, for the spoken language, the correct sound must be remembered. But the student should not worry about this too much: in most cases, a word pronounced with an incorrect sound (for example a wide "e" in place of a narrow "e") would be understood all the same. (audio sample É, acute

) · · · (audio sample È, grave

)

e (narrow sound)

F

Always as an English f in fame, knife, flute, but never like of.

G

As an English g in gravel, goblet, except in three cases: • when followed by vowels e and i, it sounds as English j in jelly, jigsaw; • when followed by n, forming cluster gn (discussed in the following page); • when followed by l, forming cluster gl (discussed in the following page).

gi

H

It is completely soundless: never as in house, hope, hammer, but as in heir, honest. Its use will be explained further on. It also takes part to special clusters, discussed in the following page. But h

acca

I

It always sounds as an English y in yellow, troyan. A similar sound is that of English ee in fleet, seem, but the length of the Italian sound is shorter. (audio sample I

effe

i

)

J

A few names have a letter j, always pronounced as an English y in yell, lawyer; for further details about this letter, scroll down the page to the NOTES or follow this LINK.

i lunga

K

In foreign or international words, it always sounds as an English k.

kappa

L

Always as English l.

M

Always as an English m.

emme

N

Always as an English n.

enne

O

elle

Always as an English o, in some cases with a "narrow" or "closed" sound as in blow, soul, row, or sometimes with a "wide" or "open" sound as in cloth, spot, dog. These sounds are spelled with the acute accent (ó) for the closed sound, and with the grave accent (ò) for the open sound. However, the use of ó and ò is very limited, and the correct sound must be known. Also in this case, a word pronounced with the wrong accent is usually understood all the same. (audio sample Ó

) · · · (audio sample Ò

o (wide sound)

)

P

Always as an English p.

pi

Q

Always as an English q, it is always followed by vowel u.

qu

R

This sound is always "rolled", like a Scottish r in Edinburgh, or a Spanish r in señor. It is obtained by making the tip of the tongue vibrate almost against the hard palate, next to the back of the upper teeth. It never sounds as an English r, nor as a French r.

erre

S

As an English s, sometimes strong as in strip, fuss, spare, and sometimes weak as in easy, abuse, lies. The letter s also belongs to some special clusters, discussed in the following page.

T

Always as English t

ti

U

The sound is similar to an English w in win, rowing, but u is a vowel, while w is a consonant.

u

(audio sample U

esse (strong sound)

)

V

Always as an English v.

vu or vi

W

In foreign or international words, it may either sound as a German w in würstel, watt (i.e. like an Italian v), or as an English w in window (i.e. as the Italian vowel u). When Italians are in doubt, they usually pronounce the letter w in the German way, as suggested by the name given to this letter, which means double v.

doppia vu

X

In foreign or international words, it always sounds as an English x.

Y

In foreign or international words, it always sounds as an English y, i.e. exactly as the Italian vowel i. A further note about this letter is at the bottom of the page: either scroll down, or follow this LINK.

Z

According to the word, it sounds either as an English ds in godzilla, or as ts in cats.

ics

i greca or ipsilon zeta (with the ds sound)

NOTES • letter J - in some Italian words, such as gioiello (= jewel), maiale (= pig), and a few others, the vowel i is followed by a further vowel that belongs to the same syllable. This i will therefore have a rather "swift" sound, i.e. a short duration, more or less as the letter y would be pronounced in English in yellow, coyote, yolk: no more than 100 years ago, this i would have been often spelled j (i.e. giojello, majale), to show this particular sound due to the following vowel. The Italian name for j means long i. Nowadays, this spelling has become totally obsolete, and j only occurs in a few first names and surnames. However, it is always pronounced as an Italian i. • letter Y - it is a reminiscence of the Greek alphabet, as suggested by the name Greek i given to this consonant. But while this letter in Greek sounds like German ü, in Italian it sounds exactly like vowel i, and since it was redundant, it was gradually dropped.

1.2 SPECIAL CLUSTERS The pronounciation of some consonants changes when they come together and form one syllable (monosyllabic clusters).

CLUSTER

PRONOUNCIATION

While ca, co and cu are pronounced as in English, ce and ci have a soft sound (palatal pronounciation), like in English che and chi. CE, CI CIA, CIE, CIO, CIU

CHE, CHI

When the cluster ci is followed by a further vowel, the i loses its sound, and becomes merely graphic (only to show that c has to be pronounced as English "ch"). Therefore, cia sounds like cha (not chya), cie is pronounced che, cio as cho, and ciu as chu. CE

CI

CIA

CIE

CIO

CIU

The letter h between c and e, or between c and i, gives the cluster a hard sound (guttural pronounciation): che sounds like an English ke, while chi sounds like an English ki. CHE

CHI

The clusters ga, go and gu are pronounced like in English, but ge and gi have a "soft" sound (palatal pronounciation), like English je and jy (or jih). GE, GI GIA, GIE, GIO, GIU

GHE, GHI

Also in this case, when cluster gi is followed by a further vowel, i becomes mute, and the English "j" sound is followed by the second vowel, thus gia sounds like ja (not jya), gie is pronounced je, gio as jo, and giu as ju. GE

GI

GIA

GIE

GLIA, GLIE, GLIO, GLIU

GIU

An h inserted between g and vowel e or i gives the cluster a hard sound (guttural pronounciation): ghe sounds like an English gue in guest , while ghi sounds like an English gui in guild. GHE

GLI

GIO

GHI

When gl is followed by vowel i, it has the same sound as ll in Spanish words like caballo, lluvia, etc. This exact sound does not exist in English, although a rather similar one is obtained pronouncing the sentence "I will call

you", in which a double l is followed by y + another vowel. The Italian sound is obtained by pressing the point of the tongue against the back of the teeth and flattening it against the hard palate. When gli is followed by vowels a, e, o and u, the sound of i is lost; glia sounds like Spanish lla (close enough to English llya, but y should not be heard much), glie as Spanish lle, glio as Spanish llo, and gliu as Spanish llu. Instead, when gl (without an i) is followed by vowels a, e, o and u, it is simply pronounced as in English, in words like glass, glove, glue. GLI GLIA

GLIE

GLIU

GLIO

It is pronounced exactly as a Spanish ñ, in señor, mañana. The gn cluster is always followed by a vowel. GNA

GN

GNE

GNI

GNO

GNU

The cluster sc only has a special sound when followed by vowels e and i, in which case it sounds like an English sh in sharp, shelf, shop. In any other case (sca, sco, scu) the pronounciation is like the English one in scar scorpion, scuba.

SCE, SCI

When the cluster sci is followed by a vowel (scia, scie, scio, sciu), the sound of i is lost; thus scia sounds like English sha, scie is pronounced she, scio as sho, and sciu as shu.

SCIA, SCIE, SCIO, SCIU

SCE

SCI

SCIA

SCIE

SCIO

SCIU

The aforesaid concepts are summarized in the following table, which shows the Italian clusters (bold letters) and their English sound (in italics); the few marked [*] refer to Spanish pronounciation.

ca · ca cia · cha

MONOSYLLABIC CLUSTERS SUMMARY TABLE co · co cu · cu ce · che ci · chi che · ke chi · ki cio · cho ciu · chu -

ga · ga gia · ja

go · go gio · jo

gu · gu giu · ju

ge · je ghe · gue -

gi · ji ghi · gui -

gla · gla glia · lla [*]

glo · glo glio · llo [*]

glu · glu gliu · llu [*]

gle · gle glie · lle [*]

gli · lli [*] -

gna · ña [*]

gno · ño [*]

sca · sca

sco · sco

gnu · ñu [*]

gne · ñe [*]

scu · scu sce · she [*] = Spanish sounds

gni · ñi [*] sci · shi

There are some words ending with ...cia, ...cie, ...gia, ...gie, whose sound does not follow above-mentioned rules. This is not due to an irregular pronounciation, but simply to the fact that the letters that form the cluster belong to separate syllables. Focus these examples: • grigia, meaning grey (feminine form), consists of the following syllables: gri - gia, and is pronounced as English "gryh-jah" (soundless "h" !). The gia cluster makes one syllable, thus its sound follows the general rule previously discussed; (AUDIO SAMPLE) • bugia, meaning a lie, consists of the following syllables: bu - gi - a, and sounds like English "bw-jyh-ah" (soundless "h" !), because the cluster gia is split into two syllables: gi and a, pronounced separately. (AUDIO SAMPLE) For the time being, the student can simply ignore this apparently complicated situation, and keep following the general rules: any unusual pronounciation will be clearly indicated.

1.3 ENGLISH SPELLING OF ITALIAN SOUNDS The pronounciation of the Italian consonants should not be difficult for English-speakers, but most vowels have a different sound. There are two important points to keep well in mind at all times: • In Italian, the pronounciation of the vowels does not change according to the word (only e and o have "wide" and "narrow" sounds, yet not very different), whereas for instance an English "e" is pronounced in different ways (leave, hen, break). As a general rule, the sound of Italian vowels is not affected by other letters. There is only one exception, already discussed in the previous paragraph 1.2: when i belongs to particular clusters, its sound is not heard. • The Italian vowels are always pronounced clipped, i.e. with a very short duration (sound length), whereas in English they are often held, so to obtain a "long" sound, particularly when they occur at the end of a word. For example, the English undergo is pronounced as if the word was spelled undergoe, although the word ends with o alone. In Italian, this sound would be shorter, as if the word was spelled undergoh, (without pronouncing the h), and the great majority of Italian words ends in a similar way, i.e. with a vowel. Vowels are the greatest obstacle in attempting to mimic the Italian sound by using syllables pronounced in the English way; there is no other way to obtain clipped vowels than to add an "h" after each of them (ah, eh, oh, etc.) This phonetic spelling looks a little awkward, for instance libreria (for bookshop) looks like "lyhbrehryhah"; but this will no longer be necessary once the student has fully learned the basic pronounciation rules. Practice hard your vowels, so to get rid of these funny spellings very soon! In these first chapters, a phonetic spelling (i.e. the English spelling of the word's sound), between quotation marks and in italics style, has been added to each Italian word, as a further help for the beginner; at more advanced stages, it will be abandoned, assuming that the student has gradually become confident with the pronounciation rules. The introduction paragraph (see GUIDELINES FOR THE USE OF THESE PAGES) shows a few examples, and explains why I preferred to use this method rather than the international phonetic system. Further notes about the phonetic spelling are the following ones: •

The sound of the Italian vowel a is obtained by spelling it "..ah..", always sounding as in bath, but obviously clipped, i.e. much shorter than in English.

• • • • •

• • • •

The Italian e is spelled "..eh..": it may sound as letter e in bet, or as letter a in may not pronouncing the y. The Italian i is obtained by "..yh.." or "..y..", always sounding as the letter y in gym; The Italian o is spelled "..oh..", sometimes sounding as letter o in box, and sometimes as in coal, though with a shorter sound than in English. The Italian u is spelled "..w..", always sounding as letter w in want. The Italian c is spelled "..k.." when its sound is "strong" (guttural), as in card, come. The "soft" (palatal) sound, like the English cluster ch in church or cheese, is spelled "..ch.." (remember not to omit the sound of h in this case!). In a similar way, the Italian g is spelled "..g..", when its sound is "strong" (guttural), as in goal, guide; its "soft" (palatal) sound, like an English j, is spelled "..j..", sounding like jam or jungle. The Italian cluster sc, when the sound matches the English cluster sh in shade or fish, is spelled "..sh.." (again, do not omit the sound of h in this case!). The Italian gn sound is spelled using a Spanish "..ñ..", as señor. For the Italian cluster gl another Spanish group has been used, "..ll.." (always with a reminder note). In the GRAMMAR AND EXERCISES section of this website, this phonetic spelling has been preferred, because it is the closest to the Italian pronounciation. Instead, in the USEFUL EXPRESSIONS sections I preferred to use its quasi-equivalent English ...lly... spelling, because the readers whose only purpose is that to use the sentences on a holiday, would find this spelling easier to understand, without having to learn the language in depth. The sound of the Italian r is always "rolled": there is no graphic way for showing this, so simply keep in mind the pronounciation of this letter. ACCENT (or STRESS)

Accent will be the subject of the next paragraph, but I would like to introduce in advance that in the English sound version, the stressed syllables are shown in bold: these syllables carry the stress in pronouncing the relevant word. For example: animale (animal) is pronounced "ahnyhmahleh" (stress on the syllable ma) tavolo (table) is pronounced "tahvohloh" (stress on the first syllable ta) perché (why, because) is pronounced "pehrkeh" (stress on the last syllable che) So now, according to the pronounciation table and to the above-mentioned notes, you should be able to pronounce correctly any Italian sound. Take a test with the following words: ITALIAN

AUDIO SAMPLE

ENGLISH SOUND

MEANING

bianco

"byahnkoh"

white

strada

"strahdah"

road

mare

"mahreh"

sea

grazie

"grahtsyeh"

thanks

luogo

"lwohgoh"

place, location

amico

"ahmykoh"

friend

facile

"fahchyleh" (English "ch")

easy

centro

"chentroh" (English "ch")

center

alzare

"ahltsahreh"

to lift

Parigi

"Pahryjyh"

Paris

1.4 DOUBLE CONSONANTS Many Italian words have double consonants. They can be found in any part of the word, but never as first letters or as last letters. In most cases they are followed by a vowel, as in dubbio = doubt, gatto = cat, etc.; but in some cases they may be followed by r, as in labbra = lips, attrito = friction, etc. Instead, another consonant never occurs before a double consonant. Also English has several words with double consonants, as supple, bottle, abbot. In Italian, though, double consonants sound stronger than in English; this is obtainable by breaking the sound, for example as if the word cattle was spelled ca-ttle: the tt sound should therefore be heard more. Any consonant can be doubled, except letter h (never doubled, because it is always soundless), or for nonstandard ones (j, k, w, x, y). Here you can listen to the actual sound of double consonants: dubbio (doubt)

affare (bargain, business)

gatto (cat)

passato (past)

labbra (lips)

collare (collar)

attrito (friction)

anno (year)

Some clusters too may be doubled: ...cci like English "...tchyh", as in stracci (rags) ...cce like English "...tcheh", as in accesso (access)

Compounds of ...cci + vowel obviously follow the same pronounciation, dropping the i sound: ...ccia (sounds like "...tchah"), as in faccia (face) ...ccio (sounds like "...tchoh"), as in riccio (curl; porcupine) ...cciu sounds like "...tchuh" as in acciuga (anchovy)

Similar clusters with g (...ggia, ...ggio, etc.), follow the same phonetical rules as above, sounding as "...djah", "...djoh", etc. Rarely, the cluster ...ccie or ...ggie (with an i) may also occur, but they sound exactly as the clusters ...cce and ...gge mentioned above; in these cases i (merely phonetic) is also redundant, so modern spellings tend to drop it. Double vowels are quite rare in Italian, though possible in a few cases. They always sound as the normal individual vowels, but in these cases a longer sound should be heard: cooperare (to cooperate) zii (uncles) veemenza (vehemence)

Double letters, either consonants or vowels, always belong to separate syllables (how to divide words into their syllables is specifically dealt with by paragraph 17.3): attrito at - tri - to passare pas - sa - to abboccare ab - boc - ca - re lucchetto luc - chet - to cooperazione co - o - pe - ra - zio - ne

and so on

1.5 ACCENT (OR STRESS) Although there is no strict rule, in most Italian words the accent or stress falls on the penultimate syllable. Although the stress is carried by the whole syllable, it is much easier to remember which vowel carries it: for instance, in the word possibile (possible) the stress is carried by the second syllable (-si-) (unlike in English), but it is easier to remember that the first vowel, i.e. i, is stressed. In the following examples accented vowels are used for the Italian spelling, to show which is the vowel that carries the stress. However, keep in mind that it is very unusual for Italian words to be spelled with accented letters, with very few exceptions discussed further in this page. To help the reader, the stressed syllables have also been marked in the "English spelling" version by using bold letters, as explained at the end of the previous paragraph 1.4. A few examples: lampadìna carbòne supermercàto senatòre aereoplàno arcobaléno riconoscènte

"lahmpahdyhnah" "karbohneh" "swpehrmehrkahtoh" "sehnahtohreh" "ahehrehohplahnoh" "ahrkohbahlehnoh" "ryhkohnohshenteh" (English "sh" !)

light bulb coal supermarket senator airoplane rainbow thankful

But in some other words the stress is carried by an earlier syllable: piece of furniture (as a noun); mòbile "mohbyhleh" movable (as an adjective) ràpido "rahpyhdoh" fast, quick telèfono "tehlehfohnoh" telephone lìbero "lyhbehroh" free (from duty or restraint) pòvero "pohvehroh" poor

THE USE OF ACCENTED VOWELS IN COMMON SPELLING Accented vowels have been used in the previous examples for the sake of an easier understanding. In ordinary spelling they are allowed, but very seldom used. Only in two cases accented vowels are commonly used: •

WORDS WHOSE LAST SYLLABLE CARRIES THE ACCENT There are many words of this kind in Italian (nouns, verb inflections, adverbs, etc.), and some are frequently used. An accent is compulsory in this case, otherwise the stress would not be heard. Furthermore, in some cases the same word spelled without an accent even has a different meaning (see further down). A few words with a similar spelling, but whose last syllable is not stressed, are shown on the right. perché

"pehrkeh"

why, because

sarà

"sahrah"

it will be

perciò

"pehrchoh"

therefore

papà però più

"pahpah" "pehroh" "pyw"

dad but, however more, plus

Sarah (a name)

Sara

"sahrah"

papa pero

"pahpah" pope "pehroh" pear-tree

Some of these words have an accent on the last syllable because they dropped the last part of the original word they derive from (usually Latin), or because they are of French origin (most French words have an accent on the last syllable). Also several compounds of che (pronounced "ke", meaning which, that) are spelled with an accent: perché (why, because) poiché (because) benché (despite) giacché (since) sicché (so, therefore) etc. WORDS THAT HAVE A DIFFERENT MEANING DEPENDING ON THE POSITION OF THE ACCENT A few words have a different meaning when different syllables carry the accent: àncora

"ahnkohrah"

anchor (noun)

ancòra

"ahnkohrah"

again, more (adverb)

règia

"rehjah"

royal (adjective)

regìa

"rehjyhah"

direction of a movie or a play (noun)

capitàno càpitano

"kahpytahnoh" captain (noun) "kahpytahnoh" they happen, they occur (verb)

In this case, accents are not mandatory; many Italian people do not use them, because the meaning of the word, and therefore its correct accent, is clearly understood by the context of the phrase: considering the first couple of sample words, in sentences such as "strange things happen" or "he is the captain", neither of the two words (happen, captain) could be mistaken with the other. Focus your attention on the second couple of words shown above: in the first noun (règia), the gia cluster forms one syllable, because the syllables of the word are re - gia; therefore, the pronounciation of the cluster "-jah" follows the standard rules, as has already been said in paragraph 1.2. In the second word (regìa), instead, the same cluster belongs to two separate syllables: re - gì - a, so the sound too splits into "re-jyh-ah". Only the second syllable gi carries the accent, not the final a. TYPES OF ACCENTED VOWELS USED IN ITALIAN SPELLING This part of the paragraph is not really fundamental for a beginner, although some readers might have noticed that most of the accented vowels used so far bear a grave accent, i.e. slanted leftwards (perciò, sarà), while a few others are slanted in the opposite direction (perché). Modern Italian uses the following set of accented vowels: "grave" accents, slanted leftwards à ("wide" sound pronounciation)

"acute" accent, slanted rightwards ("narrow" sound pronounciation)

è

ì

ò

ù

é

(eventually, read again paragraph 1.1 for the different ways of pronouncing the vowel "e"). From the table above, you can see how only e has both forms, while all the others take only the grave (leftwards) accent. Very seldom, an ó (with acute accent) is also found in printed texts, but its use is not mandatory, and most people prefer to spell it as a normal o.

It has already been said in this page that when the accent is carried by the last syllable, an accented vowel has to be used. Since most vowels only take the grave accent, this is the only one that can be used: andrà "ahndrah" he / she will go there là "lah" lunedì "lwnehdyh" monday finì "fyhnyh" it finished falò

"fahloh"

great fire, pire

però

"pehroh"

but

down there, over there laggiù "lahjjw" more - plus più "pyw" But e can take two different accents; according to the word, either one or the other should be used. These are examples of words whose final e bears a grave accent ("wide" sound): è "eh" he / she / it is coffee or coffee-bar caffè "kah'ffeh" frappè "frah'ppeh" milk shake In other words, instead, the final e bears the acute accent ("narrow" sound): perché "pehrkeh" why, because né "neh" not, nor, neither sé "seh" self, one's self In very few cases, an accented e can be used within the word, to indicate which is the correct sound of the vowel: pèsca ("wide" e) = peach pésca ("narrow" e) = fishing This is not mandatory; actually, many people would spell both words pesca (with a normal e), because the context of the sentence is enough to understand which of the two makes more sense. HOW TO TYPE ACCENTED VOWELS Most people who do not use an Italian keyboard may wonder how to type accented vowels in a text, because a standard international keyboard does not have these letters among the keys. Since they belong to the ASCII set of characters, it is possible to enter them by typing their code numbers in the keyboard's number pad, while pressing the Alt key: try them out yourself, in the box below. à = Alt+133 | è = Alt+138 | ì = Alt+141 | ò = Alt+149 | ù = Alt+151 | é = Alt+130 To type an o with an acute accent use Alt+162, but remember that ó is only found in dictionaries, as a reading aid. Instead not all fonts have capital (uppercase) accented letters. Times New Roman and Arial, among the most commonly used, have the following codes: try them out. À = Alt+0192 | È = Alt+0200 | Ì = Alt+0204 | Ò = Alt+0210 | Ù = Alt+0217 | É = Alt+0201 Again, to type Ó use Alt+0211, for the same limited use as above. If your computer or the standard font you are using does not have such vowels, you can still use normal ones followed by an apostrophe: a' | e' | i' | o' | u' A'

| E' |

I'

| O' | U'

Some Italian people too use apostrophes in place of accented vowels, but since this is not very correct, and the two different e's cannot be told, the use of accented vowels should be preferred, where available.

2.1 GENDER AND NUMBER STANDARD INFLECTIONS NOTE in this paragraph, the "English sound" spelling of words shows again which syllable is stressed.

Italian language has two main genders: masculine and feminine; a third neutre gender (for plants, non-living objects, general concepts, etc.) occurs only in pronouns, so for the time being simply disregard it. In English, a vast majority of nouns are neutre (masculine and feminine are only used for human beings or for animals), while articles and adjectives have no gender at all. In Italian instead, nouns, adjectives and articles too are either masculine or feminine (but never neutre). An important difference with English is that articles and adjectives have masculine and feminine forms, according to the gender of the noun they are related to. For nouns, number (i.e. whether the word is singular or plural) works exactly as in English: the singular form is used when referring to one subject and the plural form when referring to two or more. But in Italian, adjectives and articles are number-sensitive too, whereas in English they are not: "the old house" in plural form becomes "the old houses", only the noun changes, while in Italian also the article and the adjective would be turned in plural form. Here are a few examples. Articles and adjectives will be dealt with throughoutly in a further paragraph, so now try to focus your attention only on their inflections (marked in red colour), which show both their gender and number. casa (feminine, singular) albero (masculine, singular)

"kahsah" "ahlbehroh"

house, home tree

una casa (feminine, singular) un albero (masculine, singular)

"wnah kahsah" "wn ahlbehroh"

a house, a home a tree

una vecchia casa (feminine, singular) "uhnah veh'kkyah kahsah" an old house un grosso albero (masculine, singular) "uhn grohssoh ahlbehroh" a big tree

vecchie case (feminine, plural) grossi alberi (masculine, plural)

"veh'kkyheh kahseh" "grohssyh ahlbehryh"

old houses big trees

GENDER AND NUMBER INFLECTIONS FOR NOUNS Masculine and feminine inflections follow this general pattern: MASCULINE INFLECTIONS FEMININE INFLECTIONS • singular: ......o • singular: ......a • plural: ......i • plural: ......e

Therefore, according to this table: tavolo (masc.) tavoli

"tahvohloh" "tahvohlyh"

table tables

porta (fem.) porte

"pohrtah" "pohrteh"

door doors

vaso (masc.) vasi

"vahsoh" "vahsyh"

vase vases

capra (fem.) capre

"kahprah" "kahpreh"

goat goats

martello (masc.) martelli

"mahrtehlloh" "mahrtehllyh"

hammer hammers

No nouns nor adjectives end with u, so this vowel should not create a problem. There are also several nouns and adjectives whose singular form ends with e: they can be either masculine or feminine. Their plural always ends with i, regardless of gender: BOTH MASCULINE AND FEMININE • singular: ......e • plural: ......i Here are a few examples: cane (masc.) "kahneh" dog cani "kahnyh" dogs ape (fem.) api

"ahpeh" "ahpyh"

bee bees

rete (fem.) reti

"rehteh" "rehtyh"

net nets

mare (masc.) mari

"mahreh" "mahryh"

sea seas

The two patterns shown up to this point should be considered the standard ones, and should be practised throughoutly. Some further examples: palla (fem.) "pahllah" ball palle "pahlleh" balls uccello (masc.) uccelli

"w'tchehlloh" (English "tch") "w'tchehllyh"

bird birds

mese (masc.) mesi

"mehseh" "mehsyh"

month months

A typical problem for beginners is that if a noun or an adjective ends with e, it may be either a feminine plural (according to the first pattern), or a masculine or feminine singular (according to the second pattern). In the same way, a noun or an adjective ending with i is surely plural, but it might be either masculine or feminine. This situation is only apparently confusing, as other parts of the sentence (articles, adjectives, verb tenses, etc.) will make gender difficult to be mistaken. GENDER AND NUMBER INFLECTIONS FOR ADJECTIVES Adjectives follow the same two patterns as nouns, so: bello (masculine) "behlloh" plural: belli "behllyh"

nice, handsome

bella (feminine) plural: belle

"behllah" "behlleh"

nice, beautiful

alto (masculine) plural: alti

"ahltoh" "ahltyh"

tall, high

alta (feminine) plural: alte

"ahltah" "ahlteh"

tall, high

grande (masculine & feminine) plural: grandi (masculine & feminine)

"grahndeh" "grahndyh"

big, huge, large

divertente (masculine & feminine) plural: divertenti (masculine & feminine)

"dyhvehrtehnteh" "dyhvehrtehntyh"

funny, amusing

Since the gender and number of both noun and adjective must always match, combinations can be: brutta casa (fem.) "bruh'ttah kahsah" ugly house brutte case "bruh'tteh kahseh" ugly houses nuovo albero (masc.) nuovi alberi

"nwohvoh ahlbehroh" "nwohvyh ahlbehryh"

new tree new trees

piccola ape (fem.) piccole api

"py'kkolah ahpeh" "py'kkoleh ahpih"

small bee small bee

brutto colore (masc.) brutti colori

"brw'ttoh kohlohreh" "brw'ttyh kohlohryh"

ugly colour ugly colours

grande nave (fem.) grandi navi

"grahndeh nahveh" "grahndyh nahvyh"

big ship big ships

fedele servitore (masc.) fedeli servitori

"fehdehleh sehrvyhtohreh" "fehdehlyh sehrvyhtohryh"

faithful servant faithful servants

2.2 GENDER AND NUMBER STANDARD INFLECTIONS PARTICULAR CASES NOTE in this paragraph, the "English sound" spelling of words shows again which syllable carries the stress This page deals with nouns and adjectives which behave according to the two standard patterns dealt with in the previous paragraph, but need a further discussion. You do not need to learn all these forms now, though it would be better if you simply read this paragraph, and came back to it from time to time, until you become familiar with all cases. The nouns and adjectives dealt with in this page end with the special clusters discussed in paragraph 1.2: their plurals too have to "compromise" with phonetics, so this brings a few changes to their inflections.

WORDS ENDING WITH ...co, ...ca, ...go, ...ga These nouns and adjectives add an h to their plural form. Should this not happen, the sound of consonant c and g would change. singular English sound plural English sound ...co ...koh ...chi ...kyh ...ca ...kah ...che ...keh ...go ...goh ...ghi ...ghyh ...ga ...gah ...ghe ...gheh As said above, the plural form without an h would change the guttural or "hard" sound of c and g to a palatal or "soft" sound (...co would become ...ci, sounding like English ...chyh, ...ga would become ...ge sounding like English ...jeh, etc. etc.). So letter h is needed, to keep the "hard" sound. buco "bwkoh" hole buchi "bwkyh" holes fico fichi

"fyhkoh" "fyhkyh"

fig figs

chirurgo chirurghi

"kyhrwrgoh" "kyhrwrghyh"

surgeon surgeons

lago laghi

"lahgoh" "lahghy"

lake lakes

formica formiche

"fohrmyhkah" "fohrmyhkeh"

ant ants

sega seghe

"sehgah" "sehgheh"

saw saws

mucca mucche

"mw'kkah" "mw'kkeh"

cow cows

However, when the vowel that comes before ...-co or ...-go is i (i.e. ...-ico, ...-igo), in most cases the masculin plural drops the h, thus becoming ...-ci or ...-gi (English sound ...chyh or ...jyh): singular amico nemico logico tecnico unico comico magico tragico simpatico

English sound plural English sound "ahmyhkoh" = friend "ahmyhchyh" = friends amici "nehmyhkoh" = enemy nemici "nehmyhchyh" = enemies "lohjyhkoh" = logical "lojyhchyh" = logical referred to a plural noun logici "tehknyhkoh" = technician - technical tecnici "tehknyhchyh" = technicians - technical "wnyhkoh" = only, sole "wnyhchyh" = only, sole referred to a plural noun unici "kohmyhkoh" = comical - comedian comici "kohmyhchyh" = comical - comedians "mahjyhkoh" = magic(al) magici "mahjyhchyh" = magic(al) referred to a plural noun "trahjyhkoh" = tragic tragici "trahjyhchyh" = tragical referred to a plural noun "sympahtyhkoh" = pleasant (person) simpatici "sympahtyhchyh" = pleasant referred to to a plural noun

Unfortunately, there are also a few words that end with ...-ico or ...-igo and have a regular masculine plural: singular English sound plural English sound antico "ahntyhkoh" = antique, old antichi "ahntyhkyh" = antique, old fico "fyhkoh" = fig fichi "fyhkyh" = figs plico "plyhkoh" = large envelope, small packet plichi "plyhkyh" = large envelope, small packets rigo "ryhgoh" = line (especially of text) righi "ryhghyh" = lines The two inflections are not taken at random: a rule, based on the word's stressed syllable, determins whether the noun or adjective has a regular or an irregular masculine plural. Provided that ...-co or ...-go is the last syllable, all words whose stress falls on the antepenultimate (i.e. two syllables ahead of -co or -go) have an irregular masculine plural (...-ici, ...-igi), without any exception. Instead when the the stressed syllable is the penultimate (one syllable ahead of -co or -go), the masculine plural is regular, and the only two exceptions are amico (friend) and nemico (enemy). Let's see again a few words from the previous examples (the stressed syllable is shown in green): singular syllables plural position of the stress (stress on the antepenultimate syllable) tecnico tec - ni - co tecnici (stress on the penultimate syllable) antico an - ti - co antichi (stress on the antepenultimate syllable) magico ma - gi - co magici (stress on the penultimate syllable) rigo ri - go righi But... singular amico nemico

syllables a - mi - co ne - mi - co

plural amici nemici

position of the stress (despite the stress on the penultimate syllable) (despite the stress on the penultimate syllable)

Obviously, it would be impossible to think of all these complicated rules while reading or speaking. For this reason, when rehearsing these words, it is very important to actually pronounce them, because the sound of the correct plural forms will linger in the reader's mind. Time and exercise will gradually help the learner to tell the masculine plurals automatically, by their sound, as fluent speakers do. Instead the feminine form of the same words discussed so far always follows the general rule: singular English sound plural English sound amica

"ahmyhkah" = friend

amiche "ahmyhkeh" = friends

logica

"lohjyhkah" = logical

logiche "lohjyhkeh" = logical referred to a plural noun

magica "mahjyhkah" = magic(al) antica

magiche "mahjyhkeh" = magic(al) referred to a plural noun

"ahntyhkah" = antique, old magiche "ahntyhkeh" = antique, old referred to a plural noun

The general rule is also followed when the consonant c is double, regardless of the vowel that comes before it (i.e. ...-acco, ...-icco, ...-occo, ...-ucco, all behave in the same way): singular English sound

plural English sound

pacco

"pahkkoh" = parcel

pacchi "pahkkyh" = parcels

ricco

"ryhkkoh" = rich - rich person ricchi "ryhkkyh" = rich - rich people

tocco

"tohkkoh" = a touch

ricchi "tokkyh" = touches

succo

"swhkkoh" = juice

succhi "swhkkyh" = juices

Obviously, nothing special happens when words end with ...ce or ...ge: singular English sound plural English sound luce (feminine) "lwcheh" = light "lwchyh" = lights luci legge (feminine) "leh'jjeh" = law leggi "leh'jjyh" = laws gregge (feminine) "greh'jjeh" = herd greggi "greh'jjyh" = herds

WORDS ENDING WITH ...cio, ...cia, ...gio, ...gia These nouns and adjectives usually drop vowel i in the plural form. In the singular form, vowel i is not actually pronounced, as it is only needed to give consonants c and g a "soft" sound (these clusters sound like English ...choh, ...chah, ...joh, ...jah). In the plural inflections, the i is no longer needed to keep this "soft" sound, therefore it is dropped. English singular plural English sound sound ...chyh (with English ...cio ...cho ...ci "ch" sound) ...cheh (with English ...cia ...cha ...ce "ch" sound) ...gio ...joh ...gi ...jyh ...gia ...jah ...ge ...jeh Leaving vowel i, the sound would not change (for example, both ...ge and ...gie sound like English ...jeh). calcio "kahlchoh" kick kicks calci "kahlchyh lancia lance

"lahnchah" "lahncheh"

spear spears

orologio orologi

"ohrohlohjoh" "ohrohlohjyh"

clock, watch clocks, watches

loggia logge

"loh'djah" "loh'djeh"

lodges, balconies lodge, balcony

Also for this case a few exceptions exist, but they are not so important at this stage.

WORDS ENDING WITH ...cìo, ...cìa, ...gìo, ...gìa Although these clusters look very similar to the previous ones, you will notice that vowel i has an accent: this means that this vowel carries the stress (for example, in the word magìa = magic the word is pronounced "mahjyhah"). In the case previously discussed, ...cio, ...cia, etc. form one syllable, and the vowel i is merely phonetic (i.e. not actually heard as an individual i). In this case instead, the clusters ...cì and ...cì belong to two separate syllables; for this reason i carries the stress, and is perfectly heard. Here is an example showing two nouns which apparently end in a similar way: camicia (shirt) and farmacia (chemist shop) the syllables in camicia (previous group) are ca + mi + cia (the stress is on -mi-) the syllables in farmacia (this group) are far + ma + ci + a (the stress is on -ci-) Take note that accented vowels are not commonly used when spelling ordinary words. Sometimes they are, for words not frequently used, such as leggìo (book-stand, book-rest), zoppìa (lameness), etc. But farmacia, as well as other everyday's words, would be normally spelt with a regular i. Nevertheless, accented vowels are allowed. They are always found in dictionaries, as a useful help for readers who are likely not familiar with the Italian language. So these pages too will often show them, in the case of uncertain pronounciation. In the plural form, masculine nouns keep a double i, while feminine ones turn last vowel into e, as for any other standard plural. singular English sound plural English sound ...cìo ...chyhoh ...cìi ...chyhyh (with English "ch" sound) ...cìa ...chyhah ...cìe ...chyheh (with English "ch" sound) ...gìo ...jyhoh ...gìi ...jyhyh ...gìa ...jyhah ...gìe ...jyheh In this way, the plural inflection does not affect the vowel i, which also keeps carrying the stress, as in the singular form. In a more general sense, this rule is used for any word whose last part sounds like ...ìo or ...ìa. For example: rinvìo (postponement); armonìa (harmony); etc. rinvìo "rynvyhoh" postponement rinvìi "rynvyhyh" postponements addìo addìi

"ah'ddyhoh" "ah'ddyhyh

farewell farewells

ronzìo ronzìi

"rondzyhoh" "rondzyhyh

buzzing buzzings

bugìa bugìe

"bwjyhah" "bwjyheh"

lie lies

follìa follìe

"fohllyhah" "fohllyheh

craze crazes

armonìa armonìe

"ahrmohnyhah" "ahrmohnyheh"

harmony harmonies

Both vowels at the end of the word should be distinctly heard when properly pronouncing these nouns.

WORDS ENDING WITH ...scio AND ...scia These nouns behave like the ones ending with ...cio and ...cia discussed above: plurals simply drop the phonetic i, which is no longer needed. English singular plural English sound sound ...shyh (English "sh" ...scio ...skoh ...sci sound) ...sheh (English "sh" ...scia ...skah ...sce sound) So simply drop an i in the plural form. "fahshoh" (English "sh" fascio sound) "fahshyh (English "sh" fasci sound) "ahshah" (English "sh" sound) "ahsheh" (English "sh" asce sound) ascia

bundle (of twigs or branches) bundles

axe axes

NOUNS ENDING WITH ...scìo AND ...scìa These nouns differ from the previous ones because their vowel i carries the accent. Once again, this depends on the word's syllables; for example fruscìo (hissing) is made of: fru + sci + o (sci- is stressed). There are not many of these words, but they behave as the ones ending with cìo, cìa, etc., previously discussed. singular English sound plural English sound ...shyhoh (English "sh" sound) ...scìo ...scii ...shyhyh (English "sh" sound) ...shyhah (English "sh" sound) ...scìa ...scie ...shyheh (English "sh" sound) So they too simply keep the i in the plural form (masculine will have i twice). fruscìo "frwshyhoh" (English "sh" sound) hissing fruscìi "frwshyhyh" (English "sh" sound) hissings scìa scìe

"shyhah" (English "sh" sound) "shyheh" (English "sh" sound)

trail trails

WORDS ENDING WITH ...glio AND ...glia Again, in clusters ...glio and ...glia vowel i is not actually pronounced, but simply used to obtain a Spanish "ll" sound (see paragraph 1.2 for more details). singular English sound plural English sound ...lloh (Spanish "ll" ...llyh (Spanish "ll" ...glio ...gli sound) sound) ...llah (Spanish "ll" ...lleh (Spanish "ll" ...glia ...glie sound) sound)

So masculine plurals drop one i (which otherwise would be double), while feminine plurals keep it. "fyhlloh" (Spanish "ll" sound) figlio son "fyhllyh" (Spanish "ll" sound) figli sons scoglio scogli

"skohlloh" (Spanish "ll" sound) "skohllyh" (Spanish "ll" sound)

sea rock sea rocks

figlia figlie

"fyhllah" (Spanish "ll" sound) "fyhlleh" (Spanish "ll" sound)

daughter daughters

foglia foglie

"fohllah" (Spanish "ll" sound) "fohlleh" (Spanish "ll" sound)

leaf leaves

WORDS ENDING WITH ...glìo AND ...glìa Another case of nouns with accented i, belonging to the penultimate syllable and carrying the stress. singular English sound plural English sound ...glìo ...llyhoh (Spanish "ll" sound) ...glìi ...llyhyh (Spanish "ll" sound) ...glìa ...llyhah (Spanish "ll" sound) ...glìe ...llyeh (Spanish "ll" sound) Very few words have this ending, but the rule is the same as for similar cases discussed above: vowel i is kept in both masculine and feminine plurals. bisbiglìo "bysbyhllyhoh" (Spanish "ll" sound) wispering bisbiglìi "bysbyhllyhyh" (Spanish "ll" sound) wisperings

WORDS ENDING WITH ...gno AND ...gna These do not require a special discussion: as any other noun, masculine plural is ...gni and feminine plural is ...gne. Always remember that cluster gn sounds like Spanish ñ. singular English sound plural English sound ragno (masculine) "rahñoh" = spider "rahñyh" = spiders ragni compagna (feminine) "kohmpahñah" = partner compagne "kohmpahñeh" = partners

NOUNS ENDING WITH ...gnìo AND ...gnìa Again, these few nouns have an accented vowel i, because it belongs to their penultimate syllable (which carries the stress). The pattern is quite similar to the ones discussed before: singular English sound plural English sound ...gnìo ...ñyhoh (Spanish "ñ" sound) ...gnìi ...ñyhyh (Spanish "ñ" sound) ...gnìa ...ñyhah (Spanish "ñ" sound) ...gnìe ...ñyheh (Spanish "ñ" sound) Therefore, both genders keep the i (masculine will have two). Actually, no common nouns or adjectives exist in the masculine form, and only one common noun exists in feminine gender: compagnìa "kohmpahñyhah" (Spanish "ñ" sound) company compagnìe "kohmpahñyheh" (Spanish "ñ" sound) companies Take your time to become familiar with these inflections: once you master them, you should be able to cope with the great majority of Italian nouns and adjectives. Don't let the following paragraph scare you! Non-standard inflections might be a bit difficult to memorize,

but they represent a minority: most nouns belong to the two general patterns. For this reason, you can memorize paragraph 2.3 little by little, while carrying on with further topics, but I suggest you should browse it, to have an idea of what non-standard inflections can look like.

2.3 GENDER AND NUMBER NON-STANDARD INFLECTIONS Although most nouns and adjectives have a standard inflection, there are some words which follow different patterns. As said at the end of paragraph 2.1, they might not be easy to learn at once, but there is no need of doing so: simply read this page, try to understand how and why these inflections differ from the standard ones, and memorize them little by little, as you study further paragraphs. NOUNS WITH A LATIN NEUTRE PLURAL A few nouns indicating either objects or concepts which are commonly given a high consideration (i.e. some parts of the human body) have a standard masculine singular (....o) but a peculiar plural ending with ....a (which is the original Latin neutre plural inflection of the word); in modern Italian, though, this particular plural form has changed gender, and is feminine: osso (masculine, singular) "ohssoh" bone ossa (feminine, plural) "ohssah" bones dito (masculine, singular) finger "dyhtoh" dita (feminine, plural) fingers "dyhtah" braccio (masculine, singular) "brah'tchoh" arm braccia (feminine, plural) "brah'tchah" arms gesto (masculine, singular) "jehstoh" deed, feat gesta (feminine, plural) "jehstah" deeds, feats Sometimes these names have two plural forms, one feminine of Latin origin (as explained above), and one masculine (regular) with a similar though "less noble" meaning. This concept will be discussed again at the end of this paragraph. For the time being, try to memorize this important noun with a fully irregular gender: mano (feminine despite the ...o, singular) "mahnoh" hand mani (feminine despite the ...i, plural) "mahnyh" hands

NOUNS ENDING WITH ...tore The ...tore ending usually indicates a human action or activity (in a very generic sense). Curiously, a few English words of Latin origin still have similar inflections (i.e. actor - actress, master mistress, etc.): guidatore (masculine) "gwydahtohreh" driver, conductor (masculine or feminine) guidatrice (feminine) "gwydahtryhcheh" attore (masculine) actor (masculine) "ah'ttohreh" attrice (feminine) actress (feminine) "ah'ttryhceh" pittore (masculine) painter (masculine) "py'ttohreh" pittrice (feminine) painter (feminine) "py'ttryhceh" nuotatore (masculine) "nwohtahtohreh" swimmer (masculine or feminine) nuotatrice (feminine) "nwohtahtryhceh" mentitore (masculine) "mentyhtohreh" lier (masculine or feminine) mentitrice (feminine) "mentyhtryhceh"

NOUNS WHOSE FEMININE INFLECTION IS ...essa They belong to several categories, which cannot be specifically classified, but a few guidelines could be: noble ranks, some professional activities, some nouns whose masculine ends in ...one. Also in this case, some English feminine nouns have kept the Latin root. barone (masculine) baron (masculine) "bahrohneh" baronessa (feminine) "bahrohnehssah" (notice the accent) baroness (feminine) duca (masculine) duke (masculine) "dwkah" plural duchessa (feminine) "dwkehssah" (accent shift again) duchess (feminine) studente (masculine) student (masculine or feminine) "stwdehnteh" studentessa (feminine) "stwdehntehssah" dottore (masculine) doctor (masculine or feminine) "doh'ttohreh" dottoressa (feminine) "doh'ttohrehssah" presidente (masculine) president (masculine or feminine) "prehsyhdehnteh" presidentessa (feminine) "prehsyhdehntehssah" leone (masculine) lion (masculine) "lehohneh" leonessa (feminine) she-lion (feminine) "lehohnehssah" Besides the accent shift on the penultimate syllable (because this feminine inflection brings one additional syllable to the word), note how in the duca - duchessa example, an h has been added to keep the strong sound of the cluster ca ("ka") turning into che ("ke"); simply ce would have sounded like English "che".

NOUNS OF GREEK ORIGIN Some nouns of Greek origin end in a in both masculine and feminine forms; originally, most of them did not have a feminine form, therefore the same inflection is now used also for feminine. They indicate human activities. But in the plural form, they behave according to the standard inflections (see previous paragraph 2.2). atleta (masculine and feminine, singular) "ahtlehtah" athlete (masculine and feminine) atleti (masculine plural) atlete (feminine plural) eremita (masculine and feminine, singular) "ehrehmytah" hermit (masculine and feminine) eremiti (masculine plural) eremite (feminine plural) idiota (masculine and feminine, singular) "yhdyohtah" idiot (masculine and feminine) idioti (masculine plural) idiote (feminine plural) Some other nouns with similar features are: collega (= collegue); omicida (= murderer); sosia (= lookalike); suicida (= suicide [person]); The same inflection is also found in a number of nouns whose only gender is masculine: monarca (= monarch); problema (= problem); programma (= program); pentagramma (= pentagram); schema (pronounced "skehma" = scheme); stemma (= crest); and few more.

Most of these inflections are typically of Greek origin. Their plurals are regular (schemi, programmi, stemmi, etc.)

NOUNS WHOSE MASCULINE AND FEMININE HAVE DIFFERENT MEANINGS A few nouns have different meanings when changing from masculine to feminine. They can be organized in different groups, according to the relation between the meaning of the two forms: NOUNS WHOSE MASCULINE AND FEMININE ARE INDIVIDUAL WORDS These few nouns have the same root in masculine and feminine forms, but they might be considered totally individual, because masculine singular turns into masculin plural, and feminine singular into feminine plural; their meaning is generically related, sometimes as a metaphor. filo (masc. sing.) = string fili (masc. plur.) = strings fila (fem. sing.) = row, queue file (fem. plural) = rows, queues peso (masc. sing.) = weight pesa (fem. sing.) = scales for heavy goods

pesi (masc. plur.) = weights pese (fem. plural) = scales for heavy goods (plural)

visto (masc. sing.) = visa (for passports, etc.) visti (masc. plur.) = visas vista (fem. sing.) = sight; view viste (fem. plur.) = sights; views NOUNS INDICATING TREES AND THEIR FRUIT The pattern "masculine for the tree - feminine for the fruit" is used for many fruits which grow on trees (but not for fruit coming from plants or bushes, such as melons, raspberries, grapes, etc. etc.): melo = apple-tree mela = apple pesco = peach-tree pesca = peach olivo (or ulivo) = olive-tree oliva = olive ciliegio = cherry-tree ciliegia = cherry pruno = prune-tree prugna = prune (notice a slight change in the noun's root) A few fruit names, though, are masculine and this pattern could be confusing. Also when the fruit's name ends with e, masculine and feminine could be told only by the article (which will be the subject of the following paragraph) or by an adjective. In these cases, the above-said pattern may not be followed, and the form albero di ... (literally tree of ...) is used, followed by the fruit's plural form: un limone (masculine, singular) = a lemon un limone, or un albero di limoni = a lemon-tree una noce (feminine, singular) = a nut un noce, or un albero di noci = a nut-tree The latter form can be used as a standard, also in the previous case, so apple-tree could be either melo or albero di mele. But such details are not really important at this stage, so don't worry about them now. Simply, be aware of the importance of masculine and feminine gender in Italian nouns. A few nouns have two different plural genders, with some difference in their meaning: osso (masculine, singular) = bone ossa (feminine, plural, Latin neutre form, see above) = bones (of living beings) ossi (masculine plural) = bones (in a more "material" sense, i.e. a bone of a T-steak) gesto (masculine, singular) = deed, feat or gesture gesta (feminine, plural, Latin neutre form) = deeds, feats gesti (masculine plural) = gestures

NOUNS WHOSE SINGULAR AND PLURAL INFLECTIONS ARE THE SAME They belong to several categories: FOREIGN NOUNS Italian is becoming slowly accustomed to new foreign terms, especially in technical fields; some of these terms have no actual equivalent in the original language, so they are periodically added to the standard dictionary. Some others, though, are perfectly translatable; in these cases, the use of foreign terms is considered rather snobbish, also because in Italy the knowledge of foreign languages is still far from a good standard. Furthermore, people who like showing themselves by using foreign words are very likely to pronounce them incorrectly, or to misspell them; on the other end, when foreign words are pronounced correctly, they might even be not understood at all, a funny paradox. Therefore, if a foreign word has an Italian equivalent, it is advisable to use the latter. Nevertheless, many international terms of common use would never create a problem. This is how gender works in these cases. • When the meaning of the term is similar to an Italian one, or when it has a specific gender in the original language, the noun is usually given the same gender in Italian. A few examples: CD (compact disk) basically relates to the concept of music record (in Italian: disco, masculine), so this noun, either short form or full-length form, is considered masculine, and obviously floppy disk, hard disk, etc. are masculine too, since they contain the same concept of recording device; metro (short form for the French métropolitaine = urban subway railway) is also used in Italian; the "official" form is metropolitana, feminine (actual translation of the French term, very similar to Italian), but the short form is also used, obviously with feminine gender. e-mail is similar to mail (in Italian: posta, feminine), so it is usually considered feminine, although some "purists" prefer to use the actual translation posta elettronica (electronic mail); • When the gender of the noun is more indefinite (no similarity with Italian nouns), it is usually given a standard masculine gender (which in Italian mimics the neutre gender): sport, computer or PC, würstel, whisky, ouverture, modem, menù (also spelled menu, as in French), etc. etc. But in their plural forms, these nouns are always treated as if they were singular: due metro (two subways), tre menù (three menus), quattro e-mail (four e-mails), and so on. Some people prefer to use the foreign plurals (due ouvertures, quattro e-mails, etc.): This too is considered correct, provided that the right plurals are used (for example, words of German origin cannot be turned into their plural forms by simply adding an s). NOUNS WITH AN ACCENT ON THE LAST SYLLABLE Words whose last syllable is stressed carry a graphic accent on the last letter (always a vowel). Most of them come from longer words of archaic origin, which have dropped the last syllable, and are therefore known as "truncated nouns"; they are easily told because of the last accented vowel: metà (either half or halves); virtù (either virtue or virtues); viltà (cowardness, either singular or plural); bontà (goodness, either used to indicate the quality, or the object itself, i.e. le bontà = the good things, the good food); etc. Other words with an accent on the last vowel, though not real truncated nouns (because they were not originated from longer nouns), behave in the same way: caffè (either coffee or coffees); falò (either great fire or great fires); etc. SHORTENED NOUNS On the opposite end, there are several nouns which are often "shortened" in common speech, as if they were truncated nouns, but have no accent. bicicletta (bycicle) is shortened in bici (either singular or plural); fotografia (photograph) is shortened in foto (either singular or plural); metropolitana (subway, also mentioned above) is shortened in metro; etc.. In official texts, their full spelling is preferred, although their short form is sometimes used for compounds, like fotoamatore (amateur photographer), etc.

Obviously only the short version has one inflection, while the full-length noun has ordinary singular and plural forms (fotografia sing., fotografie plur.). MONOSYLLABIC NOUNS Also monosyllabic nouns, which are very few in Italian, behave as truncated words, because their only syllable carries the accent (although a graphic accent is not indicated, except for tè): re (either king or kings); tè (either tea or teas); all musical notes: do (C), re (D), mi (E), etc. NOUNS OF GREEK ORIGIN ENDING WITH ...si These nouns end with ...esi, ...isi, ...osi, they are feminine, and in most cases they belong to specific fields (either philosophical, or mathemathical, or medical, etc.); some of them, though, do often occur in everyday's speech too. These are a few common ones: tesi (feminine) both thesis and theses; ipotesi (feminine) both hypothesis or hypotheses and; paralisi (feminine) both paralysis and paralyses; osmosi (feminine) osmosis (normally used in singular form, though the Italian plural is the same); catarsi (feminine) catharsis (same as above for plural). As you see, also English uses the Greek root, and forms a plural by only changing the penultimate vowel i into e. Other nouns with one single inflection are very few, and should be considered exceptions, therefore they cannot be classified. An example is: vaglia = masculine, both money order and money orders.

2.4 ARTICLES Articles can prove a little tricky to English speakers, because English only has two: the (definite article) and a (indefinite), and the only variation is the use of an (instead of a) when nouns start with a vowel: a box, an eye. In Italian, though, articles need to match the noun they relate to, both by gender and by number: for example, translating the lady and the man different articles have to be used (la donna and l'uomo), as well as for the cat and the cats (il gatto and i gatti). Furthermore, Italian language uses articles more often than English: general nouns and numerals sometimes require them, whereas in English they are usually omitted ("he prefers wine to beer" in Italian would be translated "he prefers the wine to the beer"); in the same way, "I was born in the 1963" sounds queer in English. Finally, Italian articles also have to match phonetically the word coming next, to produce a more fluent sound, and they do this by modifying their basic inflection..... But don't panic! Mastering these articles is a much easier task than it might seem from this description, and once you become familiar with the sound of Italian language (more than with the actual rules), your ears will help you more than your memory. So, let's become familiar with each of them, one at a time: DEFINITE ARTICLES •

LO (masculine, singular) it is used before nouns starting with a z (at the beginning of a word, it always sounds as English "dz", not "tz"), and with nouns starting with clusters s + consonant (sb..., sc..., sd... etc.): lo zucchero (the sugar) lo zoccolo (the clog) lo scambio (the exchange) lo spazio (the space)

IL (masculine, singular) it is used when the noun starts with any consonant not belonging to the previous case: il cane (the dog) il mare (the sea) il castello (the castle) il treno (the train) il sole (the sun)

LA (feminine, singular) it is used whith nouns starting with any consonant: la casa (the house) la forza (the strength) la scatola (the box) la zuppa (the soup)

L' (both masculine and feminine, singular) this is the elision of lo or la: their vowel has been dropped, and an apostrophe has taken its place; you can see from the examples how no space separates the article from the following letter. It is used whith nouns starting with a vowel. The loss of the article's vowel is to provide a swifter sound, as the sound of two vowels would "slow down" the pronounciation: l'occhio (masculine, pronounced "loh'kkyoh", the eye) l'acqua (feminine, pronounced "lah'kkwah", the water) l'impatto (masculine, "lympahttoh", the impact) l'aria (feminine, "lahryah", the air)

GLI (masculine, plural) it is used whith nouns starting with: - vowels, - consonant z, - clusters made of s + another consoonant (sb..., sc..., sd... etc.), - cluster gn: gli artisti (the artists) gli elefanti (the elephants) gli infedeli (the infidels) gli occhi (the eyes), gli uomini (the men) gli zoccoli (the clogs) gli studenti (the students) gli scandali (the scandals), gli gnomi (the gnomes)

I (masculine, plural) it is used whith nouns starting with consonants which do not belong to the previous case: i cavalli (the horses) i signori (the gentlemen) i rami (the branches)

LE (feminine, plural) it is used whith any noun (either starting with a consonant or a vowel): le ville (the villas) le ali (the wings) le piante (the plants) le espressioni (the expressions) le scarpe (the shoes) Note that le does not follow the elision rule as for the singular form. See also the bottom of the page for a further minor note.

INDEFINITE ARTICLES As in English, only singular forms exist: • UNO (masculine, singular) it is used in the same cases which require the definite article lo is used (see above): uno zio (an uncle) uno sconto (a discount) uno steccato (a fence) •

UN (masculine, singular) it is used in the same cases which require the definite articles il and masculine l' (see above): un bottone (a button) un osso (a bone) un soldato (a soldier) un amico (a friend) un gioco (a game) un uccello (a bird)

UNA (feminine, singular) it is used with nouns starting with any consonant: una scala (a ladder) una torcia (a torch) una zucca (a pumpkin)

UN' (feminine, singular) it is the elision of una, used when nouns start with any vowel. The apostrophe "binds" the article to the following letter, both in spelling (no space) and in pronounciation, as for the l' article above: un'anima (pronounced "wnahnymah", a soul) un'elica (pronounced "wnehlykah", a propeller) un'orma (pronounced "wnohrmah", a footprint)

The full spelling una is also accepted when the following noun starts with i: i.e. un'importante scoperta (an important discovery) may sometimes be spelled una importante scoperta, but this happens rather seldom, so simply stick to the general rule. When plural nouns are indefinite, they simply do not use an article, or they use the partitive form: i.e. cats (no article) or some cats (partitive), coins or some coins (partitive), etc. Partitive will be dealt with further on, so for the time being simply disregard its use. Summarising this (apparently) difficult scheme, the following table will make articles much more easy to memorize: INDEFINITE DEFINITE ARTICLES ARTICLES (matching noun starts with...)

masculine singular

feminine singular

masculine plural

feminine plural

Z or S+consonant any other consonant vowels

lo il l'

la la l'

gli i gli

le le le

masculin feminine singular singular uno un un

una una un'

The article's gender and number is very important because, as already explained in paragraph 2.1 and paragraph 2.2, the noun's inflection alone might not always clearly tell whether the gender is masculine or feminine, singular or plural:

libro (masculine)

book

ape (feminine sing.)

bee

il libro un libro porte (feminine pl.) le porte mano (fem. sing., irregular) la mano una mano gesta (fem. pl., irregular) le gesta

the book a book doors the doors

hand the hand a hand human acts, deeds the acts, the deeds

l'ape un'ape ospiti (masculine) gli ospiti atleta (masc., nonstandard) l'atleta un atleta

the bee a bee guests the guests

athlete the athlete an athlete

gesti (masculine)

gestures

i gesti

the gestures

The importance of matching the article with the noun is even greater when the latter have the same inflection for singular and plural form, as foreign or truncated nouns (see paragraph 2.2), because in these cases whether the noun is singular or plural can be told only by the article: computer computer (or computers) computers computer (masculine) i computer (or i the the il computer computers) computer computers un computer a computer età (feminine) age età ages l'età the age le età the ages un'età an age INDEFINITE ARTICLES USED AS PRONOUNS In certain sentences, indefinite articles act as pronouns. In this case, the English equivalent does not match the Italian syntax, so an example will make this concept easy to understand: an old dog - an old one (one acts as a pronoun, meaning dog) beautiful flowers - beautiful ones (again, ones acts as a pronoun) In Italian, one used as a pronoun is translated with the same indefinite article uno or una before the noun: as already explained, article uno also has the meaning of one (as a numeral), so in these cases it acts both as an article and a pronoun at the same time: un vecchio cane = an old dog uno vecchio = an old one The only difference is that the full-length expression uno or una are used (not un, or un', as indefinite articles): this gives stress to the fact that the article also acts as a pronoun. As a result, only two forms are possible: uno (always used for masculine) and una (always used for feminine). Here are a few more examples: un'ampia veduta = a wide view una ampia = a wide one uno speciale apparecchio = a special device uno speciale = a special one una grossa scatola = a large box una grossa = a large one un'improbabile circostanza = an unlikely circumstance una improbabile = an unlikely one Foreseeing a common impression, I agree that these topics might appear complicated ...but only for non-

Italian speakers, of course. The three ways of mastering these patterns are practice, more practice and practice again.

NOTES • for phonetic reasons, nouns starting with the diptongues (cluster of two vowels) ia, ie, io and iu, require the full article, without elision, despite the general rule; for example: lo iodio (iodine, in Italian it requires an article). But these words are pretty rare, so don't worry about them now. • feminine plural words starting with e (esposizioni = expositions, evidenze = evidences, etc.) now use the full article le, which means that the pronounciation of both vowels e should be heard: le entrate (the income) would be pronounced "leh ehntrahteh". In older times, this article used to be treated as for singular nouns starting with a vowel: l'entrate, l'esposizioni, etc... But now this does not occur any longer.

2.5 THE POSITION OF ADJECTIVES English adjectives usually come before the noun (with very few exceptions, such as "prince charming", or similar expressions). Italian adjectives, instead, may come either before or after the matching noun: una piccola casa una casa piccola Both expressions above mean a small house, but in the second one the idea of small is slightly more emphasized. Two further situations will make this concept more evident: He lives in a small house not far from mine It is a small house compared to the average The main concept of the first sentence is that "somebody lives nearby", not that "his house is small": in Italian, the adjective would come before the noun (una piccola casa). In the second expression, the fact that "the house is small" is much more important for the overall sense of the sentence: in this case the Italian adjective would come after the noun (una casa piccola). Also the tone of the voice can be used to express different concepts: in the second sentence, small house would be pronounced with a slight stress. But don't worry: in Italian, the general idea would be understood in both cases. The pattern "noun - adjective" is as common as the opposite one "adjective - noun", though in certain expressions the "adjective - noun" pattern might be incorrect, or sound very strange to an Italian. For example, when colours are used as adjectives, they always follow the noun: a black cat would always be un gatto nero the green leaves always le foglie verdi the blue sky always il cielo azzurro The opposite form (le verdi foglie, l'azzurro cielo, etc.) would sound unusual, or poetical, but it would never be used in common speech. Anyway, it's not really important to master this concept now; simply, be aware that adjectives may either follow the noun, or may be used before it with a less emphasized meaning.

ADJECTIVES grande, bello, buono Three very common adjectives, grande (big, great, large), bello (nice, pretty, handsom, fine), and buono (good, fine), when used before a noun, sometimes drop one or two letters for phonetic reasons. grande

For masculine gender, when this adjective is followed by a consonant, it may be shortened in gran, to create a more fluent rythm, but both forms are perfectly correct, and which of the two is used is just a personal choice: un grande castello ~ un gran castello (a big castle) il grande rumore ~ il gran rumore (the big noise) un grande paese ~ un gran paese (a great country) etc. etc. When the following masculine noun starts with a vowel, instead, grande remains more oten unchanged. The shortened form grand' (with an apostrophe) also exists, but only in a limited number of cases. If you are in doubt, it is better to use grande in full: un grande armadio (a big wardrobe) il grande esodo (the great exodus) un grande uomo ~ un grand'uomo (a great man, both are correct) etc. etc. With feminine nouns, the same changes as for masculine ones may sometimes occur, but in many cases the unchanged grande is the only possible form: una grande nazione ~ una gran nazione (a big nation, both correct) la grande avventura (the great adventure) una grande paura ~ una gran paura (a great fear) una grande esperienza (a great experience) and so on. Plurals of both genders behave as singular forms: grandi castelli or (less common) gran castelli grandi uomini or (less common) grand'uomini grandi nazioni or (less common) gran nazioni grandi paure or (less common) gran paure (obviously, when only one singular form is possible, also its plural will have only one form). bello This adjective is slightly more complicated, although its changes only concern masculine gender. Before a consonant, this adjective changes in the same way as the previous one (i.e. it drops two letters), but in this case it is not a free choice, because bello in full would sound unacceptable: un bel gatto (a nice cat) notice: "un bello gatto" is wrong un bel cappotto (a nice coat) un bel lavoro (meaning both a nice job and a good job) un bel cane (a nice dog) etc. etc. When the shortening occurs before a vowel, only one letter is dropped instead of two, and an apostrophe links the adjective to the noun (as it happens when using articles l', dealt with in paragraph 2.4): il bell'orologio (the nice watch) notice: l'orologio - il bell'orologio il bell'uccello (the nice bird) notice: l'uccello - il bell'uccello il bell'esemplare (the nice specimen) notice: l'esemplare - il bell'esemplare and so on. Feminine gender (bella) does not change: una bella casa (a nice house) la bella stagione (the fine season) When the following feminine noun starts with a vowel, the form bell' may be used, although modern language tends to abandon the latter form when the vowel is not an "a": una bella automobile ~ una bell'automobile (a nice car, both are correct) la bella isola or (less common) la bell'isola (the nice island) una bella estate or (less common) una bell'estate (a nice summer) Used with masculine plural nouns, the adjective turns into begli when followed by a vowel, bei when followed by a consonant (this is the same phonetic change which occurs for plural articles i ~ gli, see previous paragraph 2.4):

i begli occhi (the pretty eyes) notice: gli occhi - i begli occhi i begli abiti (the nice clothes) notice: gli abiti - i begli abiti i begli effetti (the nice effects) notice: gli effetti - i begli effetti ...and i bei cani (the nice dogs) bei gioielli (nice jewels) bei capelli (fine hair) etc. etc. No change occurs in feminine plural: le belle vacanze (the nice holidays) le belle arti (the fine arts) le belle melodie (the nice melodies). buono This adjective is much easier: masculine singular always requires the short form buon (without an apostrophe): un buon prezzo (a good price) un buon impiego (a good job) un buon televisore (a good TV set) etc. etc.. Feminine singular has no special change: una buona marca (a good brand) una buona giornata (a good ~ fine day) una buona cena (a good dinner) and so on. Plurals never change: i buoni amici (the good friends) buone maniere (good manners) buoni strumenti (good instruments) buone notizie (good news, notice how in Italian this noun is plural) etc. etc.

Summarizing these irregular adjectives for an easier memorization: (in brackets are less usual forms, or forms which do not exist for all nouns) masculine feminine masculine following noun singular singular plural starts with...

feminine plural

vowel consonant

grande (grand') grande (gran)

grande (grand') grande (gran)

grandi (grand') grandi (gran)

grandi (grand') grandi (gran)

vowel consonant

bell' bel

bella (bell') bella

begli bei

belle belle

vowel consonant

buon buon

buona buona

buoni buoni

buone buone

Obviously, when these adjectives are used after the noun, no changes occur and standard inflections are used: gran castello, but castello grande bell'uomo, but uomo bello buon prezzo, but prezzo buono. Whatever form you use, remember to make a correct match between the adjective's gender and number, and those of the noun it relates to: a masculine plural noun always requires a masculine plural adjective, a

singular feminine noun always needs a feminine singular adjective, and so on. COMBINING ARTICLES WITH NOUN-ADJECTIVE AND ADJECTIVE-NOUN

When an article occurs before either an adjective-noun (a-n) or a noun-adjective (n-a) combination, it will obviously match the same gender and number of the word coming next, and it will also have to match with it phonetically: (the article matches il grande oceano (a-n, masculine) the great ocean grande) (the article matches l'oceano grande (n-a) the great ocean oceano) l'unica scelta (a-n, feminine) the only choice (the article matches unica) la scelta unica (n-a) the only choice (the article matches scelta) (the article matches i piccoli uccelli (a-n, masculine) the small birds piccoli) (the article matches gli uccelli piccoli (n-a) the small birds uccelli) (the article matches una buona occasione (a-n, a good masculine) buona) opportunity (the article matches a good un'occasione buona (n-a) occasione) opportunity uno stupido incidente (a-n, (the article matches a stupid accident masculine) stupido) (the article matches un incidente stupido (n-a) a stupid accident incidente) When using indefinite articles before an adjective, beware of a typical mistake which should be avoided: the use of an apostrophe where it is not needed. Focus the following examples: un incredibile evento = an incredible event un ultimo tentativo = a last try un amaro ricordo = a bitter memory un'incredibile notizia = an incredible news un'ultima risposta = a last answer un'amara bevanda = a bitter drink In the first three sentences the noun is masculine, so un does not require an apostrophe (un evento, un incredibile evento, or un tentativo, un ultimo tentativo). In the second three sentences the noun is feminine, so una is shortened in un' which does require an apostrophe (una notizia, but un'incredibile notizia), since for phonetic reasons una drops the last a before words starting with a vowel. It's quite common for beginners to make an incorrect use of the apostrophe (i.e. "un'incredibile evento", or so), especially when the adjective has the same inflection "-e" both for masculine and for feminine, as in the afore-said example. So always take care in using (or not using) the apostrophe according on the gender of the following noun, disregarding the adjective. These patterns are not easy to master at once, so it is better to practice them throughoutly from time to time.

3.1 CARDINAL & DECIMAL NUMBERS Cardinal numerals (1, 2, 3... etc.) are used for mathematics or for stating quantities. The name of Italian ones works in the following way: • 1 to 10 have a specific name, • 11 to 16 follow a semi-standard pattern (more or less like English ...-teen), • 17 to 19 have a different semi-standard pattern; • all the others can be obtained with a fully standard pattern. The following tables show also English sounds. 0 to 10 zero (but also nill, o, etc...) zero dzehroh uno wnoh one due dweh two tre treh three quattro quah'ttroh four cinque chinqueh five sei sehy six sette seh'tteh seven otto oh'ttoh eight nove nohveh nine dieci dyehchih ten Numbers do not change inflection for different genders, except uno, which actually behaves as the same indefinite article (see paragraph 2.4), and therefore when followed by a matching noun changes as follows: one (as a digit) uno uno scopo, un cane, un occhio one purpose (= a purpose), one dog (= a dog), one eye (= an eye) una scatola, una chiave, un'oca one box (= a box), one key (= a key), one goose (= a goose)

But any other number is irrespective of gender (the noun will obviously be plural): un albero, tre alberi (masculine) una casa, tre case (feminine) un cane, otto cani (masculine) una chiave, otto chiavi (feminine)

one tree, three trees one house, three houses one dog, eight dogs eight keys

In written Italian, it is usually more correct to spell small numbers by their names when they state a quantity: "there were five ships" would be better than "there were 5 ships". When using articles, the numeral acts like a plural adjective in the "adjective-noun" pattern: gli alberi - i tre alberi le case - le tre case i cani - gli otto cani

(gli matches alberi, while i matches the trees - the three trees tre) the houses - the three (le matches both case and tre) houses (i matches cani, while gli matches the dogs - the eight dogs otto)

le chiavi - le otto chiavi

(le matches both chiavi and otto)

the keys - the eight keys

When the numbered noun is single (i.e. "only one"), the adjective unico = only can be used: il gatto (the cat) - un gatto (one cat) - l'unico gatto (the only cat) la strada (the road) - una strada (one road) - l'unica strada (the only road) l'indice (masc., the index) - un indice (one index) - l'unico indice (the only index) (if you don't feel confident with articles, browse again paragraph 2.4) Instead, when numbers are treated as nouns, they are always masculine and singular, because Italian assumes that numero (= number) comes before them, although in most cases it may be omitted. And, as any other noun, also the word numero requires an article: il numero uno or simply l'uno number one il numero due or simply il due number two il numero otto or simply l'otto number eight il numero dieci or simply il dieci number ten As usual, notice how the article phonetically depends on the following word.

undici dodici tredici quattordici quindici sedici diciassette diciotto diciannove

11 to 19 wndychih eleven dohdychih twelve trehdychih thirteen quah'ttohrdychih fourteen fifteen quihndychih sehdychih sixteen dychassehtteh seventeen dychohttoh eighteen dychahnnohveh nineteen

As you see, the first group has a root resembling numbers 1 to 6, followed by the suffix ...dici, a contraction of dieci (ten), with accent falling on the last syllable before the suffix. The last three numbers, instead, have an opposite pattern: a prefix for ten (dicia...) is followed by the digit, though for fonetic reasons something changes in the overall spelling. The stressed syllable is the same as for the corresponding digits. The same rules stated above for 0 to 9 are also valid for these numbers (and for the following ones, as well), therefore: (eleven) undici gli undici cani (masculine) the eleven dogs) le undici case (feminine) the eleven houses il numero undici or simply l'undici (number eleven) diciannove i diciannove cani (masculine) le diciannove case (feminine) il numero diciannove or simply il diciannove

(nineteen) the nineteen dogs) the nineteen houses (number nineteen)

FULL MULTIPLES OF 10 venti vehnty twenty trenta trehntah thirty quaranta quahrahntah forty cinquanta chinquahntah fifty sessanta sehssahntah sixty settanta seh'ttahntah seventy ottanta oh'ttahntah eighty novanta nohvahntah ninety cento chehntoh one hundred So the multiples of ten are not very different from the English ones, as they use a suffix ...anta (but ...enta for thirty) in the same way English uses ...ty. Names of digits slightly change, binding with the suffix. The word cento, instead, actually means hundred (Italian does not require to specify one, as in English). All rules are the same as above: cinquanta i cinquanta cani (masculine) le cinquanta case (feminine) il numero cinquanta or il cinquanta

(fifty) (the fifty dogs) (the fifty houses) (number fifty)

cento i cento cani le cento case il numero cento or il cento

(one hundred) (the one hundred dogs) (the one hundred houses) (number one hundred)

COMPOUND NUMBERS FROM 21 TO 99 To obtain twenty-one, thirty-two, forty-eight, etc., the pattern is similar to English: bind the multiple of 10 to the digit (with no dash). ventuno vehntwnoh twenty-one ventidue vehntydweh twenty-two ventitré vehntytreh twenty-three ventiquattro vehntyquah'ttroh twenty-four venticinque vehntychinqueh twenty-five ventisei vehntysehih twenty-six ventisette vehntyseh'tteh twenty-seven ventotto vehntoh'ttoh twenty-eight ventinove vehntynohveh twenty-nine and the same for other numbers: trentuno trehntwnoh thirty-one trentadue trehntahdweh thirty-two trentatré trehntahtreh thirty-three forty-one quarantuno quahrahntwnoh quarantadue quahrahntahdweh forty-two cinquantuno chinquahntwnoh fifty-one cinquantadue chinquahntahdweh fifty-two Note that the stress always falls on the digit. Two observations: • when digits start with a vowel (uno, otto) the last vowel of the multiple of ten is dropped (ventuno, not "ventiuno"; quarantotto, not "quarantaotto"); etc. • since digit tre is monosyllabic (one syllable), in order to keep the stress on vowel e also in compound numbers, the last vowel is spelled é (with an accent): tre, but ventitré; trentatré; quarantatré; etc.).

FULL MULTIPLES OF 100 Very simple! Just bind each digit to cento: duecento trecento quattrocento cinquecento seicento settecento ottocento novecento mille

dwehchentoh two hundred trehchentoh three hundred quah'ttrohchentoh four hundred chinquehchentoh five hundred sehychentoh six hundred seh'ttehchentoh seven hundred oh'ttohchentoh eight hundred nohvehchentoh nine hundred mylleh one thousand

COMPOUND NUMBERS FROM 100 TO 999 Also cento behaves in the same way as the previous numbers, although in English you would have to use conjunction and (i.e. one hundred and one; three hundred and two; etc.): centouno chentohwnoh one hundred and one centodue chentohdweh one hundred and two centotré chentohtreh one hundred and three centoquattro chentohquah'ttroh one hundred and four centocinque chentohchinqueh one hundred and five centosei chentohsehih one hundred and six centosette chentohseh'tteh one hundred and seven centootto chentohoh'ttoh one hundred and eight centonove chentohnohveh one hundred and nine centodieci chentohdyehchih one hundred and ten Note that this time no elisions are made, therefore cento always remains the same, also before uno and otto. For greater numbers with a cento compound, the pattern is the same: centoundici (one hundred and eleven) centoventitré (one hundred and twenty-three) centocinquantotto (one hundred and fifty-eight) centonovanta (one hundred and ninety) etc. Also multiples work out in the same way: duecentocinque (two hundred and five) trecentodiciassette (three hundred and seventeen) quattrocentosessantasette (four hundred and sixty-seven) cinquecentotrentuno (five hundred and thirty-one) ottocentocinquantaquattro (eight hundred and fifty-four) novenentoottantotto (nine hundred and eighty-eight) etc.

FULL MULTIPLES OF 1,000 Mille is slightly different from the cento concept: it actually means one thousand (not simply thousand): its multiples are therefore made of number + ...mila (suffix for mille), also for numbers greater than 9: duemila dwehmyhlah two thousand tremila trehmyhlah three thousand quattromila quah'ttrohmyhlah four thousand cinquemila chinquehmyhlah five thousand seimila sehymyhlah six thousand settemila seh'ttehmyhlah seven thousand ottomila oh'ttohmyhlah eight thousand novemila nohvehmyhlah nine thousand diecimila dyehchymyhlah ten thousand undicimila wndychihmyhlah eleven thousand thousand dodicimila dohdychihmyhlah twelve thousand ventimila vehntymyhlah twenty thousand ventunomila ventwnohmyhlah twenty-one thousand ventydwehmyhlah ventiduemila twenty-two thousand trentamila trehntahmyhlah thirty thousand quahrahntahmyhlah quarantamila forty thousand centomila chentohmyhlah one hundred thousand centodiecimila chentohdyehchymyhlah one hundred and ten thousand centocinquantamila chentohchinquahntahmyhlah one hundred and fifty thousand duecentomila dwechentohmyhlah two hundred thousand novecentonovantanovemila nohvehchentohnohvantahnohvehmyhlah nine hundred ninety-nine thousand Notice how the stress is always carried by the ...mila suffix.

COMPOUND NUMBERS FROM 1,001 TO 999,999 There is a slight change at this point, as mille and ...mila sometimes need conjunction e (= and), where in English it is usually omitted. Follow these examples: • mille e uno (mylleh eh wnoh) = one thousand one • mille e sette = one thousand seven • mille e trentacinque = one thousand thirty-five • mille e cento = one thousand one hundred • mille e trecento = one thousand three hundred • mille e novecento = one thousand nine hundred BUT... • • • • •

millecentouno = one thousand one hundred and one millecentonove = one thousand one hundred and nine millecentoventotto = one thousand one hundred and twenty-eight millequattrocentonovantasei = one thousand four hundred and ninety-six milleottocentotrentatré = one thousand eight hundred and thirty-three Therefore, as a general rule, conjunction e breaks the word only when mille is followed by numbers smaller than 100, or by full multiples of 100 (duecento, trecento, etc.). The unbroken form is used in all other cases. But in written texts, books, newspapers, etc., such big numbers are uncommon to be spelled with words: "almost two thousand people attended the event" would be more likely than "one thousand nine hundred and eighty-seven people...", or if the right number was required it would often be spelled with numerals: "1987 people". So if you don't become familiar now with these patterns, you can still do well, although you will need to master these numbers for dates (discussed in paragraph 3.4).

NOTE In English, numbers like 1,100; 1,200; 1,300; etc. may either sound one thousand one hundred, one thousand two hundred, etc., or eleven hundred, twelve hundred, etc.: this never happens in Italian, which only uses the first form (mille e cento, mille e duecento, etc.), as the word cento does not support digits greater than nine (novecento).

DECIMAL NUMBERS AND SEPARATORS While English uses a comma ( , ) as a separator for thousands, Italian uses a full stop ( . ). 1,100 (English spelling) becomes 1.000 344,901 (English spelling) becomes 344.901 and so on. Obviously, thousand separators do not affect pronounciation: they are simply used as mere graphic elements.

The comma instead, in Italian virgola, is used as a separator for decimals, whereas in English a dot is normally used: 1.15 (English spelling) becomes 1,15 63.05 (English spelling) becomes 63,05 and so on. In this case, the word virgola is used exactly as English point, so that in the examples above the pronounciation would be: 1,15 = uno virgola quindici (one point fifteen) 63,05 = sessantatré virgola zero cinque (sixty-three point o five) and so on. Fractions, instead, will be discussed in paragraph 3.3.

3.2 ORDINAL NUMBERS As suggested by their name, ordinal numbers (1st, 2nd, 3rd... etc.) are used for indicating orders or ranks. In Italian, they have specific forms from 1 to 10, while all the following ones use one same suffix, so they are quite easy to learn. Unlike cardinal numbers, though, ordinals behave like an adjective, therefore they can have both a masculine and a feminine gender, in both singular and plural forms (all of them are regular). Also in this page English sounds are shown. ORDINAL NUMBERS FROM 1st TO 9th primo pryhmoh first secondo sehkohndoh second terzo tehrtzo third fourth quarto quahrtoh quinto quihntoh fifth sesto sehstoh sixth settimo seh'ttymoh seventh ottavo oh'ttahvoh eighth nono nohnoh ninth decimo dehchimoh tenth As found in most Western languages, the expressions first and second are irregular (i.e. they have no

phonetic relation with their cardinal numbers one and two), in all the others the name of the digit is still recognizable, though slightly changed: tre - terzo, quattro - quarto, cinque - quinto, and so on, while many suffixes change. Used as adjectives, they all follow the most common pattern: primo (masculine singular) primi (masculine plural) prima (feminine singular) prime (feminine plural) secondo (masculine singular) secondi (masculine plural) seconda (feminine singular) seconde (feminine plural) And so on with all the others. Note that there is an adjective derived from uno (one), unico, which means only, in contrast with primo (first). This adjective is regular, although its "...co" ending causes phonetic adjustment: unico wnyhkoh (masculine singular) unica wnyhkah (feminine singular) unici wnyhchyh (masculine plural) uniche wnyhkeh (feminine plural) As in English, ordinals require an article, whose gender and phonetics will match the ordinal itself: il primo = the first (masculine singular); la prima = the first (feminine singular); i primi = the first (masculine singular); le prime = the first (feminine singular); l'ottavo = the eighth (masculine singular); l'ottava = the eighth (feminine singular); gli ottavi = the eighth (masculine plural); le ottave = the eighth (feminine plural); As in English, the article is required both when the ordinal is used as an adjective (i.e. when it is followed by a noun) and when it works as a pronoun (i.e. when it replaces the noun): la prima casa = the first house tu sei il terzo = you are the third il quinto concorrente = the fifth participant l'ottava a destra = the eighth on the right In Italian, primo (especially its plural masculine and feminine) in some cases may also have a meaning of the early.... or the earliest..., referred to time, history, etc.: le prime conquiste = the early (earliest) achievements i primi abitanti = the early (earliest) inhabitants le prime tracce dell'uomo = the early (earliest) traces of man i primi esempi di arte bizantina = the early (earliest) samples of Byzantine art Instead, when quoting the entries of an ordered list, a ranking, etc., the article is dropped (as in English): primo: XXXXX first: XXXXX secondo: YYYYY second: YYYYY terzo: ZZZZZ third: ZZZZZ .... ....

ORDINAL NUMBERS FROM 11th ONWARDS

From 11th onwards, you only need to add suffix ...esimo, and to drop the cardinal number's last vowel (except when the last digit is ...tre = ...three): undicesimo wndychehsyhmo eleventh dodicesimo dohdychehsyhmoh twelfth tredicesimo trehdychehsyhmoh thirteenth quattordicesimo quah'ttohrdychehsyhmoh fourteenth ventesimo vehntehsyhmoh twentieth ventunesimo vehntuhnehsyhmoh twenty-first ventiduesimo vehntydwehsyhmoh twenty-second ventitreesimo vehntytrehehsyhmoh twenty-second trentesimo trehntehsyhmoh thirtieth trentunesimo trehntwhnehsyhmoh twenty-first trentaduesimo trehntahdwehsyhmoh twenty-second trentatreesimo trehntahtrehehsyhmoh twenty-second quarantesimo quahrantehsyhmoh fortieth centesimo chentehsyhmoh one hundredth duecentesimo dwechentehsyhmoh two hundredth millesimo myllehsyhmoh one thousandth

The modern way to indicate ordinal numbers is to add their last vowel to the number, in "superscript" style: 1o (primo) or 1a (prima) 9o (nono) or 9a (nona) 17o (diciassettesimo) or 17a (diciassettesima) etc. etc... Just like adjectives, they can also have the plural form: 8i (ottavi) or 8e (ottave) 22i (ventiduesimi) or 22e (ventiduesime) etc. etc... Eventually, a circumflex accent (^) may replace any of the superscript vowels: 1^ = 1o, 1a, 1i, 1e 25^ = 25o, 25a, 25i, 25e 130^ = 130o, 130a, 130i, 130e etc. etc. The more classic way to indicate an ordinal number in Italian is to use roman numbers: I = 1o (primo) or 1a (prima) IX = 9o (nono) or 9a (nona) XVII = 17o (diciassettesimo) or 17a (diciassettesima) etc. etc... When a roman number occurs in an Italian text, it should always be looked at as an ordinal number, unless it belongs to a date. If you don't feel too confident with these numbers, appendix 1 will show you how they work. Adding a superscript vowel to roman numbers (i.e. IIIo, Va, etc.) is considered incorrect: since they already act as ordinal numbers, the vowel would be redundant. Roman numbers are now still used to indicate volumes, chapters, monarchs, centuries, and very few more categories. However, for some of the aforesaid ones (centuries, rulers) the use of Western numbers would not be considered very elegant. In common speech, ordinal numbers are used according to the "adjective-noun" pattern, i.e. they are always followed by the classified noun, never vice-versa:

il primo giorno (the first day) le seconde case (the second houses) la ventesima volta (the twentieth time) etc. Instead, when a roman number is used, the ordinal number usually follows the noun: • when they are used to indicate a monarch, a pope, or other rulers, they are mentioned as in English, but omitting article the: Leone IV (read as Leone quarto) = Leo IV, (in English, Leo the fourth) Carlo VIII (Carlo ottavo) = Charles VIII (in English, Charles the eighth). • When indicating a book's chapter or volume, a play's act, etc.: volume III (volume terzo), capitolo XIII (capitolo tredicesimo) = third volume, thirteenth chapter atto II (atto secondo) = second act. In these cases both forms are accepted, so also terzo volume, secondo atto, etc., would be correct if spelled with letters (but not with roman numbers). • When indicating a century (also in this case both forms are correct): secolo XVII (secolo diciassettesimo) or XVII secolo(diciassettesimo secolo) = seventeenth century.

NOTE As already said, ordinals greater than 10th do not use the same suffix as the smaller ones, having simplified the inflection to ...esimo or ...esima. In old-style Italian, instead, all ordinals used to follow the pattern decimo primo (instead of undicesimo), decimo secondo (instead of dodicesimo), etc., also for larger numbers (ventesimo quinto instead of venticinquesimo, settantesimo nono instead of settantanovesimo, etc.), thus keeping the original suffixes of the first nine digits; today this form is very rarely used, and sounds quite archaic.

3.3 FRACTIONS AND

ROUGH QUANTITIES FRACTIONS In Italian, fractions work exactly as in English: the first number is expressed as a cardinal number, the second one as an ordinal. 2 /3 = due terzi = two thirds 1

/7 = un settimo = one seventh

5

/8 = cinque ottavi = five eighths

12

/45 = dodici quarantacinquesimi = twelve forty-fifths Number 1 always has the 'short' form un, according to the general phonetic rules of uno, either as a number or as an indefinite article: 1 /3 = un terzo = one third 1

1

/10 = un decimo = one tenth

/90 = un novantesimo = one ninetieth Fractions whose denominator is 2 read this number as mezzo (half) or mezzi (halves).

1

/2 = un mezzo, or simply mezzo = one half, or half

4

/2 = quattro mezzi = four halves

5

/8 = cinque ottavi = five eighths

12

/45 = dodici quarantacinquesimi = twelve forty-fifths

When a fraction is used to state a quantity, the noun to which it refers is introduced by preposition di (of): due quinti di alcool = two fifths of alcohol cinque ottavi di pollice = five eighths of an inch notice how Italian does not use an indefinite article before inch, nor before any other measure tre quarti di litro = three fourths of a liter cinquanta centesimi di dollaro = fifty hundredths of a dollar (actually: fifty cents) This last example shows how the word centesimi (hundredths) is also used for cents, to indicate small change of any decimal system currency. When the object of the fraction is introduced by a definite article (two thirds of the members, etc.), a compound preposition made of di + article will have to be used, instead of di alone. The following samples show the use of both the simple preposition di and of its compound form; although you may disregard the latter now, simply note the difference with the first two. Compound prepositions will be dealt with in paragraph 5.2. Ordinal numbers always have the masculine form, also when the numbered object is feminine: un quarto di torta = one fourth of cake un quarto di questa torta = one fourth of this cake un quarto della torta = one fourth of the cake tre quinti di zucchero = three fifths of sugar tre quinti di questo zucchero = three fifths of this sugar tre quinti dello zucchero = three fifths of the sugar

ROUGH QUANTITIES Besides the common use of una dozzina di... (a dozen...), meaning twelve of something, in Italian the following expressions referring to rough quantities are commonly used: una decina = about ten una ventina = about twenty una trentina = about thirty una quarantina = about forty una cinquantina = about fifty una sessantina = about sixty una settantina = about seventy una ottantina = about eighty una novantina = about ninety As for the word dozzina, these quantities are treated as nouns (i.e. not as pure numbers), therefore they require an article, and are followed by the simple preposition di (of), which refers to the counted objects. So, for instance: una decina di bottoni = about ten buttons una quarantina di minuti = about forty minutes un'ottantina di soldati = about eighty soldiers The noun decina may be combined with exact numbers, to obtain alternative forms: due decine = una ventina = about twenty tre decine = una trentina = about thirty quattro decine = una quarantina = about forty

and so on, up to nove decine = una novantina = about ninety All the others (ventina, trentina, etc.) are never numbered, i.e. they are always used in the form una ventina, una trentina, etc. Also una cinquina (about five) and una quindicina (about fifteen) are quite common, although they tend to be rather colloquial. Other nouns for rough quantities are: un centinaio (masculine) = about one hundred plural centinaia (feminine) = hundreds un migliaio (masculine) = about one thousand plural migliaia (feminine) = thousands These two are not really "rough", as their literal meaning is hundred and thousand, but since for counting (see again paragraph 3.1) their equivalent suffixes ...-cento and ...-mila are normally used, centinaio and migliaio often carry a meaning of approximately 100 and approximately 1.000. cento scatole = one hundred boxes un centinaio di scatole = some one hundred boxes trecentocinque mattoni = three hundred and five bricks tre centinaia di mattoni = some three hundred bricks novecentocinquanta frammenti = nine hundred and fifty fragments un migliaio di frammenti = some one thousand fragments tremilasettantotto spettatori = three thousand and seventy-eight spectators tre migliaia di spettatori = some three thousand spectators An exact number may be turned into a rough amount also by using circa and all'incirca, which mean about, approximately, some. cento scatole = one hundred boxes circa cento scatole = about one hundred boxes trecentocinque mattoni = three hundred and five bricks circa trecento mattoni = approximately three hundred bricks novecentocinquanta frammenti = nine hundred and fifty fragments circa un migliaio di frammenti = some one thousand fragments tremilasettantotto spettatori = three thousand and seventy-eight spectators circa tre migliaia di spettatori = about three thousand spectators The use of circa or all'incirca does not automatically exclude the use of decine, centinaia, migliaia, ecc. circa quaranta minuti = about forty minutes una quarantina di minuti = (same as above) circa una quarantina di minuti = (same as above) all'incirca trecento mattoni = approximately three hundred bricks tre centinaia di mattoni = (same as above) all'incirca tre centinaia di mattoni = (same as above) all'incirca mille frammenti = some one thousand fragments un migliaio di frammenti = (same as above) circa un migliaio di frammenti = (same as above) Also indefinite adjectives such as qualche (some), poche (a few), diverse (several), etc. may combine with decine, centinaia and migliaia:

poche decine di minuti = literally: a few tens of minutes (i.e. 40 min.-50 min., or so) qualche centinaio di membri = a few hundred members diverse migliaia di metri = several thousand metres Note that qualche is singular, and can only combine with singular nouns, thus qualche centinaio, qualche migliaio (masculine). Instead poche is already plural, therefore it has to be poche centinaia, poche migliaia (both feminine). It is also possible to combine two rough quantities: due decine di migliaia di abitanti = some twenty thousand inhabitants (literally: two tens of thousands) poche centinaia di migliaia di cellule = a few hundred thousand cells

In the same way also paio (pair), besides its "standard" meaning of two of something, two-piece set, is also commonly used for "slightly more than one" (a couple of, a few, a little, two or three, etc.). entro un paio di giorni = within a couple of days - within a few days un paio di consigli = a couple of tips - a few tips fra un paio d'anni = in a couple of years time - in a few years time Paio (masculine), whose plural is paia (feminine), is never numbered, unless wishing to express the actual meaning of "pair", "a set of two": due paia di scarpe = two pairs of shoes sei paia di guanti = six pairs of gloves circa dieci paia di pantaloni = some ten pairs of trousers una quindicina di paia di occhiali = about fifteen pairs of glasses

4.1 PERSONAL PRONOUNS USED AS SUBJECTS In chapter 4 we will start discussing verbs, but in order to build actual sentences with them it is better to introduce personal pronouns first. Since in Italian these pronouns have two forms, one when they are used as subjects and one when they are used for any other part of the sentence (as direct object, in genitive case, in dative case, etc.), only the former case will be dealt with by this paragraph. singular plural 1st person io I noi we 2nd you tu voi you (plural) person (singular) egli he they (masculine + essi ella she 3rd person neutre) it (masculine) esse esso they (feminine) it (feminine) essa Personal pronouns are the only part of the sentence in which Italian makes a distinction between masculine/feminine and neutre. Neutre gender is used for objects, plants and animals except man; but this distinction does not cause any important change, because all other parts of the sentence (nouns, verb inflections, adjectives, etc.) do not have a neutre gender, which is simply handled by using either masculine or feminine. So you only need to be aware of neutre gender when using singular personal pronouns as a subject of the sentence. Before turning the page, be sure to memorize them well.

4.2 INDICATIVE TENSES OF ITALIAN VERBS The Italian word for tense is tempo, which also means time, suggesting that tenses are inflections which show whether actions are carried out in the present, in the past, or in the future. As in most western languages, also Italian verbs are indicated with their infinitive tense, called tempo infinito or simply infinito (omitting the word for tense). According to the infinitive tense, verbs can be divided into three main groups, called coniugazioni (= conjugations): 1. verbs ending with ...are, like andare (to go), mangiare (to eat), camminare (to walk) 2. verbs ending with ...ere, like avere (to have), vedere (to see), essere (to be), decidere (to decide) 3. verbs ending with ...ire, like dormire (to sleep), venire (to come), coprire (to cover) In conjugations 1 and 3, the infinitive tense of all verbs carries its accent on the penultimate syllable, thus stressing the verb's inflection (in the following examples, the stressed syllable is shown in italics style and in lighter blue colour): andare (1st), mangiare (1st), dormire (3rd), venire (3rd), etc. But in the 2nd conjugation (...ere), stress may sometimes fall on the antepenultimate syllable (i.e. one syllable before the infinitive's inflection), so this conjugation may be split into two further groups: • verbs whose penultimate syllable carries the stress (as in conjugations 1 and 3): avere, vedere, etc. • verbs whose stress is carried by an earlier syllable, as essere, decidere, etc.

INDICATIVO (INDICATIVE) Indicative is the group of tenses used more often, especially at an early stage. Since some of the tenses do not exactly match English ones, their literal meaning will be stated in this page, but in further pages they will be referred to with their Italian name. simple tenses • PRESENTE (= literally present tense), translating English present tense: "I go", "you go", etc.; • IMPERFETTO (= literally imperfect tense), translating English simple past tense "I went", "you went", etc., expressing an action which was still in progress by the time the sentence refers to, or was habitual (the use of this tense will be later explained more in detail). • FUTURO (= literally future tense), translating English future tense, "I shall go"; • PASSATO REMOTO (= literally remote past tense), translating English simple past tense "I went", expressing an action which happened quite a long time ago, and has already ended by the time the sentence refers to. This tense almost acts in opposition to imperfect tense, by which the past action has not ended by the time of the sentence (further details will be discussed later on). compound tenses (made by an auxiliary verb + the main verb's past participle) • PASSATO PROSSIMO (= literally recent past tense), translating the English present perfect "I have gone", and often also English simple past tense "I went"; it expresses actions which have taken place a short time ago. • TRAPASSATO PROSSIMO (= recent pluperfect tense), matching English past perfect "I had gone"; it expresses actions which have taken place a long time ago. • TRAPASSATO REMOTO (= remote pluperfect tense), translating the same English past perfect "I had gone", but with a much more limited use: the action described is no longer in progress, and it is followed by another action expressed by simple past tense (i.e. "when he had gone, you came"); • FUTURO ANTERIORE (= literally forward future), also known as future perfect, expressing an action which will have taken place in a future time: in English, this tense is not specific, but the matching form may be obtained all the same: "you will have gone", "they will have arrived", etc. In Italian, this same tense may also translate uncertainty, as if the action was not sure, or only had chance to be true: "it might have been him", "he might have arrived". In the following paragraphs, all these concept will be fully discussed again.

Summarizing again these tenses in a chronological order: FUTURE ACTIONS are translated by: futuro = English future tense: the action will happen in the future futuro anteriore = English future perfect: in the future, the given action will have happened; but it can also express possibility: the action might have happened (now). PRESENT ACTIONS are translated by: presente = English present tense: the action happens now PAST ACTIONS are translated by: passato prossimo = English present perfect: the action has happened a short time ago and is now over imperfetto = English simple past: the action happened in the past, and was either habitual or was in progress passato remoto = English simple past: the action happened a long time ago, and is now over trapassato prossimo = English past pefect: the action had happened in a further past trapassato remoto = English past perfect: the action had happened, and then something else happened afterwards

Inflections of regular verbs follow a standard pattern, but there are many irregular verbs too, most of which are important ones, as the verb essere (to be) and avere (to have), which will be the first ones discussed in the following paragraphs, because they are also used as auxiliary verbs for all others. Nevertheless, when two irregular verbs have similar stems, they often have similar inflections too.

COMPOUND TENSES These tenses (I have seen, you have heard, he had wrote, they had come, etc.) are very similar to the English ones, as they need an auxiliary verb in simple tense, followed by the main verb's past participle. Two auxiliary verbs are used in Italian: avere (to have), used for all transitive verbs and a few intransitive ones, and essere (to be), used for most intransitive verbs. The same auxiliary essere is also used for passive forms. English uses auxiliary verbs in a rather different way: the verb to have is always used for compound tenses, both for transitive and intransitive verbs ("I have gone", "it had rained", "we had returned", etc.); verb to be is always used for passive forms ("I am helped", "you were defeated", etc.). Interrogative and negative sentences, instead, use the auxiliary verbs to do and to have ("do you go...?", "have you gone...?", "I do not go"). To become confident with the construction of Italian compound tenses you should focus well the simple pattern mentioned above and summarized by the following lines: • transitive verbs form compound tenses by using avere + past participle of the main verb • most intransitive verbs use essere + past participle of the main verb • a few intransitive verbs use avere + past participle of the main verb, as transitive ones

4.3 THE VERB ESSERE PART I

SIMPLE INDICATIVE TENSES The Italian verb essere (to be) is strongly irregular but also very important, because it is one of the two auxiliary verbs used in forming compound tenses with all other verbs. Furthermore, essere is also used for nominal sentences, i.e. the ones in which to be is followed by an adjective or by a noun, thus forming a copula (or nominal predicate). For instance I am old; this is plastic; they were nice; we were lazy etc., in which to be expresses a condition, a quality, not a direct object which receives a real action. Therefore, before discussing regular verbs, it is important for the student to become confident with the verb essere.

1st person 2nd person 3rd person

PRESENTE singular (io) sono I am you are (singular) (tu) sei (egli / ella) è he/she/it is

plural (noi) siamo we are you are (plural) (voi) siete (essi / esse) sono they are

A first important thing to remember is that in spoken Italian the verbs are not necessarily introduced by a personal pronoun, as they are in English, because the different persons (singular and plural) have a specific inflection for each of them, with very few exceptions. So, when the subject of a sentence is a personal pronoun, in spoken language it is frequently omitted, while in written language it is often more correct to mention it. This page, as well as the following ones, will show personal pronouns in brackets: it is useful for the student to practice them, yet remembering that their use is not compulsory in everyday's speech. Without a pronoun, the sentence might look as if it had no subject, because in English it is always mentioned; but in Italian the specific inflection of the verb is enough to understand who carries out the

action, i.e. who is the subject of the sentence. In the case of the present tense, only inflection sono refers to two persons, 1st singular and 3rd plural, and could be mistaken. But also in this case, there is no need to use a pronoun when the other parts of the sentence make it clear to whom sono refers: (io) sono alto = I am tall (alto is singular, therefore sono can only be 1st singular person) (essi) sono giovani = they are young (giovani is plural, therefore sono is 3rd plural person) Another example: (io) sono brava = I am clever (feminine) (esse) sono brave = they are clever (feminine) When the remaining part of the sentence does not make clear who the subject is, a pronoun is used to avoid any doubt: sono a letto = either I am in bed or they are in bed io sono a letto = I am in bed essi sono a letto = I am in bed But sometimes the subject has already been mentioned, in which case the pronoun may be dropped again: dove sei? sono a letto = where are you? I am in bed dove sono i bambini? sono a letto = where are the kids? they are in bed

Pronouns, though, may be used on purpose to give the sentence a certain emphasis, or to show a contrast. Focus this case: sei un uomo = you are a man tu sei un uomo = you are a man The second sentence may carry a meaning of you are a man, not me, nor her, giving a certain stress to "you". Also when the sentence expresses a contrast, personal pronouns may be used for the same reason explained above: io sono un uomo e tu sei una donna = I am a man and you are a woman noi siamo veloci, voi siete lenti = we are fast, you are slow But if no emphasis is required, the spoken language often omits the pronoun, and sometimes the written language too does: sono magro (alternatively, io sono magro) = I am thin sei un uomo (alternatively, tu sei un uomo) = you are a man siete ragazzi (alternatively, voi siete ragazzi) = you are boys è un vecchio libro (alternatively, esso è un vecchio libro) = it's an old book è una brava insegnante (alternatively, ella è una brava insegnante) = she is a good teacher sono vecchie (alternatively, esse sono vecchie) = they are old (feminine) So, there is no need to worry about the choice of pronouns, unless you wish to use them for practice or to emphasize the pronoun itself. When the latter is used, it has to match the verb by gender and number. Plural forms will obviously be told by the same verb inflection: (tu) sei alto = you are tall (masculine) (voi) siete alti = you are tall (plural) (io) sono giovane = I am young (noi) siamo giovani = we are young

IMPERFETTO singular 1st person 2nd person 3rd person

(io) ero

I was

(tu) eri

you were (singular)

(egli / ella) he/she/it was era

plural (noi) eravamo

we were

(voi) eravate

you were (plural)

(essi / esse) erano

they were

Accent falls on the penultimate syllable of each of them, except for erano, whose stressed syllable is the antipenultimate (pronounced "ehrahnoh"). Imperfect tense is usually translated with English simple past, although it expresses the concept of an action carried out in the past which has not necessarily come to an end. In many cases, the English form "I used to be" could be used instead of "I was"; since Italian has no such form, you may translate imperfect tense with both English forms: ero bravo = I was clever or I used to be clever (the fact of being clever is a condition lasting throughout the time the sentence refers to) era un cattivo studente = he/she was a bad student or he/she used to be a bad student (again, a condition, with no definite end) erano quattro uomini = they were four men (again, a condition lasting throughout the period which the sentence refers to, although the form "they used to be..." would not be proper in this case)

FUTURO singular 1st person 2nd person 3rd person

(io) sarò

plural I shall be

you will be (singular) (egli / ella) he/she/it will sarà be

(tu) sarai

(noi) saremo we shall be (voi) sarete

you will be (plural)

(essi / esse) saranno

they will be

All accents fall on the penultimate syllable of each inflection, except sarò and sarà which have an accent on the last syllable (pronounced "sahroh", "sahrah"). In a few cases, Italian future tense might have a meaning of probability, or chance: for example, if the phone rings, the expression sarà Carlo translates the English form it might be Charles.

PASSATO REMOTO singular 1st person 2nd person 3rd person

plural

(io) fui

I was

(noi) fummo we were

(tu) fosti

you were (singular)

(voi) foste

you were (plural)

(essi / esse) furono

they were

(egli / ella) he/she/it was fu

Accents fall on penultimate syllables, except in fu (only one syllable), obviously carrying stress, and furono, where the antipenultimate syllable is stressed (pronounced "fwrohnoh"). Notice that fu does not have an accented u because there is no other way of pronouncing the word. This tense expresses the fact that the action has ended time ago, and is no longer in progress: fu un brutto incidente = it was a bad accident (the fact happened long ago, and it is now over) fu un grande musicista = he was a great musician (in the past, meaning "...now he is dead") furono bravi a vincere = they were clever to win (on that specific occasion, not as a lasting condition).

4.4 THE VERB AVERE PART I

SIMPLE INDICATIVE TENSES Avere (to have) is another auxiliary verb used in compound tenses, therefore it is as much important as the previous one. It is irregular, but less than essere. PRESENTE singular plural 1st (noi) (io) ho I have we have person abbiamo 2nd you have you have (voi) avete (tu) hai (singular) (plural) person 3rd (essi / esse) (egli / ella) they have he/she/it has person hanno ha Two considerations: • accent falls on the penultimate syllable, except in those inflections which only have one, ho, hai, and ha, which sound like "oh" "ahyh" and "ah", spelled without an accented vocal on the last letter because no other accent would be possible (as in simple past inflection fu, see paragraph 4.3); • a second note is about the spelling of inflections starting with an h: in Italian, this consonant is absolutely soundless, so read the word as if the h was not there. The reason for which h is added is that similar words (without an h) exist: ai = to the (pronounced exactly like hai = you have); a = to or for (pronounced exactly like ha = he/she/it has); anno = year (pronounced exactly like hanno = they have); etc. So the consonant is merely graphic, to indicate the verb's inflections. ha una bella casa = he or she has a nice home hanno due gatti = they have two cats tu hai un gatto, ma io ho un cane = you have a cat, but I have a dog (notice the use of pronouns for stressing the opposition)

IMPERFETTO singular 1st person 2nd person 3rd person

plural

(io) avevo

I had

(noi) avevamo we had

(tu) avevi

you had (singular)

(voi) avevate

you had (plural)

(egli / ella) aveva

he/she/it had

(essi / esse) avevano

they had

As for the same tense of the verb essere, accent falls on the penultimate syllable of each of them, except for avevano, whose stressed syllable is the antepenultimate (pronounced "ahvehvahnoh"). Always remember that the imperfect tense expresses the concept of a past action which has not necessarily come to an end: l'uomo aveva un grosso naso = the man had a big nose (this is a condition, which obviously was lasting for the whole time the sentence refers to) avevo tre automobili = I had three cars or I used to have three cars (probably I do no longer have them now, but nevertheless the expression carries the sense of "some time ago I used to have them", as a continuous condition).

FUTURO singular 1st person 2nd person 3rd person

(io) avrò

plural I shall be

you will be (singular) (egli / ella) he/she/it will avrà be

(tu) avrai

(noi) avremo we shall be (voi) avrete

you will be (plural)

(essi / esse) avranno

they will be

Accents fall on the penultimate syllable of each inflection, except avrò and avrà which behave like sarò and sarà (see future tense of essere): although both verbs are irregular, their future tense has the same patterns.

PASSATO REMOTO singular 1st person 2nd person 3rd person

plural (noi) avemmo

(io) ebbi

I was

(tu) avesti

you were (singular)

(egli / ella) he/she/it was ebbe

we were

(voi) aveste

you were (plural)

(essi /esse) ebbero

they were

A tense with very irregular inflections, where all accents fall on penultimate syllables, except in ebbero, whose antepenultimate syllable is stressed (pronounced "eh'bbehroh"). Although the past perfect of the verb essere (discussed in the previous paragraph) has some differences, accents and many of the inflections work in the same way. Remember that this tense expresses ceased actions, no longer active: l'uomo ebbe un incidente = the man had an accident (the accident itself did not last in time) avemmo una grande fortuna = we had a great luck (we were lucky on that occasion) ebbero due figli = they had two sons (in Italian this sounds like "their two sons were born", as a non-lasting action, while the imperfect tense avevano due figli would express the fact that during their lives "they had two sons", as a continuous condition).

4.5 VERBS OF THE 1st CONJUGATION PART I

SIMPLE INDICATIVE TENSES Verbs whose infinitive tense has the inflection ...are, belong to the 1st conjugation. Most verbs belonging to this conjugation are regular. Tenses will be discussed by using the verb parlare (= to speak, to talk). Sample sentences will also use these other few regular verbs: lavorare = to work tirare = to pull cantare = to sing ascoltare = to listen cucinare = to cook comprare = to buy pagare = to pay attaccare = to attack mangiare = to eat fischiare = to whistle pescare = to fish pagare = to pay portare = to carry, to bring sbirciare = to peep strisciare = to creep saltare = to jump cambiare = to change scappare = to escape, to run away Comparing them with the two irregular verbs essere and avere already discussed, you will surely find that

many inflections are similar (but many others are different).

1st person 2nd person 3rd person

PRESENTE singular (io) parlo I talk you talk (singular) (tu) parli (egli / ella) parla he/she/it talks

plural (noi) parliamo we talk you talk (plural) (voi) parlate (essi / esse) parlano they talk

As in all previous verbs, accent falls on the penultimate syllable, except for the 3rd plural person, whose antipenultimate syllable is stressed (pronounced "pahrlahnoh"). parla bene = he or she speaks well tiro una fune = I pull a rope gli uccelli cantano = the birds sing --- PHONETIC CHANGES --When the last letter of the verb's root is c or g, for phonetic reasons the inflections of the 2nd singular person and 1st plural person (...i and ...iamo) need an h : singular plural 1st person (noi) giochiamo we play (io) gioco I play 2nd person you play (singular) you play (plural) (tu) giochi (voi) giocate 3rd person (egli / ella) gioca he/she/it plays (essi / esse) giocano they play note the h in the 2nd singular and the 1st plural persons: it enables consonant c to keep a "hard" or guttural sound (English sound: "johkyh", "johkyahmoh"); without an h, the pronounciation would be "johchyh", "johchahmoh". pago = I pay, paghi = you pay (not pagi), paghiamo = we pay (not pagiamo) attacco = I attack, attacchi = you attack, attacchiamo = we attack When the root of the verb ends with vowel i, the 2nd singular person and the 1st plural person drop this vowel: singular plural 1st person (io) mangio I eat (noi) mangiamo we eat 2nd you eat you eat (tu) mangi (voi) mangiate (singular) (plural) person (egli / essa) (essi / esse) 3rd person he/she/it eats they eat mangia mangiano Note how the root of verb mangiare is mangi..., but the 2nd singular and the 1st plural persons lose the vowel i; sbircio = I peep, sbirci = you peep (not sbircii), sbirciamo = we peep (not sbirciiamo) striscio = I creep, strisci = you creep (not striscii), strisciamo = we creep (not strisciiamo)

IMPERFETTO 1st person 2nd person 3rd person

singular (io) parlavo (tu) parlavi (egli / ella) parlava

I talked you talked (singular) he/she/it talked

plural (noi) parlavamo (voi) parlavate (essi / esse) parlavano

we talked you talked (plural) they talked

Also in this case, all accents falls on the penultimate syllable of each person, except for parlavano, whose stressed syllable is the antipenultimate (pronounced "pahrlahvahnoh"). le tre donne compravano il pane = the three women bought [the] bread (as a continuous action: this could be translated as the three women used to buy bread, not only on that occasion, but usually, often, etc.; also note the use of an article where English omits it) l'uomo portava un pacco = the man carried a parcel (obviously, in this case the man did not usually carry a parcel, but the use of imperfect gives a sense of "the man was carrying the parcel", as a continuous action, almost as to show the man with the parcel still in his hands) ascoltavo la radio = I listened to the radio (again, suggesting a continuous action: this could be translated as "I was listening to the radio", maybe only on that occasion, but as an action in progress; note how in Italian the verb is transitive, and does not require preposition "to")

FUTURO singular 1st person 2nd person 3rd person

plural

(io) parlerò

I shall talk

(noi) parleremo

we shall talk

(tu) parlerai

you will talk (singular)

(voi) parlerete

you will talk (plural)

(egli / ella) parlerà

he/she/it will talk

(essi / esse) parleranno

they will talk

Accent falls on the penultimate syllable of each inflection, except parlerò and parlerà, whose stress is on the last syllable (pronounced "pahrlehroh" and "pahrlehrah"): also the two irregular verbs already discussed have the same pattern. cucineremo una bistecca = we'll cook a steak il cane salterà lo steccato e scapperà = the dog will jump [over] the fence and will run away (in Italian the verb to jump is transitive, and does not require preposition "over") --- PHONETIC CHANGES --When the last consonant of the verb's root is c or g, all future tense inflections needs an h for phonetic reasons: singular plural 1st person (io) giocherò I shall play (noi) giocheremo we shall play you will play you will play 2nd person (tu) giocherai (voi) giocherete (singular) (plural) 3rd person (egli / ella) giocherà he/she/it will play (essi / esse) giocheranno they will play Again, the h gives a "hard" guttural sound (English sound: "johkehroh", "johkehrahyh", etc.); without an h, the pronounciation would be "johchehroh", etc. pagherò = I shall pay attaccherò = I shall attack

Instead, verbs whose last letter of the root is i, drop this vowel when it becomes phonetically redundant: singular plural 1st person (io) mangerò I shall eat (noi) mangeremo we shall eat 2nd person (tu) mangerai you will eat (singular) (voi) mangerete you will eat (plural) 3rd person (egli / ella) mangerà he/she/it will eat (essi / esse) mangeranno they will eat the root of verb mangiare is mangi..., but in future tense inflections is drops the i and becomes mang..., because since these inflections start with vowel e, there is no need to keep vowel i: both mangerò (correct) and mangierò (incorrect) sound like "mahnjehroh", with a palatal sound.

PASSATO REMOTO singular plural 1st person (io) parlai I talked (noi) parlammo we talked 2nd person (tu) parlasti you talked (singular) (voi) parlaste you talked (plural) 3rd person (egli / ella) parlò he/she/it talked (essi / esse) parlarono they talked

The penultimate syllables carry the accent, except in parlò (3rd singular person), sounding as a truncated word (pronounced "pahrloh"), and parlarono (3rd plural person), whose antipenultimate syllable is stressed (pronounced "pahrlahrohnoh"). Be careful not to mistake parlò with parlerò (1st singular person, future tense), and parlarono with parlano (3rd plural person, present tense). Always remember that this tense is used when the past action expressed by the sentence is already over. le tre donne comprarono il pane = the three women bought [the] bread (in comparison with a similar sentence shown for the imperfect tense, here the three women bought bread on a specific occasion, not as a usual action) il cielo cambiò colore = the sky changed colour (the change is an action with very limited duration) tu parlasti, e io ascoltai = You spoke, and I listened (note the use of pronouns to give stress to the different subjects; the sentence refers specifically to one past occasion: should this situation have occured often or usually, imperfect tense would express the fact: io cucinavo e tu mangiavi).

4.6 VERBS OF THE 2nd CONJUGATION PART I

SIMPLE INDICATIVE TENSES Verbs whose infinitive tense has the inflection ...ere, belong to the 2nd conjugation. But, as explained in paragraph 4.2, the accent may fall on the penultimate syllable or on the antepenultimate one. Most verbs in the latter subgroup are regular; despite this, past perfect tense is partially irregular in all cases, but this will be discussed later on. Instead, almost every verb in the first subgroup has peculiarities in one or more tenses, so these ones will be discussed in a further paragraph, at a more advanced stage; only one important verb of this subgroup, vedere (= to see, to watch) is shown in this page, as a comparison with other verbs. As a help for the reader, I will spell the Italian infinitive tense with one accented vowel (the vowel which carries the stress), but remember that this never happens in common spelling. Also take note how vowel e may have an "open" sound ( è ) or a "closed" sound ( é ), according to the verb. Standard inflections will be shown by using the verb chièdere (= to ask for), whose accent falls on the

antepenultimate syllable (pronounced "kyehdehreh"). Other verbs used in sample sentences are: chiùdere = to close muòvere = to move ròmpere = to break risòlvere = to solve prèndere = to take discùtere = to discuss vìncere = to win pèrdere = to lose spìngere = to push pùngere = to prick vedére = to see rìdere = to laugh

còrrere = to run scéndere = to come down, to descend ripètere = to repeat nàscere = to be born tìngere = to dye, to colour piàngere = to cry

PRESENTE 1st person 2nd person 3rd person

singular (io) chiedo I ask you ask (singular) (tu) chiedi (egli / ella) chiede he/she/it asks

plural (noi) chiediamo we ask you ask (plural) (voi) chiedete (essi / esse) chiedono they ask

Accents fall on the same syllable as in present tense of the 1st conjugation (see paragraph 4.5). In order to memorize this tense more easily, concentrate on the following differences with the 1st conjugation: the inflection of 3rd singular person turns from ...a (1st conj.) into ...e (2nd conj.); the 2nd plural person turns from ...ate into ...ete, for the same reason; the 3rd plural person changes from ...ano into ...ono. i turisti chiedono un buon ristorante = the tourists ask [for] a good restaurant (note the shortening of buono into buon, according to the rule discussed in paragraph 2.4) discutiamo un argomento = we discuss a topic tu ridi ma lui piange = you laugh but he cries (note the use of pronouns, to stress the contrast of subjects --- PHONETIC CHANGES --When the last letter of the verb's root is c or g, verbs of the 2nd conjugation behave in a different way from the 1st one: they do NOT add a phonetic h. Therefore, no change occurs in the verb's root: this means that the sound of c or g actually changes from "hard" (guttural) to "soft" (palatal), according to the vowel following this consonant: singular plural 1st person (io) vinco I win (noi) vinciamo we win 2nd person you win (singular) you win (plural) (tu) vinci (voi) vincete 3rd person (egli / ella) vince he/she/it wins (essi / esse) vincono they win the 1st singular person sounds like "vynkoh" ("hard" or guttural c), the 2nd singular like "vynchyh" ("soft" or palatal c), the 3rd singular "vyncheh" ("soft" again), the 1st plural "vynchahmoh" ("soft"), the 2nd plural "vynchehteh" ("soft"), the 3rd plural "vynkohnoh" ("hard"). tingo ("tyngoh") = I dye, tingi ("tynjyh") = you dye, etc. spingo ("spyngoh") = I push, spingi ("spynjyh") = you push, etc. piango ("pyahngoh") = I cry, piangi ("pyahnjyh") = you cry, etc. nasco ("nahskoh") = I am born, nasci ("nahshyh") = you are born, etc.

IMPERFETTO singular plural 1st person (io) chiedevo I asked (noi) chiedevamo we asked 2nd person (tu) chiedevi you asked (singular) (voi) chiedevate you asked (plural) 3rd person (egli / ella) chiedeva he/she asked (essi / esse) chiedevano they asked

Compared to the 1st conjugation, the first vowel of all inflections is e. The accents, instead, are the same. chiedevano sempre aiuto = they always asked [for] help (continuous action, as also suggested by "always") vendevamo tappeti = we sold carpets or we used to sell carpets (as an activity, therefore a lasting action) prendeva l'autobus = he / she took the bus (as a customary action)

FUTURO singular plural 1st person (io) chiederò I shall ask (noi) chiederemo we shall ask 2nd person (tu) chiederai you will ask (sing.) (voi) chiederete you will ask (pl.) 3rd person (egli / ella) chiederà he/she will ask (essi / esse) chiederanno they will ask

Both accent and inflections are the same as in 1st conjugation. chiederemo un'informazione = we shall ask [for] an information (note the apostrophe in article un', because the gender of informazione is feminine) l'atleta correrà la maratona = the athlete will run the marathon As mentioned in the introduction, verb vedére (accent on the penultimate syllable) has a slightly different inflection for future tense, losing the first e: singular plural 1st person (io) vedrò I shall see (noi) vedremo we shall see you will see (plural) 2nd person (tu) vedrai you will see (singular) (voi) vedrete 3rd person (egli / ella) vedrà he/she will see (essi / esse) vedranno they will see This is not a standard change, so other verbs of the same subgroup do not follow this pattern.

PASSATO REMOTO

This tense is always partially irregular: changes do not occur in inflections, but in the roots of 1st singular, 3rd singular and 3rd plural persons: singular plural 1st person (io) chiesi I talked (noi) chiedemmo we talked 2nd person (tu) chiedesti you talked (singular) (voi) chiedeste you talked (plural) 3rd person (egli / ella) chiese he/she/it talked (essi / esse) chiesero they talked

The first evident difference is the change of root; as a general rule, 1st and 3rd singular and 3rd plural persons have a different root than the others (which keep the original one); obviously, the new root is the same for all three persons. In this case, the normal root chied... has turned into chies..., and for many other verbs the change is similar: the last consonant turns into s. But for some verbs the change is more consistant (past perfect might be a nightmare for beginners, and a real test for well-taught Italian speakers). This is why, in common speech, many Italians too often prefer to use the present perfect tense (a compound tense, discussed in a further paragraph) instead of past perfect, although this choice would be considered slightly incorrect.

The second important difference with the same tense of the 1st conjugation is that no inflections have an accent on the last syllable (no one ends with an accented vowel). Despite the change of root, though, all inflections are regular and do not change. This is an example of how other verbs behave, according to the "simple" rule: chiudere (to close) singular plural 1st person (io) chiusi I closed (noi) chiudemmo we closed 2nd person (tu) chiudesti you closed (singular) (voi) chiudeste you closed (plural) 3rd person (egli / ella) chiuse he/she/it closed (essi / esse) chiusero they closed

risolvere (to solve) singular plural 1st person (io) risolsi I solved (noi) risolvemmo we solved 2nd person (tu) risolvesti you solved (singular) (voi) risolveste you solved (plural) 3rd person (egli / ella) risolse he/she/it solved (essi / esse) risolsero they solved

spingere (to see) singular plural 1st person (io) spinsi I pushed (noi) spingemmo we pushed 2nd person (tu) spingesti you pushed (singular) (voi) spingeste you pushed (plural) 3rd person (egli / ella) spinse he/she/it pushed (essi / esse) spinsero they pushed ridere (to laugh) singular plural 1st person (io) risi I laughed (noi) ridemmo we laughed you laughed (plural) 2nd person (tu) ridesti you laughed (singular) (voi) rideste 3rd person (egli / ella) rise he/she laughed (essi / esse) risero they laughed But here are some others whose root changes more evidently: prendere (to take) singular plural 1st person (io) presi I took (noi) prendemmo we took 2nd person (tu) prendesti you took (singular) (voi) prendeste you took (plural) 3rd person (egli / ella) prese he/she/it took (essi / esse) presero they took vedere (to see) 1st person 2nd person 3rd person

singular (io) vidi I saw you saw (singular) (tu) vedesti (egli / ella) vide he/she/it saw

plural (noi) vedemmo we saw you saw (plural) (voi) vedeste (essi / esse) videro they saw

rompere (to break) singular plural 1st person (io) ruppi I broke (noi) rompemmo we broke 2nd person (tu) rompesti you broke (singular) (voi) rompeste you broke (plural) 3rd person (egli / ella) ruppe he/she/it broke (essi / esse) ruppero they broke

muovere (to move) singular plural 1st person (io) mossi I moved (noi) muovemmo we moved 2nd person (tu) muovesti you moved (singular) (voi) muoveste you moved (plural) 3rd person (egli / ella) mosse he/she/it moved (essi / esse) mossero they moved nascere (to be born) singular plural 1st person (io) nacqui I was born (noi) nascemmo we were born 2nd person (tu) nascesti you were born (singular) (voi) nasceste you were born (plural) 3rd person (egli/ella) nacque he/she/it was born (essi / esse) nacquero they were born

chiusi la porta = I closed the door (the action is over) vedesti un grosso animale = you saw a big animal due uomini scesero le scale = two men came down the steps (they did so on this occasion; had the sentence been "usually, they came down the steps", the imperfect tense would have been used: ...scendevano le scale)

4.7 VERBS OF THE 3rd CONJUGATION PART I

SIMPLE INDICATIVE TENSES Verbs whose infinitive tense has the inflection ...ire, belong to the 3rd conjugation. This is the conjugation with the least umber of verbs, and most of them are regular. Verb capire (= to understand) is used to discuss the tenses; others used in sample sentences are: agire = to act proibire = to forbid finire = to finish sparire = to disappear fornire = to provide with obbedire = to obey garantire = to grant reagire = to react punire = to punish seguire = to follow partire = to leave sentire = to feel scoprire = to discover fuggire = to escape dormire = to sleep aprire = to open cucire = to sew mentire = to lie

PRESENTE Present tense of the 3rd conjugation is slightly more difficult than others because two different inflections may occur, according to the verb: singular plural 1st person (io) capisco I understand (noi) capiamo we understand 2nd person (tu) capisci you understand (sing.) (voi) capite you understand (pl.) 3rd person (egli / ella) capisce he/she/it understands (essi / esse) capiscono they understand This pattern is the most common one, and the first nine verbs listed in the table above use these inflections. Note how the inflection of all singular persons and of the 3rd plural person is longer than in other

conjugations (i.e. there is a cluster "isc.." before the final vowel). This causes a certain difference in pronounciation (see paragraph 1.2): ...isco sounds as "...yskoh", thus capisco sounds as "kahpyskoh" ...isci sounds as "...yshyh", thus capisci sounds as "kahpyshyh" ...isce sounds as "...ysheh", thus capisce sounds as "kahpysheh" ...iscono sounds as "...yskohnoh", thus capiscono sounds as "kahpyskohnoh" Note how the sc cluster changes sound, from "hard" to "soft", according to the following vowel. But a fewer number of verbs, as the following nine ones of the table above, have simple inflections, like the ones used for present tense of the 1st and the 2nd conjugation: singular plural 1st person (io) scopro I discover (noi) scopriamo we discover 2nd person (tu) scopri you discover (singular) (voi) scoprite you discover (plural) 3rd person (egli / ella) scopre he/she/it discover (essi / esse) scoprono they discover Unfortunately, there is no specific rule to tell whether a verb of the 3rd conjugation follows the first or the second pattern, but present tense is the only one with this dual situation: all other tenses have simply one inflection. In both cases, accent always falls on the penultimate syllable, except the 3rd plural person (accent on the antepenultimate syllable), like in present tense of the 1st and 2nd conjugation. capisco la situazione = I understand the situation ...BUT apro il giornale = I open the newspaper forniscono le informazioni = they provide the informations ...BUT seguono una persona = they follow a person capiamo le istruzioni = we understand the instructions apriamo la porta = we open the door fornite gli attrezzi = you (plur.) provide the tools pulite la stanza = you clean up the room (no difference for 1st and 2nd plural persons) --- PHONETIC CHANGES --In very few cases, a verb whose root ends with c or g (i.e. fuggire = to run away, or cucire = to sew) follows the second pattern. Some of them add a phonetic i to the root, so to keep the consonant's "soft" sound:

1st person 2nd person 3rd person

singular (io) cucio I sew you sew (singular) (tu) cuci (egli / ella) cuce he/she sews

plural (noi) cuciamo we sew you sew (plural) (voi) cucite (essi / esse) cuciono they sew

Note that the root of cucire is cuc..., but the 1st singular and 3rd plural persons have cuci...: in this way, consonant c sounds "soft", or palatal: cucio (pronounced "kwchoh") and cuciono (pronounced "kwchohnoh"). Without the i, they would have sounded "kwkoh" and "kwkohnoh", i.e. guttural. Instead, other verbs do not add the phonetic i, so the root remains graphically unchanged, but the sound of the consonant changes according to the following vowel: singular plural 1st person (io) fuggo I run away (noi) fuggiamo we run away 2nd person (tu) fuggi you run away (singular) (voi) fuggite you run away (plural) 3rd person (egli / ella) fugge he/she runs aways (essi / esse) fuggono they run away

Note the pronounciation: fuggo sounds as "fw'ggoh", "hard", i.e. guttural, whereas fuggi sounds as "fw'djyh", "soft", i.e. palatal. But almost every other verb of the 3rd conjugation whose root ends with c or g follows the first pattern (i.e. reagire, agire, marcire, ruggire, etc.), for which phonetic changes are not required, because all inflections start with vowel i: agisco ("ahjyskoh"), agisci ("ahjyshyh"), agisce ("ahjysheh"), etc. So, try to memorize only the two aforesaid irregular patterns, and don't worry about others.

IMPERFETTO singular plural 1st person (io) capivo I understood (noi) capivamo we understood 2nd person (tu) capivi you understood (singular) (voi) capivate you understood (plural) 3rd person (egli/ella) capiva he/she understood (essi/esse) capivano they understood Accents are the same as in the 1st and 2nd conjugation. The first vowel of the inflection is i. No special phonetic change occurs with any verb. sentivamo freddo = we felt cold (or "we were feeling cold") finivano il lavoro = they finished the work (or "they were finishing the work") cucivano tutti i giorni = they sewed every day

FUTURO singular plural 1st person (io) capirò I shall understand (noi) capiremo we shall understand 2nd person (tu) capirai you will understand (sing.) (voi) capirete you will understand (pl.) 3rd person (egli/ella) capirà he/she will understand (essi/esse) capiranno they will understand

Accents are the same as in the 1st and 2nd conjugation (two of them fall on the last syllable). Again, the first vowel of the inflection is i. aprirà un negozio = he will open a shop partiremo domani = we shall leave tomorrow

PASSATO REMOTO singular plural 1st person (io) capii I understood (noi) capimmo we understood 2nd person (tu) capisti you understood (singular) (voi) capiste you understood (plural) 3rd person (egli / ella) capì he/she understood (essi /esse) capirono they understood

These inflections are rather similar to the ones of the 1st conjugation. Only the 3rd singular person is slightly different, because it has an accented i instead of an accented o. Also note how the 1st singular person ends with two vowels i: both of them must be heard, pronouncing "ahpryhyh" (like a long English "ee" sound), with the accent on the first i; this should not be confused with the 3rd singular person, whose only i is accented, and therefore carries the stress: "ahpryh" (thus ending with a very short sound).

5.1 SIMPLE PREPOSITIONS Prepositions are short words which express conditions, directions, specifications, such as of, over, to, from, etc. The Italian language has nine basic prepositions: DI

A

DA

IN

CON

PER

SU

TRA

FRA

When a definite article follows them, they bind to it. When they are not followed (and bound) to articles, as above, they are called "simple prepositions". Each of them will be discussed individually, showing their basic use. You don't need to memorize all their meanings now, but reading the page will let you become more familiar with these prepositions and with their use. You may also use this page as a reference, for translating exercise sentences. Most of these prepositions will be more deeply discussed in further specific paragraphs.

DI The first important meaning of this preposition is of, so that it can be easily translated in most expressions: un bicchiere di vino = a glass of wine la città di Roma = the city of Rome un tipo di musica = a kind of music But Italian also uses di to express specifications, which in English sometimes behave as adjectives: un bastone di legno = a wooden stick (literally: "a stick of wood") una forchetta di plastica = a plastic fork (literally: "a fork of plastic") un topo di campagna = a country mouse (literally: "a mouse of country") i giorni di festa = the holidays (literally: "the days of holiday") il piano di sopra = the upper floor (literally: "the floor of up") Furthermore, since Italian does not have a genitive case, di also translates the English saxon genitive, indicating possession (either actual or metaphorical): il libro di Paolo = Paul's book (literally: "the book of Paul") la madre di Roberto = Robert's mother i dischi di Bob Dylan = Bob Dylan's records il giorno di Natale = Christmas day In a similar way, di is also used as English by (i.e in works by an artist, songs by a composer, etc., almost considered as the author's belonging): un affresco di Michelangelo = a fresco by Michelangelo una sinfonia di Beethoven = a symphony by Beethoven una commedia di Shakespeare = a play by Shakespeare un racconto di Maupassant = a novel by Maupassant Geographic origin is also expressed by possession (as if people belonged to where they come from): io sono di Roma = I am from Rome i due ragazzi sono di Berlino = the two boys are from Berlin

When di is followed by a verb (always infinitive tense!) it has the English meaning of for (+ gerundive), or to (+ infinitive): decido di mangiare un panino = I decide to eat a sandwich il modo di costruire un modello = the way of building a model

A further meaning of di is English on, used for days (as a habitual circumstance): di sabato = on Saturdays (note that in Italy this expression has a singular form, literally "on [every] Saturday") di mercoledì = on Wednesdays it is also sometimes used with seasons of the year; when the season's name starts with a vowel, the preposition drops the i, and its place is taken by an apostrophe: d'estate = in summer d'inverno = in winter

A (AD)

When preposition a is followed by another word starting with a vowel, for mere phonetic reasons it changes to ad. The first important meaning of this prepositon is to, as a dative case: regalo il libro a Stefania = I give the book to Stephanie venderò la bicicletta a Carlo = I shall sell the bycicle to Charles mandai un pacco ad Alberto = I sent Albert a parcel (literally: "I sent a parcel to Albert"). In a similar way, a indicates directions: a sinistra = to the left a destra = to the right (note how in Italian the two directions have no article) tornerò ad Amburgo = I shall return to Hamburg It also translates English at, or sometimes in, when stating locations: a casa = at home a scuola = at school siamo a letto = we are in bed tu vivi a Roma = you live in Rome When this preposition is between two verbs (the first one usually indicating movement, the second one always in infinitive tense), it indicates the goal of an action, thus translating English to (or sometimes and): corsi a portare le buone notizie a Paolo = I ran to carry the good news to Paolo tornano a restituire i libri = they come back to return the books scenderò a cercare il cane = I shall go down and look for the dog (or ...to look for the dog)

Preposition a is also used with the verb giocare (to play), which in Italian is intransitive, and is therefore followed by this preposition which in English is not required: giocare a carte = to play cards giocare a tennis = to play tennis giocare a biliardo = to play billiards

DA The main use is that of English from or since or as of, indicating an origin (either in time or in space, or a person): da Parigi a Vienna = from Paris to Vienna da qui a lì = from here to there da padre a figlio = from father to son da ieri = since yesterday da lunedì 25 marzo il negozio chiuderà presto = as of monday, March 25th, the shop will close early riceverai una lettera da Francesco = you will receive a letter from Frances When followed by a verb (always infinitive!), it has the meaning of English "has to be..." or "needs to be..." or "can be...": il pacco è da spedire = the parcel has to be sent or the parcel is to be sent l'indirizzo è da verificare = the address has to be checked or the address needs to be checked il sistema è da cambiare = the system needs to be changed

IN It basically corresponds to the English preposition in or into: in certi casi = in certain cases entrò in dieci negozi = he/she entered [into] ten shops ho dieci monete in tasca = I have ten coins in my pocket Sometimes it corresponds to English by: arrivarono in automobile = they arrived by car un giro in bicicletta = a ride by bicycle traverseremo il fiume in barca = we will cross the river by boat etc. etc. Another common Italian use for preposition in is to describe the quantity of people in groups or parties, when only the number is stated: siamo in sette = we are seven tirano la fune in cinque = they are five [people] to pull the rope Preposition in is also the most commonly used with seasons of the year (the other preposition mentioned above, di, is an alternative) in estate = in summer in autunno = in autumn in primavera = in spring

CON It translates the English with, and is very similar in use: ho comprato il libro con pochi soldi = I bought the book with little money il bambino era con un adulto = the child was with an adult scrivo con una penna = I write with a pen etc. It is also often used as an alternative to in when indicating transport, but in this case it is followed by an article (either definite or indefinite): torno con il treno = I come back by train (literally "with the train") the same sentence could be expressed by using in: torno in treno = I come back by train

PER It can translate English for, to, by, or even as, according to the different use. ho un biglietto per il teatro = I have a ticket for the theatre il pacco è per la signora = the parcel is for the lady una medicina per il dolore = a medicine for [the] pain (note the use of an article in Italian) dipingeva per puro divertimento = he/she painted for pure pleasure lavoravano per i soldi = they worked for the money tornammo per vedere un amico = they came back to see a friend per favore = please (literally: "as a favour") il treno per Roma = the train [going] to Rome teneva il bambino per la mano = he/she held the child by the hand

SU The most common meanings are on and over. l'aereo vola su Firenze = the plane flies over Florence It can also mean about when indicating a topic: un libro su Roma = a book about Rome Since in most cases this preposition is followed by an article, it will be discussed more throughoutly in the following paragraph. TRA & FRA Both prepositions translate the English between and among, and any of the two may be used, according to one's own choice. l'insegnante è fra fra gli alunni = the teacher is among the pupils (but ...è tra gli alunni would have been the same) l'albero fra le due case è alto = the tree between the two houses is tall (but l'albero tra le due case... would have been the same)

The same prepositions also translate the English in when speaking of a time length in the future: l'autobus passerà fra due ore = the bus will pass in two hours time (it could also have been ...passerà tra due ore) fra due mesi tornerò a Napoli = in two months time I will return to Naples (it could also have been tra due mesi...)

5.2 COMPOUND PREPOSITIONS Due to phonetic reasons, simple prepositions di, a, da, in, su, followed by an article bind to it, thus creating a compound preposition. Most of these changes concern both spoken and written language. DI

DI + LO = DELLO

DI + I = DEI

with singular articles: DI + IL = DEL DI + L' = DELL' with plural articles: DI + GLI = DEGLI

DI + LA = DELLA

DI + LE = DELLE

il traffico della città = the city's traffic (literally: the traffic of the city) i rami dell'albero = the branches of the tree (or the tree's branches) i bagagli dei turisti = the tourists' luggage notice that the Italian word for luggage, bagagli, is plural

A

A + LO = ALLO

A + I = AI

with singular articles: A + IL = AL A + L' = ALL' with plural articles: A + GLI = AGLI

A + LA = ALLA

A + LE = ALLE

regaleranno un libro all'insegnante = they will give a book to the teacher porta l'automobile al garage = he/she takes the car to the garage chiederò agli amici di restare = I will ask the friends to stay notice that the verb chiedere = to ask needs preposition a (to) before the person whom the request is addressed to: only the object is introduced without a preposition.

DA

DA + LO = DALLO

with singular articles: DA + IL = DAL DA + L' = DALL'

DA + LA = DALLA

with plural articles: DA + I = DAI DA + GLI = DAGLI DA + LE = DALLE viaggerò dal nord al sud del paese = I will travel from the north to the south of the country riconosco il suo cane dalla coda = I can tell his/her dog by the tail l'evoluzione delle specie, dalla scimmia all'uomo = the evolution of species, from ape to man notice that many nouns expressing general categories (species, ape, man, etc.) in Italian require an article, therefore compound prepositions have to be used.

IN

IN + LO = NELLO

IN + I = NEI

with singular articles: IN + IL = NEL IN + L' = NELL' with plural articles: IN + GLI = NEGLI

IN + LA = NELLA

IN + LE = NELLE

il vino è nella bottiglia = the wine is in the bottle appesero i vestiti negli armadi = they hung the clothes into the wardrobes l'indice dell'opera è nell' ultimo volume = the work's index is in the last volume

SU Unlike other prepositions, con might link to the following article, but especially in recent times the two words are left separate. with singular articles: SU + LO = SULLO SU + IL = SUL SU + L' = SULL' SU + LA = SULLA

SU + I = SUI

with plural articles: SU + GLI = SUGLI

SU + LE = SULLE

la casa sulla montagna = the house on the mountain ho lasciato i libri sul tavolo = I left the books on the table un documentario sugli insetti = a documentary about insects (in Italian the definite article is needed)

All other prepositions (con, per, tra, fra) do not bind to the article, and remain separate: il regalo è per la signora = the gift is for the lady l'accordo con gli avversari = the agreement with the opponents il nido dell'uccello è fra i rami dell'albero = the bird's nest is among the tree's branches Only preposition con is sometimes used in the compound form, but only in spoken language. Many of its combinations have become almost obsolete in written language, and the simple form (i.e. unbound, con + article) is now preferred in most texts. Since these changes are merely phonetic, spoken language may use either of the two forms. with singular articles: CON + LO = COLLO CON + IL = COL CON + L' = COLL' CON + LA = COLLA

CON + I = COI

with plural articles: CON + GLI = COGLI

CON + LE = COLLE

If you are in doubt, use the unbound form which is correct in both cases: l'uomo con il cane = the man with the dog (l'uomo col cane would be the form used in spoken language, but both are correct) la donna con la borsa = the woman with the hand-bag (la donna colla borsa would be more common in spoken language, both correct)

5.3 POSSESSIVE ADJECTIVES AND PRONOUNS In Italian, possessive adjectives and possessive pronouns are exactly the same. They correspond to the English ones, but while in English possession is expressed by two different forms, one as adjective (my, your, his, her, etc.) and one as pronoun (mine, yours, etc.), Italian has only one form, used in both cases. mio my - mine tuo your - yours suo his/her/its - hers nostro our - ours your - yours (plural) vostro loro their - theirs But as any other Italian adjective and pronoun, they are gender- and number-sensitive (except one): feminine and plural inflections are almost the same ones used for common adjectives: masculine singular feminine singular masculine plural feminine plural mio tuo suo

mia tua sua

miei (irregular) tuoi (irregular) suoi (irregular)

mie tue sue

nostro vostro loro

nostra vostra loro

nostri vostri loro

nostre vostre loro

POSSESSIVE ADJECTIVES AND PRONOUNS USED AS SUBJECTS An important difference with English is that either used alone (as pronouns) or followed by a noun (used as adjectives), they always need an article (definite or indefinite), while in English always rejects articles before a possessive adjective or pronoun. la mia automobile è veloce = my car is fast (here my acts as an adjective for the noun car) la loro è lenta = theirs is slow (here theirs is a pronoun, meaning their car, not mentioned) il suo gatto prese un topo = his cat caught a mouse anche il tuo prese un topo = also yours caught a mouse il vostro albero è alto = your (plur.) tree is tall il loro è basso = theirs is short un tuo parente = a relative of yours (or one of your relatives) uno mio = one of mine (this last example also recalls the rule for indefinite articles used as pronouns, explained in paragraph 2.4). Only when the possessed noun is a specific family relative the article is dropped, as in English: mio padre è alto (not "il mio padre") = my father is tall mia madre è giovane (not "la mia madre") = my mother is young mio fratello è pigro (not "il mio fratello") = my brother is lazy This will be explained again further down in the page, in a more detailed way, with further examples.

Another important difference is that while in English the gender of the possessive pronoun matches the possessor, in Italian it matches the possessed subject: mio padre ha una bicicletta = my father has a bycicle la sua bicicletta (sua matches bicicletta, feminine) = his bycicle (his matches father, masculine) mia madre ha un cane = my mother has a dog il suo cane (suo matches cane, masculine)= her dog (her matches mother, feminine) Number too must match the possessed subjects (English possessive pronouns do not have a plural): mio padre ha due biciclette = my father has two bycicles le sue bicicletta (sue matches biciclette, feminine plural) mia madre ha tre cane = my mother has three dogs i suoi cani (suoi matches cani, masculine plural)

The article too matches the possessed subject (noun) for gender and number, but it matches the possessive pronoun for phonetics. If this seems difficult, focus this sample sentence: la mia automobile è veloce = my car is fast • la is a feminine singular article, since automobile is a feminine singular noun; • mia is a feminine singular possessive pronoun, for the same noun. Had the pronoun mia not been there, the sentence would have read: l'automobile = the car where the article la would have been shortened in l', phonetically matching automobile. But in the previous sentence, the the word next to the article is not the noun but mia, which has to be phonetically matched. These are more sentences with the same situation. l'occhio the eye il mio occhio my eye la tua casa

your house (singular)

lo studio the study

il loro studio

their study

un'amica a friend (feminine)

una mia amica a friend of mine (feminine)

la casa

the house

The definite article is omitted only when nouns indicate a family relationship: padre = father ; madre = mother ; fratello = brother ; sorella = sister ; marito = husband ; moglie = wife ; figlio = son ; figlia = daughter ; zio = uncle ; zia = aunt ; nonno = grand-father ; nonna = grand-mother ; nipote (both sexes) = nephew / niece / grand-son / grand-daughter ; suocero = father-in-law ; suocera = mother -in-law ; genero = son-in-law ; nuora = daughter-in-law . Therefore: il mio amico = my friend (note the use of the article il) .......BUT mio padre = my father (without an article) la madre del mio amico = my friend's mother (with compound preposition del = di + il) .......BUT l'amico di mia madre = my mother's friend (with simple preposition di) regalerò un libro al mio amico = I shall give a book to my friend (preposition al = a + il) .......BUT regalerò un libro a mio zio = I shall give a book to my uncle (with simple preposition a) If the noun is plural, it requires an article in any case:

mia sorella = my sister (without an article) .......BUT le mie sorelle = my sisters (with an article)

la casa di mio nonno = my grandfather's home (with simple preposition di) .......BUT la casa dei miei nonni = my grandparents's home (with compound preposition dei)

comprerò un regalo per tuo genero = I will buy a gift for your son-in-law (without an article) .......BUT comprerò un regalo per i tuoi generi = I will buy a gift for your sons-in-law (with an article) (notice that preposition per does not form compounds with articles) Indefinite articles, instead, are always used, also for relatives: mio zio = my uncle un mio zio = an uncle of mine (or one of my uncles), with an article mia nonna = my grand-mother una mia nonna = one of my grand-mothers, with an article Notice that, as for most other nouns, when a family relation name is plural, the masculine form may refer either to masculine gender only or to both genders (meaning masculine and feminine together, i.e. uncles and aunts, grand-father and grand-mother, etc.), while feminine plural only refers to feminine relatives. Instead, when nouns describing different sexes have a different root, both nouns are actually mentioned: zio uncle zia aunt uncles or uncles and aunts aunts (only) zii zie nonno nonni

grand-father grand-fathers or grand-parents

fratello fratelli e sorelle genero generi e nuore

...BUT brother brothers and sisters son-in-law sons- and daughters-in-law

nonna nonne

grand-mother grand-mothers (only)

sorella

sister

nuora

daughter-in-law

POSSESSIVE ADJECTIVES AND PRONOUNS USED AS OBJECTS OR COPULAS Pronouns and adjectives do not change inflection when they are used as an object or as a copula (i.e. when they follow verb to be, thus indicating a condition of property or possession). What may change is the use of an article before the pronoun. It is more easy to discuss the two cases separately. USED AS OBJECTS Either used before a noun (adjective) or alone (pronoun) as direct objects, they always require an article: leggo il mio giornale = I read my newspaper (adjective) leggo il mio = I read mine (pronoun) comprammo i loro libri = we bought their books comprammo i loro = we bought theirs prenderò le sue carte = I will take his/her cards prenderò le sue = I will take his/hers When the object is a family person (in singular form), the article is required only for pronouns (not for adjectives, as explained above): vedo tua madre e la sua = I see your mother (adjective) and his/hers (pronoun)

incontrò tuo fratello, e poi incontrò il mio = he/she met your brother, and then he/she met mine tuo padre è alto, il nostro è basso = your father is tall, ours is short USED AS COPULAS When used as the copula's adjective (i.e. they are followed by a noun), they behave exactly as above, requiring an article: è il mio libro = it is my book era la sua scuola = it was his/her school saranno le vostre insegnanti = they will be your teachers (femin.) è mio zio = he is my uncle è sua nipote = she is his/her niece sono i miei nonni = they are my grand-parents When used after the verb essere (to be) as an actual copula, they describe a state of possession as if it was a quality of the object, and therefore the article is not required: il libro è mio = the book is mine la casa era loro = the house was theirs il cane sarà tuo = the dog will be yours Nevertheless, a similar form which requires an article does exist, with a rather specific meaning. Focus the following example: il libro è mio = the book is mine il libro è il mio = the book is mine In the second sentence, where mio has an article, the actual meaning is "the book is the one belonging to me", and mio acts both as an adjective and a pronoun, at the same time. This form is used to indicate the possessed object among others of similar nature. While the standard form puts the stress on the owner of the object, the latter form stresses which of the objects among the present ones are possessed: la casa piccola è mia = the small house is mine (meaning "the small house belongs to me") la casa piccola è la mia = the small house (among other houses) is mine (meaning "among the other houses, I own the small one") il cane con il collare bianco è tuo = the dog with the white collar is yours il cane con il collare bianco è il tuo = the dog with the white collar (among others) is yours le foto sul tavolo sono sue = the pictures on the table are his le foto sul tavolo sono le sue = the pictures on the table (among others) are his (notice that foto is feminine, despite the -o inflection, because it is the shortened form of the original word fotografia = photograph (and foto is therefore either singular or plural, see also paragraph 2.3, "foreign truncated and shortened nouns"). This form is not compulsory, but it is very commonly used.

5.4 INTERROGATIVE AND NEGATIVE FORMS Interrogative and negative forms are much more simple in Italian than they are in English. INTERROGATIVE FORM This is simply obtained by adding a uestion mark at the end of the sentence, while in speech only the inflection of the voice expresses a question.

hai una penna rossa = you have a red pen hai una penna rossa ? = do you have a red pen ? l'albero è nel giardino = the tree is in the garden l'albero è nel giardino ? = is the tree in the garden ? In spoken language, the question will be expressed by simply raising the pitch of the voice while approaching the end of the sentence, especially stressing the last one or two words (in the two examples above: ...penna rossa and ...nel giardino).

The only situation in which words change order is when verb essere (to be) introduces a copula, expressing a quality, a condition, etc. (not a direct object). Compare the following examples with the previous ones: la penna è rossa = the pen is red è rossa la penna ? = is the pen red ? The verb and the copula go before the rest of the sentence, and the subject is postponed. More examples: la casa era fredda = the house was cold era fredda la casa ? = was the house cold ? il mio gatto è nero = my cat is black è nero il mio gatto ? = is my cat black ? tuo marito è alto e grosso = your husband is tall and stout è alto e grosso tuo marito ? = is your husband tall and stout ? il mese sarà grigio e piovoso = the month will be dull and rainy sarà grigio e piovoso il mese ? = will the month be dull and rainy ? la donna grassa è sua madre = the fat lady is his/her mother è sua madre la donna grassa ? = is the fat lady his/her mother ? But when there is no definite subject to be postponed, the interrogative form is simply obtained by adding a question mark: è un treno lungo = it's a long train è un treno lungo ? = is it a long train ? sarà un esame difficile = it will be a difficult exam sarà un esame difficile ? = will it be a difficult exam ? The interrogative form will be discussed again, at a more advanced stage.

NEGATIVE FORM It is simply obtained by adding non = not to the sentence, just before the verb. il tuo albero è una quercia = your tree is an oak il tuo albero non è una quercia = your tree is not an oak preparò un pranzo per dodici persone = he/she prepared a lunch for twelve persons non preparò un pranzo per dodici persone = he/she did not prepare a lunch for twelve persons i miei amici vivono a Parigi = my friends live in Paris i miei amici non vivono a Parigi = my friends do not live in Paris mangerete in casa ? = will you eat at home ? non mangerete in casa ? = will you not eat at home ? era facile = it was easy non era facile = it was not easy

5.5 DEMONSTRATIVE PRONOUNS AND

DEMONSTRATIVE ADJECTIVES DEMONSTRATIVE PRONOUNS

They are used to indicate a person or an object, as if pointing towards it with a finger. QUESTO (this, this one) - QUELLO (that, that one) These pronouns are used as in English, with two differences: • in Italian they are gender-sensitive, according to the object they indicate; • the Italian ones can translate both this and this one. questo this / this one (masculine) questa this / this ones (feminine) questi these / these ones (masculine) queste these / these ones (feminine) quello that / that one (masculine)

quelli

those / those ones (masculine)

quella that / that ones (feminine)

quelle

those / those ones (feminine)

questo è il tuo cane = this is your dog, or this one is your dog quella è mia madre = that one (= that woman) is my mother quelli sono i suoi libri = those are his/her books, or those ones are his/her books queste sono le nostre zie = these are our aunts or these ones are our aunts questa e quella sono identiche = this one and that one are identical questi sono i loro figli = these (ones) are their children

These pronouns may be used either as a subject of the sentence (as in the previous examples), or as an object (as in the following sentences), in which case the English translation always includes ...one: (egli / ella) non prese questa, ma quella = he / she did not take this one, but that one (tu) comprerai quelli = you will buy those ones domani vernicerò questi = tomorrow I will paint these ones preferite questo o quello? = do you prefer this one or that one? They may be used for any other case (genitive, dative, etc.): cominciammo da queste = we started from these ones (feminine) ripareranno la bicicletta con questa = they will repair the bycicle with this one (feminine) la scatola gialla è per questo, non per quello = the yellow box is for this one, not for that one Sometimes, when demonstrative pronouns are the subject of a nominal sentence (a sentence whose verb is to be, which describes a condition or a quality rather than a real action), it is possible to reverse the subject of the sentence: this gives more emphasis to the pronoun, shifted at the bottom, as it also happens in English: questo è il tuo cane = this (one) is your dog il tuo cane è questo = your dog is this one quelle sono le mie penne = those (ones) are my pens le mie penne sono quelle = my pens are those ones

quella sarà la nostra scuola = that one will be our school la nostra scuola sarà quella = our school will be that one questo era il tuo ufficio = this (one) was your office il tuo ufficio era questo = your office was this one questi sono i loro abiti = these are their clothes il tuo posto è questo = their clothes are these ones The postponement of the sentence's subject will be dealt with more in detail in a future paragraph. Especially in the spoken language, questo and quello are often strengthened by the use of the following adverbs: qua lì là qui here here there there The result is as follows: (masculine)

(feminine)

(masculine)

(feminine)

questo qui questo qua this one here

questa qui questa qua this one here

quello lì quello là that one there

quella lì quella là that one there

questi qui questi qua these ones here

queste qui queste qua these ones here

quelli lì quelli là those ones there

quelle lì quelle là those ones there

Note that while in qua and qui the last vowel is not accented (although they sound as if it really was), là and lì are spelt with an accented vowel, not to be mistaken with la (definite article) and li (personal pronoun used as an object, discussed at a further stage). questa qui (or questa qua) è la mia penna = this one here is my pen quelli là (or quelli lì) sono i miei genitori = those one (there) are my parents (essi / esse) scelsero quello là (or quello lì) = they chose that one there (noi) compreremo questo qui (or questo qua) = we shall buy this one here In written language, instead, it is preferrable to avoid adding these adverbs to the pronouns.

COSTUI (that man) - COSTEI (that woman) COSTORO (those people) These pronouns have no equivalent in English, so their translation can vary according to the text, or to the speech. They are somewhat similar in meaning to egli (he), ella (she) and essi / esse (they), discussed in paragraph 4.1, but they carry an intrinsic meaning of detachment from whom is speaking, as if referring to a stranger, or to somebody whom the speaker is not in relation with, or sometimes even to express contempt, as in making a reproach or describing the villain of a novel. For this reason their English translation is more often that man rather than this man, but several other expressions would be correct: that fellow, the bloke, the guy, he, she, and so on, according to the context. Instead, these pronouns would never be used to address a friend, or somebody who is well-known, or the main character of a novel, and so on. They are not too frequently used in the spoken language, while they are very common in literature. (egli) afferrò un lungo bastone = he grabbed a long stick costui afferrò un lungo bastone = the bloke / the fellow grabbed a long stick (ella) non rispettò l'appuntamento = she did not observe the rules costei non rispettò l'appuntamento = this woman did not observe the rules (essi / esse) nascosero i soldi sotto un mattone = they hid the money under a brick

costoro nascosero i soldi sotto un mattone = those people hid the money under a brick (essi / esse) arrivano sempre tardi = they always arrive late costoro arrivano sempre tardi = those people always arrive late

QUESTI (this / that person) Used mainly in written language, especially in literature, questi (note the inflection, apparently the plural form of questo), may be sometimes used as an alternative for costui, i.e. a singular pronoun. It still carries a meaning of "person rather new to the context", for instance it could be used for a side character in a novel, but it never expresses contempt. (egli) afferrò un lungo bastone = he grabbed a long stick costui afferrò un lungo bastone = the bloke grabbed a long stick questi afferrò un lungo bastone = he / the man grabbed a long stick (egli) veniva da un paese lontano = he came from a faraway country costui veniva da un paese lontano = the man / the fellow came from a faraway country questi veniva da un paese lontano = he / this person came from a faraway country Note how the verb's inflections are always singular after this particular questi, and this would be enough to mark its meaning: questi veniva da un paese lontano = he / this person came from a faraway country questi venivano da un paese lontano = these (ones) came from a faraway country The student will rarely hear this pronoun in spoken language, although it is a good thing to know it exists, not to mistake this singular questi with its more frequent plural meaning.

CIÒ (this / that) This very common pronoun, equals in meaning to questo, discussed above, is used to indicate inanimate objects, general concepts, situations, etc. Once again, the written language uses it more than the spoken language (which often prefers questo to ciò), but it is not a merely literary pronoun. ciò è bene per tutti = questo è bene per tutti (spoken language) = this is good for everybody (egli) rubò il gioiello, e ciò è molto grave = he stole the jewel, and this is very serious ciò non migliorò la nostra situazione = this did not improve our situation

While questo and quello (variously inflected) may be turned into adjectives, as will be explained in the second part of this paragraph, costui and ciò are pure pronouns.

DEMONSTRATIVE ADJECTIVES When demonstrative pronouns questo (questa, questi, queste) and quello (quella, quelli, quelle) are followed by a noun, they turn into adjectives. In this case, a few changes occur to match phonetically the first letter of the following word: QUESTO - QUELLO (masculine singular) When questo is followed by a noun beginning with a vowel, it makes an elision, i.e. it drops the last ...o, whose place is taken by an apostrophe: questo cane = this dog quest'occhio = this eye quest'anno = this year quest'uomo = this man quest'inverno = this winter Forms such as questo occhio, questo anno, etc. are still accepted, although the most correct form is the one with an elision.

Pronoun quello instead, changes according to the same rule described for article lo (see paragraph 2.4): • when the following name begins with a vowel it turns into quell', with an apostrophe; • when the following name begins with Z or with S + consonant (sb..., sc..., sd..., etc.) it remains as it is; • when the following name starts with a consonant it turns into quel (simply dropping ...lo, without an apostrophe). quel cane = that dog quell'uomo = that man quello sport = that sport quel tavolo = that table quell'anno = that year quello zucchero = that sugar QUESTA - QUELLA (feminine singular) questa only makes an elision (i.e. quest' with an apostrophe) if the following name begins with a vowel: questa casa = this house quest'automobile = this car questa strada = this road quest'orchestra = this orchestra questa penna = this pen quest'acqua = this water And quella changes in a similar way: quella casa = that house quell'automobile = that car quella strada = that road quell'orchestra = that orchestra quella penna = that pen quell'acqua = that water The elision may be sometimes omitted to give these demonstrative pronouns a stronger emphasis, almost as underlining the noun they refer to: quest'uomo generically translates this man questo uomo translates this man, as if meaning ...not any other one quell'automobile è veloce plainly translates that car is fast quella automobile è veloce gives the sentence a meaning of that car is fast (not this one) In these cases, they are spelt (and pronounced) throughoutly, to stress their meaning.

QUESTI - QUESTE AND QUELLI - QUELLE (plural) Pronouns questi, queste and quelle do not have any phonetic changes: questi uomini = these men questi numeri = these numbers questi alberi = these trees questi scudi = these shields queste idee = these ideas queste carte = these cards queste armi = these weapons queste zone = these zones questi idioti = these idiots questi giardini = these gardens questi operai = these workmen questi strumenti = these instruments The adjective quelli, instead, changes into quei or into quegli, according to the same rules by which definite articles i or gli are used (see paragraph 2.4): quegli is used when the following word begins with a vowel, or with z..., or with cluster s + consonant (sb...; sc...; etc.)

quegli uomini = those men quegli occhiali = those glasses quegli zoccoli = those clogs quegli schermi = those screens quei is used in all other cases: quei tavoli = those tables quei piatti = those dishes quei serpenti = those snakes quei libri = those books Remember that such phonetic changes take place according to the next following word, not necessarily to the noun which the adjective relates to: quei piatti = those dishes quegli ottimi piatti = those excellent dishes quegli zoccoli = those clogs quei brutti zoccoli = those ugly clogs

These rules are summarized in the following table: the following noun starts with...

masculine singular

feminine singular

masculine plural

feminine plural

pronoun used alone (no noun) followed by any vowel followed by any consonant

questo quest' questo

questa quest' questa

questi questi questi

queste queste queste

pronoun used alone (no noun) followed by any vowel followed by Z, or S + consonant followed by any other consonant

quello quell' quello quel

quella quell' quella quella

quelli quegli quegli quei

quelle quelle quelle quelle

Note that expressions such as quell'uomo (that man) and quel ragazzo (that boy) are formally equals to costui and questi (previously discussed), although the intrinsic meaning that the two latter pronouns carry, as explained above, would account for choosing each of them according to the context of the speech. In the same way, quella donna (that woman), or quella ragazza (that girl) would match costei in formal meaning, and quelle persone (those people), quegli uomini (those men), quelle donne (those women), etc. would all correspond to costoro.

DEMONSTRATIVE ADJECTIVES USED AS PRONOUNS

In paragraph 2.4 (see INDEFINITE ARTICLES USED AS PRONOUNS) we found that the indefinite articles uno and una, when followed by an adjective without a noun, replace the latter acting as its pronoun. For instance: un grosso libro = a large book uno grosso = a large one una bella penna = a nice pen una bella = a nice one un prodotto economico = a cheap product uno economico = a cheap one

In the same way, quello and its feminine and plural forms may be used to obtain the definite equivalent of the aforesaid pattern: un grosso libro = a large book uno grosso = a large one quello grosso = the large one una bella penna = a nice pen una bella = a nice one quella bella = the nice one un prodotto economico = a cheap product uno economico = a cheap one quello economico = the cheap one i ragazzi giovani = the young boys quelli giovani = the young ones le bevande fredde = the cold drinks quelle fredde = the cold ones i ragazzi giovani = the young boys quelli giovani = the young ones i monumenti antichi = the ancient monuments quelli antichi = the ancient ones Note that also quello and quella, when used for this purpose, never undergo an elision to make a phonetic match with the adjective. For instance: quell'abile artigiano = that skillful craftsman quello abile = the skillful one quell'ottima ricetta = that excellent recipe quella ottima = the excellent one quell'attore famoso = that famous actor quello famoso = the famous one Also note that the masculine plural form used for this purpose is always quelli, whereas before a true adjective or a noun quegli or quei would have to be used: quegli scomodi letti = those uncomfortable beds quelli scomodi = the uncomfortable ones quei bravi giocatori = those clever players quelli bravi = the clever ones quegli amici stranieri = those foreign friends quelli stranieri = the foreign ones quei vestiti eleganti = those elegant clothes quelli eleganti = the elegant ones Try to become as more confident as possible with these schemes, since they will be brought again into discussion at a further stage.

6.1 THE VERB ESSERE PART II

COMPOUND INDICATIVE TENSES To proceed with this paragraph you should feel confident with the simple tenses of this verb (paragraph 4.3). For an introduction to these tenses, see paragraph 4.2. As explained in paragraph 4.2, compound tenses are made of two parts: an auxiliary verb (used in one of the simple tenses previously discussed) and the actual verb (used in past participle tense). Essere (to be) is a transitive verb, so avere (to be) should be used as an auxiliary verb; but essere is a very irregular verb, so as an exception, the same verb essere is also used as the auxiliary one. The past participle of the verb essere is stato (irregular). Actually, stato is the regular past participle of the verb stare = to stay, to be (phisically), which is though used also by essere, because often the meaning of these two verbs overlaps. The verb stare will be dealt with more in depth in paragraph 20.1

PASSATO PROSSIMO

1st person 2nd person 3rd person

This tense is made by present + past participle: singular plural (io) sono stato I have been siamo stati we have been (tu) sei stato you have been (singular) siete stati you have been (plural) (egli) è stato he/it has been sono stati they have been

As will be explained more in detail in paragraph 6.7, when essere acts as an auxiliary verb for a past participle, as in this case, the latter becomes gender- and number-sensitive: when stato is referred to feminine gender it becomes (essa) è stata (she has been), while their plurals are (essi) sono stati (they have been) and (esse) sono state (they feminine have been). è stato un bello spettacolo = it has been a nice show sono state settimane terribili = they have been terrible weeks è stata la segretaria del ministro = she has been the secretary of the minister tutti noi siamo stati giovani = all of us have been young

TRAPASSATO PROSSIMO This tense is made by imperfect + past participle: singular plural 1st person (io) ero stato I had been (noi) eravamo stati we had been 2nd person (tu) eri stato you had been (singular) (voi) eravate stati you had been (plural) 3rd person (egli) era stato he/it had been (essi) erano stati they had been

Actions expressed by this tense have taken place in the past, translating the English form "I had been". Once again, for feminine and plural the past participle changes its inflections in stata, stati, state.

eri stato allo zoo = you (masculine) had been to the zoo ero stata a Roma quattro volte = I (feminine) had been to Rome four times eravamo stati al museo = we (masculine) had been to the museum erano state con un amico = they (feminine) had been with a friend

TRAPASSATO REMOTO This tense is made by past perfect + past participle. singular plural 1st person (io) fui stato I had been (noi) fummo stati we had been 2nd person (tu) fosti stato you had been (singular) (voi) foste stati you had been (plural) 3rd person (egli) fu stato he had been (essi) furono stati they had been Due to the fact that the verb essere acts both as an auxiliary verb and as a main verb, this tense is not commonly used, and other forms (which will be discussed further on) are more commonly used to express the same concept. Remember the change of inflection for feminine and plurals (stata, stati, state).

FUTURO ANTERIORE This tense is made by future + past participle: singular plural 1st person (io) sarò stato I will have been (noi) saremo stati we will have been 2nd person (tu) sarai stato you will have been (sing.) (voi) sarete stati you will have been (pl.) 3rd person (egli) sarà stato he/she/it will have been (essi) saranno stati they will have been

The futuro anteriore can express two concepts: • when used in a future sentence, it indicates an action that has already happened by that time: tomorrow, by 10 o'clock, you will have gone to work. • more often, this tense expresses the chance that an action has already been carried out, but we have no proof of it, or we are not sure: sarà stato a Firenze = he might have been to Florence sarà stata a Londra = he might have been to London saranno state in casa = they (feminine) might have been at home sarà stato un incidente = it might have been an accident saranno stati in cinque = they might have been five (people) A similar concept of chance is sometimes expressed also by simple future tense, as explained in paragraph 4.3.

6.2 THE VERB AVERE PART II

COMPOUND INDICATIVE TENSES Avere (to have) is transitive, so it will also be used as an auxiliary verb. The past participle of the verb is avuto (regular past participle inflection). When avere is used before the past participle, the latter is insensitive to gender and number, so avuto will be the participle for both masculine and feminine, both singular and plural forms.

PASSATO PROSSIMO singular plural 1st person (io) ho avuto I have had (noi) abbiamo avuto we have had 2nd person (tu) hai avuto you have had (singular) (voi) avete avuto you have had (plural) 3rd person (egli / ella) ha avuto he/she has had (essi / esse) hanno avuto they have had

The tense expresses an action which has happened in a near past, and is now over. It may be translated with the English corresponding tense ("I have had"), but the use of simple past tense is commonly preferred: ho avuto un incidente = I had an accident (actual translation: I have had an accident) hanno avuto una grande fortuna = they had a big luck (actually: they have had a big luck) The difference with passato remoto tense is that the latter expresses an action happened a long time ago: ieri ho avuto un incidente = yesterday I had an accident (tense: passato prossimo) lo scorso anno ebbi un incidente = last year I had an accident (tense: passato remoto) As a colloquial form, passato prossimo tense is more popular, despite being compound, irrespectively of time: in common speech, the last sentence above could often be turned into: lo scorso anno ho avuto un incidente (less correct, but very common).

TRAPASSATO PROSSIMO singular plural 1st person (io) avevo avuto I had had (noi) avevamo avuto 2nd person (tu) avevi avuto you had had (singular) (voi) avevate avuto 3rd person (egli / ella) aveva avuto he/she/it had had (essi / esse) avevano avuto

we had had you had had (plural) they had had

Actions expressed by this tense have taken place in the past, translating the English past perfect "I had been". avevamo avuto un gatto = we had had a cat (but in English, a different verb would often be used to avoid repeating "had" twice: "we had owned a cat", etc.)

TRAPASSATO REMOTO singular plural 1st person (io) ebbi avuto I had had (noi) avemmo avuto we had had 2nd person (tu) avesti avuto you had had (singular) (voi) aveste avuto you had had (plural) 3rd person (egli / ella) ebbe avuto he/she/it had had (essi / esse) ebbero avuto they had had

Actions expressed by this tense have taken place in the past, and were already over by the time the sentence refers to. It is usually translated with the English form "I had had". When this tense is used, the action expressed is followed by another action, in passato remoto tense. In English, this pattern can be turned into an alternative form: "having" + past participle. For example: "after he had received his wage, he came back from work" could be turned into "after having received his wage, he came back from work". This literally means: "at first he received his wage, then he came back from work". In Italian, this sentence would require a past pluperfect (trapassato remoto) for the first verb, and a past perfect (passato remoto) for the second one: dopo che ebbe avuto la paga, tornò dal lavoro ebbe avuto = trapassato remoto, tornò = passato remoto IMPORTANT NOTE In Italian, the English form "to have something done" is translated in a completely different way, so expressions like "he has the car washed", or "he had the car washed" are NEVER translated with any of the tenses discussed above.

FUTURO ANTERIORE 1st person 2nd person 3rd person

singular (io) avrò avuto (tu) avrai avuto (egli / ella) avrà avuto

I will have had you will have had (sing.) he/she will have had

plural (noi) avremo avuto (voi) avrete avuto (essi / esse) avranno avuto

we will have had you will have had (pl.) they will have had

Again, this tense is mostly used for expressing chance: il treno avrà avuto un problema = the train might have had a problem avranno avuto bel tempo = they might have had fine weather avrai avuto una brutta giornata = you might have had a bad day But in fewer cases it does express a past action in the future: pagherò quando avrò avuto una risposta = I will pay when I will have had a reply (in English, it would be more common to say "I will pay after having received a reply"). torneranno quando avranno avuto la loro parte = they'll return when they will have had their share

6.3 PAST PARTICIPLE Before introducing compound tenses of the three conjugations, it is necessary to become familiar with past participle. NOTE accented vowels are used to mark the accent (stress) in verbs of the 2nd conjugation, but remember that they are not used in common spelling Many verbs have a regular past participle, whose inflections are as follows: 1st CONJUGATION: infinitive ...are, past participle ....ato 2nd CONJUGATION: infinitive ...ere, past participle ....uto 3rd CONJUGATION: infinitive ...ire, past participle ....ito camminare (to walk) camminato (walked) mangiare (to eat) mangiato (eat) saltare (to jump) saltato (jumped)

véndere (to sell) sedére (to sit) prèmere (to press) capire (to understand) sentire (to hear) partire (to leave)

venduto (sold) seduto (sat) premuto (pressed) capito (understood) sentito (heard) partito (left)

Verbs of the 1st and 3rd conjugation have regular past participles in most cases, while very often verbs of the 2nd conjugation have an irregular one. Most dictionaries state irregular past participles: a common inflection is ...so: prèndere (to take) scéndere (to come off, to come down) estèndere (to extend) spèndere (to spend) delùdere (to disappoint) evàdere (to escape) chiùdere (to close)

preso (taken) sceso (come off) esteso (extended) speso (spent) deluso (disapponted) evaso (escaped) chiuso (come off)

Some verbs double the s: flèttere (to flex) méttere (to put, to place) sopprìmere (to cancel, to kill) esprìmere (to express) discùtere (to discuss)

flesso (flexed) messo (put, placed) soppresso (cancelled, killed) notice the change of i into e espresso (cancelled, killed) same as above discusso (read)

Some verbs have a ...to inflection: spìngere (to push) piàngere (to cry) avvòlgere (to wind) raccògliere (to pick up)

spinto (pushed) pianto (cried) avvolto (wound) raccolto (picked up) for phonetic reasons, gli turns into l

Some verbs have a similar inflection, but double the t: lèggere (to read) letto (read) cuòcere (to cook) cotto (cooked) the u is dropped dirìgere (to direct) diretto (directed) the second i turns into e Sometimes a compound of ...so and ...to occurs, forming ...sto: chiedere (to ask) chiesto (asked) nascondere (to hide) nascosto (hidden) vedére (to see, to watch) visto (seen, watched) the regular form veduto is also allowed A special case is that of two verbs belonging to the 3rd conjugation, whose past participle inflection is ...to, but with a number of changes in the verb's root: soffrire (to suffer) sofferto (suffered) aprire (to open) aperto (opened) Notice how in the two cases above letter r swaps position with vowel i, which turns into e. Obviously you don't need to learn all forms at once, but try to get slowly familiar with them, because it is important to tell a past participle from other words (a noun, an adjective, etc.) whose last part mimics the above-mentioned inflections:

vaso (vase, noun); brutto (ugly, adjective); cesto (basket, noun); piatto (dish, noun); sotto (under - below, adverb); etc. Also try to focus how verbs with similar phonetic structure often behave in the same way: if the past participle of spingere is spinto, verbs with a similar sound (tingere, vincere, dipingere, etc.) have a similar past participle. But this is not an absolute rule.

Some past participles can be used both as a verbal tense and as an adjective; this happens also in English: rotto (broken): I have broken the stick (verb) - the stick is broken (adjective); sigillato (sealed): you had sealed the envelope - the sealed envelope; rubato (stolen): they had stolen the car - the stolen car; etc. etc. It is also important to learn how to trace back the verb's root (thus, the verb's infinitive) from its past participle. It's easy when the participle is regular: preparato comes from preparare (to prepare) goduto comes from godére (to enjoy) fuggito comes from fuggire (to run off) It's less easy for irregular participles: compreso comes from comprèndere (to comprehend, to understand) compresso (notice, double s) comes from comprìmere (to press) chiuso comes from chiùdere (to close) aperto comes from aprire (to open) and so on.

6.4 VERBS OF THE 1st CONJUGATION PART II

COMPOUND INDICATIVE TENSES As previously said, compound tenses are formed by the auxiliary verb avere when the verb is transitive (i.e. when the action expressed by the verb may have a direct object). Things are a little more complicated when the verb is intransitive (i.e. when the action may not have a direct object); in these cases, the auxiliary verb used may be avere, as well, but some require essere; dictionaries usually indicate which auxiliary intransitive verbs use in compound tenses. Therefore, the following examples show both situations, by using the transitive verb alzare (to lift, to raise) and the intransitive verb scappare (to run off, to escape). But a few examples with telefonare (to phone) will also be shown: unlike the English verb, in Italian it is an intransitive verb, and it always requires preposition a = to before the object, but the auxiliary verb is avere all the same. Most verbs of the 1st conjugation are transitive, despite some of them might seem intransitive at first sight: for example, lavorare = to work is not often followed by a direct object, but you can still work something (clay, wood, etc.), so it's perfectly transitive).

PASSATO PROSSIMO singular 1st person (io) ho alzato I have lifted 2nd person (tu) hai alzato you have lifted (sing.) 3rd person (egli / ella) ha alzato he/she has lifted

plural we have lifted (noi) abbiamo alzato you have lifted (pl.) (voi) avete alzato (essi / esse) hanno alzato they have lifted

1st person (io) sono scappato 2nd person (tu) sei scappato 3rd person (egli) è scappato

I have escaped (noi) siamo scappati you have escaped (sing.) (voi) siete scappati he has escaped (essi) sono scappati

we have escaped you have escaped (pl.) they have escaped

You will notice that the intransitive verb's past participle changes its inflections. This depends on the fact that when essere is used as an auxiliary verb, the following past participle behaves almost as if it was an adjective. So, when a past participle follows the verb essere, it is gender- and number-sensitive. sono scappato = I (masculine) have escaped siamo scappati = we (masculine) have escaped sono scappata = I (feminine) have escaped siamo scappate = we (feminine) have escaped This tense is used to translate actions which have been carried out a small time ago (a few minutes, up to a few weeks ago, but there is no fixed time limit). For older actions, passato remoto (English simple past) should be more properly used. In common speech, though, this tense is often used in place of passato remoto also for older actions. When translating this tense into English, often the closest equivalent is a simple past, not the actual compound tense (i.e. present perfect), but this is not a strict rule. Some elements in the sentence might help to decide which of the two is better. questa mattina ho preso l'autobus = this morning I took the bus ha mangiato una grossa bistecca = he has eaten a big steak (but "he ate a big steak" would be a fair translation, as well) abbiamo telefonato a casa= we phoned home (notice how Italian requires the use of preposition a) In the first sentence, Italian uses passato prossimo because "this morning" is a short time ago. English instead would use simple past: it sounds uncommon to use present perfect this morning I have taken the bus. In the same way, in Italian a simple past (questa mattina non presi l'autobus: camminai) would sound rather incorrect. So, when turning Italian into English, in most cases passato prossimo will require simple past; when doing the opposite translation (English into Italian), rely on how much time ago the action happened, but if you find difficulties with passato remoto tense, you can use the easier passato prossimo, in any case.

1st person 2nd person 3rd person

TRAPASSATO PROSSIMO singular plural I had lifted we had lifted (io) avevo alzato (noi) avevamo alzato you had lifted (s.) you had lifted (p.) (tu) avevi alzato (voi) avevate alzato (egli / ella) aveva alzato he/she had lifted (essi / esse) avevano alzato they had lifted

1st person 2nd person 3rd person

(io) ero scappato (tu) eri scappato (egli) era scappato

I had escaped you had escaped (s.) he/she/it had escaped

(noi) eravamo scappati (voi) eravate scappati (essi) erano scappati

we had escaped you had escaped (p.) they had escaped

In this case, the English past perfect corresponds more or less precisely to the Italian tense: avevi alzato il volume della radio = you (singular) had raised the radio volume erano scappate da casa = they (feminine) had ran away from home avevate telefonato a Paolo = you (plural) had phoned Paul due elefanti erano scappati = two elephants had run away

TRAPASSATO REMOTO 1st person 2nd person 3rd person

singular I had lifted (io) ebbi alzato you had lifted (s.) (tu) avesti alzato (egli / ella) ebbe alzato he/she had lifted

1st person 2nd person 3rd person

(io) fui scappato (tu) fosti scappato (egli) fu scappato

I had escaped you had escaped (s.) he/she had escaped

plural we had lifted (noi) avemmo alzato you had lifted (p.) (voi) aveste alzato (essi / esse) ebbero alzato they had lifted (noi) fummo scappati (voi) foste scappati (essi) furono scappati

we had escaped you had escaped (p.) they had escaped

The use of this tense, less common than others, has already been discussed; here are a few more examples. quando tutti i gatti furono scappati, il cane tornò indietro = when all the cats had run away, the dog came back Note how this tense describes an early action, which has already finished when the following action starts. The latter is in passato remoto tense (English simple past). Had there not been a following action, the trapassato prossimo tense would have been used: tutti i gatti erano scappati, così il cane tornò indietro = all the cats had run off, so the dog came back

FUTURO ANTERIORE singular

plural

1st person

(io) avrò alzato

I shall have lifted

(noi) avremo alzato

we shall have lifted

2nd person

(tu) avrai alzato

you will have lifted (s.)

(voi) avrete alzato

you will have lifted (p.)

3rd person

(egli / ella) avrà alzato he/she will have lifted

1st person 2nd person

(io) sarò scappato (tu) sarai scappato

I shall have escaped you will have escaped (s.)

(noi) saranno scappati (voi) sarete scappati

we shall have escaped you will have escaped (p.)

3rd person

(egli) sarà scappato

he/she will have escaped

(essi) saranno scappati

they will have escaped

(essi / esse) avranno alzato they will have lifted

As previously said, this tense is mostly used for expressing chance, rather than its actual meaning of past action in the future. Always remember to inflect the past participle when essere is the auxiliary verb. la scimmia sarà scappata da uno zoo = the monkey might have escaped from a zoo ieri avrò camminato almeno dieci chilometri = yesterday I might have walked at least ten kilometers avrà telefonato all'ufficio questa mattina = he might have phoned the office this morning saranno tornate da Vienna = they (feminine) might have returned from Vienna But in fewer cases it expresses a past action in the future: telefonerò ad Enrico quando avrò parlato con suo figlio = literally I will phone Henry when I will have spoken to his son (but in English, it would be better to say "I will phone Henry as soon as I have spoken to his son", or "...after having spoken to his son").

6.5 VERBS OF THE 2nd CONJUGATION PART II

COMPOUND INDICATIVE TENSES To choose the right auxiliary verb, follow the same rule as the 1st conjugation: for transitive verbs use avere, while intransitive ones more often require avere, as well, but some use essere (check the dictionary). Since some verbs may be either transitive or intransitive according to different meanings, the auxiliary verb may change: for example crescere = to grow requires essere in expressions such as this plant has grown, the dog had rapidly grown, etc., but it requires verb avere when it is used with a transitive meaning i.e. he grew (up) two children, etc. Tables will be shown by using spingere = (to push, transitive), whose past participle is spinto, and scendere (to go down, to come off, always intransitive, requiring essere), whose past participle is sceso. PASSATO PROSSIMO 1st person 2nd person 3rd person

singular I have pushed (io) ho spinto you have pushed (s.) (tu) hai spinto (egli / ella) ha spinto he/she has pushed

1st person 2nd person 3rd person

(io) sono sceso (tu ) sei sceso (egli) è sceso

I have come down you have come down (s.) he/she has come down

plural we have pushed (noi) abbiamo spinto you have pushed (p.) (voi) avete spinto (essi / esse) hanno spinto they have pushed (noi) siamo scesi (voi) siete scesi (essi) sono scesi

we have come down you have come down (p.) they have come down

Also in this case the intransitive verb using essere treats past participles as adjectives, using both singular and plural forms. sono sceso = I (masculine) have come down/come off - siamo scesi = we (masculine) have come down/come off sono scesa = I (feminine) have come down/come off - siamo scese = we (feminine) have come down/come off

ho spinto il carrello = I (both genders) have pushed the trolley (or I pushed the trolley) abbiamo spinto il carrello = we (both genders) have pushed the trolley (or we pushed the trolley) sono sceso dall'aereo = I (masculine) have come off the plane (or I came off the plane) sono scesa dall'aereo = I (feminine) have come off the plane (or I came off the plane) siamo scese dall'aereo = we (feminine) have come off the plane (or we came off the plane)

TRAPASSATO PROSSIMO 1st person 2nd person 3rd person

singular I had pushed (io) avevo spinto you had pushed (s.) (tu) avevi spinto (egli / ella) aveva spinto he/she had pushed

1st person 2nd person 3rd person

(io) ero sceso (tu) eri sceso (egli) era sceso

I had escaped you had escaped (s.) he/she had escaped

plural we had pushed (noi) avevamo spinto you had pushed (p.) (voi) avevate spinto (essi / esse) avevano spinto they had pushed (noi) eravamo scappati (voi) eravate scappati (essi) erano scappati

we had escaped you had escaped (p.) they had escaped

In this case the English compound tense corresponds more or less precisely to the Italian tense: avevamo spinto la porta = we had pushed the door le donne erano scese al primo piano = the women had gone down to the first floor

TRAPASSATO REMOTO singular

plural

1st person 2nd person 3rd person

I had pushed (io) ebbi spinto you had pushed (s.) (tu) avesti spinto (egli / ella) ebbe spinto he/she had pushed

1st person 2nd person 3rd person

(io) fui sceso (tu) fosti sceso (egli) fu sceso

I have escaped you have escaped (s.) he/she has escaped

we had pushed (noi) avemmo spinto you had pushed (p.) (voi) aveste spinto (essi / esse) ebbero spinto they had pushed (noi) fummo scappati (voi) foste scappati (essi) fummo scappati

we have escaped you have escaped (p.) they have escaped

dopo che ebbero spinto l'automobile fino al garage, entrarono nella casa = after they had pushed the car up to the garage, they entered the house quando fu scesa dal treno, telefonò al principale = when she had come off the train, she phoned the boss

FUTURO ANTERIORE 1st person 2nd person 3rd person

singular (io) avrò spinto (tu) avrai spinto (egli /ella) avrà spinto

I shall have pushed you will have pushed (s.) he/she will have pushed

plural we shall have pushed (noi) avremo spinto you will have pushed (p.) (voi) avrete spinto (essi / esse) avranno spinto they will have pushed

1st person 2nd person 3rd person

(io) sarò sceso (tu) sarai sceso (egli) sarà sceso

I shall have escaped you will have escaped (s.) he/she will have escaped

(noi) saremo scappati (voi) sarete scappati (essi) saranno scappati

we shall have escaped you will have escaped (p.) they will have escaped

a quest'ora, sarà scesa dall'aereo = by this time, she might have come off the plane avrò spinto la bicicletta per almeno due ore = I might have pushed the bycicle for at least two hours quando avrete spinto il pulsante l'ascensore scenderà = literally when you will have pushed the button, the lift will come down

6.6 VERBS OF THE 3rd CONJUGATION PART II

COMPOUND INDICATIVE TENSES Verbs of the third conjugation are less irregular than the ones of the 2nd, so most of them have a regular past participle (...ito). Tables will be shown by using udire = (to feel, transitive), and partire (to leave, intransitive, requiring essere); both past participles are regular. PASSATO PROSSIMO 1st person 2nd person 3rd person 1st person 2nd person 3rd person

singular I have heard (io) ho udito you have heard (sing.) (tu) hai udito (egli / ella) ha udito he/she/it has heard I have left (io) sono partito you have left (sing.) (tu) sei partito he/she/it has left (egli) è partito

plural we have heard (noi) abbiamo udito you have heard (pl.) (voi) avete udito (essi / esse) hanno udito they have heard we have left (noi) siamo scesi you have left (pl.) (voi) siete scesi they have left (essi) sono scesi

Also in this case the intransitive verb using essere causes the following past participle to use different inflections for feminine and plural forms. ho udito un rumore = I heard a noise hanno udito un rumore = they heard a noise è partita ieri = she left yesterday sono partiti ieri = they (masculine) left yesterday sono partite ieri = they (feminine) left yesterday

TRAPASSATO PROSSIMO 1st person 2nd person 3rd person

singular I had heard (io) avevo udito you had heard (s.) (tu) avevi udito (egli / ella) aveva udito he/she/it had heard

1st person 2nd person 3rd person

(io) ero partito (tu) eri partito (egli) era partito

I had left you had left (s.) he/she/it had left

plural (noi) avevamo udito (voi) avevate udito (essi / esse) avevano udito

we had heard you had heard (p.) they had heard

(noi) eravamo scappati (voi) eravate scappati (essi) erano scappati

we had left you had left (p.) they had left

A few examples: avevamo udito quella esplosione = we had heard that blast la sua amica non era partita = his/her friend had not left le sue amiche non erano partite = his/her friends had not left

TRAPASSATO REMOTO 1st person 2nd person 3rd person

singular I had heard (io) ebbi udito you had heard (s.) (tu) avesti udito (egli / ella) ebbe udito he/she/it had heard

1st person 2nd person 3rd person

(io) fui partito (tu) fosti partito (egli) fu partito

I had left you had left (s.) he/she/it had left

plural (noi) avemmo udito (voi) aveste udito (essi / esse) ebbero udito

we had heard you had heard (p.) they had heard

(noi) fummo partiti (voi) foste partiti (essi) furono partiti

we had left you had left (p.) they had left

appena i ragazzi ebbero finito i compiti, uscirono in strada = as soon as the boys had finished their homework, they came out in the street quando Paolo fu partito, tornammo a casa = when Paul had left, we returned home note how casa (home, or house) needs preposition a (to), like any other place

FUTURO ANTERIORE 1st person 2nd person 3rd person

singular (io) avrò udito (tu) avrai udito (egli / ella) avrà udito

I shall have heard you will have heard (s.) he/she/it will have heard

plural we shall have heard (noi) avremo udito you will have heard (pl.) (voi) avrete udito (essi / esse) avranno udito they will have heard

1st person 2nd person 3rd person

(io) sarò partito (tu) sarai partito (egli) sarà partito

I shall have left you will have left (s.) he/she/it will have left

(noi) saremo scappati (voi) sarete scappati (essi) saranno scappati

we shall have left you will have left (pl.) they will have left

avranno udito la chiamata? = will they have heard the call ? sarà partita per Parigi = she might have left for Paris quando saranno partite venderanno la casa = when they (feminine) will have left, they will sell the house

7.1 THE DAYS OF THE WEEK ALSO INTRODUCING THE ADVERB QUANDO Before discussing several topics concerning time, it is useful to memorize the adverb quando, which means when, both in positive and interrogative sentences: quando tornerete ? = when will you (plur.) return ? quando avremo finito il nostro lavoro = when we will have finished our work To indicate a future action, it is not strictly necessary to use a future tense after quando: present tense still gives the idea of something yet to come, although it may also indicate a habitual action, depending on the context and the meaning of the sentence: quando comprerà la nuova automobile = when he/she will buy the new car quando compra la nuova automobile = when he/she buys the new car (future action) quando compra qualcosa = when he/she buys something (habitual action) An idiomatic expression contains this adverb twice: di quando in quando, meaning every now and then, from time to time, occasionally. di quando in quando andiamo al cinema = from time to time we go to the movies

THE DAYS OF THE WEEK The Italian names of the seven days of the week are: lunedì martedì mercoledì giovedì venerdì sabato domenica

Monday Tuesday Wednesday Thursday Friday Saturday Sunday

The Italian week always starts with Monday, while sometimes in English, especially in charts, in tables, etc., it starts with Sunday. Also notice how these names never have a capital (uppercase) letter, as they usually do in English. These names are all masculine, except domenica which is feminine. Most names end with ...dì (notice the accent), because the word dì, truncated form of the Latin dies, means day (which has the same Latin origin). In modern Italian, dì alone is not very commonly used, and another word for day, giorno, is often preferred. Many Italian names of the week have an astronomical-mythological origin, referring to planets (which often bear the name of ancient roman gods and goddesses), but also a few English names have this peculiar origin: • lunedì means "the day of the Moon" (like English monday); • martedì means "the day of Mars"; • mercoledì means "the day of Mercurius"; • giovedì means "the day of Jupiter"; • venerdì means "the day of Venus"; • sabato curiously is of Jewish origin (shabbath = Jewish saturday); the English name is linked to Saturn; • domenica means "the day of the Lord" (Latin dominus); the English name, instead, is linked to the Sun.

When using these names to indicate a precise date, (I will come on Monday, etc.), Italian does not use any preposition to match English on. venerdì comprerò un nuovo televisore = on Friday I will buy a new TV set. mercoledì, quando sei partito, hai dimenticato le chiavi = on Wednesday, when you left, you forgot the keys oggi è martedì = today is Tuesday The same form is used when days are not specified: due giovedì di questo mese = two Thursdays in this month (literally "...of this month"), but it can also mean on two Thursdays in this month The use of a preposition or an article gives the day a habitual meaning: there are several forms for doing so. A definite article is often used: il lunedì lavoro a casa = on Mondays I work at home il sabato vado al mare = on Saturdays I go to the seaside la domenica i negozi sono chiusi = on Sundays the shops are closed The name of the day can be shifted to the end of the sentence, to give it more emphasis, and in this case the simple preposition di is preferred (though not compulsory): lavoro a casa di lunedì = I work at home on Mondays vado al mare di sabato = I go to the seaside on Saturdays i negozi sono chiusi di domenica = the shops are closed on Sundays Instead of di, the compound preposition al (= a + il) or alla (= a + la) can be used: lavoro a casa al lunedì = I work at home on Mondays vado al mare al sabato = I go to the seaside on Saturdays i negozi sono chiusi alla domenica = the shops are closed on Sundays But, to make things easier, you can simply memorize either the use of articles, or of preposition di.

A further way to indicate habitual days is to use a definite article in singular form: il lunedì lavoro a casa = on Mondays I work at home il sabato vado al mare = on Saturdays I go to the seaside la domenica i negozi sono chiusi = on Sundays the shops are closed The same form is also used to indicate a very specific day (usually, a further specification occurs in the sentence): il venerdì prima di Natale = Friday before Christmas (but this can also read on Friday before Christmas) il prossimo martedì = next Tuesday or on next Tuesday la domenica di Pasqua = Easter Sunday (literally "the Sunday of Easter") or on Easter Sunday But when the specific day is introduced by a demonstrative adjective, the article is always dropped: il sabato prima di Natale = Saturday before Christmas (or on Saturday before Christmas) ...BUT quel sabato prima di Natale = that Saturday before Christmas (or on that Saturday before....) NOTE - in the latter case, the specification "before Christmas" is almost redundant, because the use of "that" indicates how this day has already been introduced as a topic, or specified Some sentences refer to more than one specific day (i.e. the winter Sundays, all Wednesdays in March, etc.), in which case Italian always uses a definite article in plural form:

i giovedì di quest'anno = Thursdays of this year tutti i sabati = all Saturdays le domeniche estive = the summer Sundays i primi lunedì del mese = the first Monday of each month, whose literal translation is "the first Mondays of the month", in this case with an actual meaning of "each", but this topic will be discussed at a further stage. In the sentences above, giovedì and lunedì are plural, although the inflection is the same as singular forms because these nouns are truncated (see paragraph 2.3). Instead, sabato and domenica have standard plurals: sabati and domeniche; notice the phonetic h, added to keep the guttural sound of c (i.e. as an English k) before the vowel e.

7.2 MONTHS & SEASONS OF THE YEAR MONTHS The Italian names of the twelve months of the year are: gennaio febbraio marzo aprile maggio giugno luglio agosto settembre ottobre novembre dicembre

January February March April May June July August September October November December

They are not very different from the English version, in which the Latin root is even more evident than in Italian. In most cases, these names have an ancient roman origin: gennaio comes from Janus, the god who patroned the beginning of all events, to whom the first month was dedicated; marzo comes from Mars, god of war; agosto was probably given after the name of the first worshipped emperor, Augustus; settembre through dicembre come from the fact that in ancient times the year had ten months, and these names simply numbered the last ones (Latin septem = 7, octo = 8, novem = 9 and decem = 10). A main difference with English is that, in Italian, they always have a small (or lowercase) initial letter. Usually simple preposition in is used to indicate an event taking place within the month: in giugno partiremo per Berlino = in June we shall leave for Berlin Natale cade in dicembre = Christmas falls in December Preposition a can be used insted of in, especially in spoken language: a settembre cambierò lavoro = in September I shall change job quest'anno Pasqua cade a marzo = this year Easter falls in March Any of the two prepositions can be used: in is more formal, while a is more colloquial.

Unlike day names, months never use a definite article in habitual forms: febbraio è un mese freddo = february is a cold month ad (or in) agosto andiamo sempre al mare = in August we always go to the seaside (notice the phonetic use of ad instead of a, because the following word too starts with vowel a)

The article can be used only to indicate a very precise month: il luglio più caldo fu nel 1947 = the hottest July was in (the) 1947 (disregard the comparative form now: it will be discussed further on) questo è stato un novembre piovoso = this has been a rainy November dal maggio del 1963 = as of (the) May (of the) 1963 (next paragraph 7.3 will discuss years) nel giugno del 1970 = in (the) June (of the) 1970 Notice that while English preposition in can be translated either with a or with in when the month does not require an article (as said above), only preposition in is used in forms with an article, as shown again in the followng examples: in gennaio or a gennaio = in January ...BUT nel gennaio del 1985 (only form) = in January 1985 But when introduced by a demonstrative adjective, the article is always dropped: durante il gennaio del 1985 = during January 1985 ...BUT durante quel gennaio del 1985 = during that January 1985 (notice how in this case the specification "1985" is almost redundant, because the use of "that" indicates that this month already was a topic of discussion)

Both in common speech and written language, months are very often introduced by mese di (month of), which affects the need of an article, because mese requires it: in gennaio le fontane ghiacciano = in January, fountains freeze (but using mese) nel mese di gennaio le fontane ghiacciano = in (the month of) January, fountains freeze da agosto in poi = from August onwards (but using mese) dal mese di agosto in poi = from (the month of) August onwards notice how compound prepositions nel (= in + il) and dal (= da + il) had to be used, instead of simple prepositions in and da because mese cannot stand without a definite article when it introduces a definite month. SEASONS The Italian names of the four seasons are: primavera estate autunno inverno Italian also has adjectives referring to each season: primaverile estivo (fem. estiva) autunnale invernale

spring summer autumn or fall winter

(of) spring (of) summer (of) autumn or fall (of) winter

The simple preposition in is commonly used with seasons: in primavera gli uccelli tornano dai paesi caldi = in spring birds come back from (the) hot countries i contadini fanno il vino in autunno = (the) peasants make (the) wine in autumn Sometimes, simple preposition di is used, especially with estate and inverno, in which case it is phonetically shortened in d' (with an apostrophe). It is less commonly used with autunno. Obviously, primavera would require a full di, but this preposition is not really used at all with this noun. d'estate il tempo è bello = in summer the weather is fine quando d'inverno nevica, accendiamo il fuoco = when in winter it snows, we light the fire In some expressions, as the ones above, di is more commonly used, but preposition in could have also been used, and both forms would have been correct, as well.

An article is only used to indicate seasons when no event is related to them: detesto l'autunno = I hate (the) autumn i fiori sono simboli della primavera = (the) flowers are symbols of (the) spring l'inverno giunse presto = (the) winter came soon When adjectives are used, no special rule is required: i lunghi mesi invernali = the long winter months il clima autunnale è grigio e piovoso = the autumn weather is dull and grey (notice that clima is a masculine noun, despite the ...a inflection) le vacanze estive sono sempre troppo corte = (the) summer holidays are always too short

7.3 YEARS & CENTURIES NOTE before you go any further, be sure to master Italian numbers; you might wish to check again paragraph 3.1. Some sentences also use compound prepositions, so if you are in doubt check again paragraph 5.2.

YEARS In Italian years are pronounced as if they were simple numbers: 1963 nineteen sixty-three

millenovecentosessantatré

(one thousand nine hundred and sixtythree)

1500 fifteen hundred

millecinquecento

(one thousand five hundred)

(millesettecentouno)

one thousand seven hundred and one

1701

seventeen hundred and one

...and so on. Unlike English, Italian years need a definite article, because they are referred to the word anno (= year). il 1950 (read il millenovecentocinquanta) = nineteen fifty nel 1950 = in nineteen fifty dal 1950 = from (or as of) nineteen fifty fino al 1950 = until or through nineteen fifty fra il 1950 e il 1960 = between nineteen fifty and nineteen sixty When a month is referred to a specific year, the latter needs an article, unlike the English form:

il maggio del 1963 = May 1963 nel dicembre del 1995 = in December 1995 dal febbraio del '48 = as of February '48 Sometimes, when the year might be mistaken with a number, the word anno is used: l'anno 2000 (read l'anno duemila) = year two thousand nell'anno 2 = in year 2 dall'anno 500 = as of (or from) year 500

CENTURIES The Italian word for century is sècolo (vowel e has been accented for mere tutorial reasons). When writing a specific ordinal number before this word, usually roman numbers are used (see paragraph 3.2). Also western numbers can be used, but a roman numeral is always considered a more elegant choice. If you don't feel confident with roman numbers, check appendix 1. il XIV secolo (read il quattordicesimo secolo) = the 14th century nel XX secolo (read nel ventesimo secolo) = in the 20th century The English forms BC (Before Christ) and AD (Anno Domini = Latin for "in the Year of the Lord") correspond to Italian forms aC (avanti Cristo) and dC (dopo Cristo = after Christ). Only when two or more centuries are mentioned, the numeral part may come after the word secolo: nel I secolo aC e nel III secolo dC = in the 1st century BC and in the 3rd century AD may be turned into nei secoli I aC e III dC = literally in the centuries 1st BC and 3rd AD

7.4 DATES Italian dates are always in the following standard: • day, always spelled in western numbers • month, spelled either with letters (abbreviated or in full length) or with numbers (western or roman) • year, spelled either in full length or by the last two digits Separators are more often hyphens (-) or dots (. or ·), but backslashes (/) are also common, or no separator at all. A few examples: 3 · 5 · 1970 = May 3rd, 1970 (...never March 5th!) 1 gen 1990 = January 1st, 1990 2 - XII - 65 = December 2nd, 1965 Unlike English dates, Italian ones need a definite article, referred to the word giorno (= day). As all articles, they require a phonetical match with the number of the day (the first word following the article). Another important difference is that in Italian date numbers are cardinal, not ordinal as in English: il 25 aprile (read il venticinque aprile) = April 25th (or on April 25th) dal 7 giugno (read dal sette giugno) = as of June 7th) Only number 1 may be read in both ways: l'1 maggio (read l'uno maggio) = May 1st (or on May 1st) can also be turned into il 1º maggio (read il primo maggio) = May 1st (or on May 1st) Notice how in this case a roman number is never used. The cardinal number is more common when the month is followed by a year, in a full date: 1.12.1955 would be l'uno dicembre millenovecentocinquantacinque but 1.12 would more often be il primo dicembre

Anyway, both forms are correct in either case. Quite often, the simple preposition di (of) is used between number and month: il 24 settembre = September 24th (or on September 24th) can also be il 24 di settembre = the 24th of September (or on the 24th of September) In official or burocratic papers, dates may be read by their numbers: 23.8.97 could sound as ventitré otto novantasette

7.5 WHAT TIME IS IT ? The expression what time is it? in Italian is che ore sono? (literally "which hours are they?"), but also the singular form che ora è? is used. Italian hours always need a definite article, referring to the noun ora (hour), which is though usually omitted. l'una one o'clock le due two o'clock le tre three o'clock ..... ..... le dodici twelve o'clock It should be noticed how the article is always plural, because the full expressions would be "the two hours", "the three hours", and so on; only one o'clock is singular. All forms are obviously feminine, because the noun ora to which they refer is feminine too. Italian can use both the 12-hour format and the 24-hour format, the latter being more formal (used in timetables, or in official speech, etc.). le tredici one o'clock PM le quattordici two o'clock PM le quindici three o'clock PM ..... ..... le ventiquattro twelve o'clock PM A practical rule to convert the 24-hour format into the 12-hour format is to subtract 2 from the hour, and then 10: 21:00 21-2 = 19, then 19-10 = 9 9:00 PM In common speech, though, the 12-hour format is much more commonly used; the "AM" or "PM" specification is usually omitted, since the context of the sentence will provide enough elements to understand which of the two is the right one. Should the time be possibly mistaken, the hour can be followed by the expressions antemeridiane (= antemeridian, AM) or pomeridiane (= postmeridian, PM). But in common speech and in most texts more common expressions take the place of these "official" ones: di mattina or del mattino (= in the morning), from 4 or 5 AM to 12 AM di pomeriggio or del pomeriggio (= in the afternoon), from 1 PM to 5 PM (or 6 PM) di sera (= in the evening), from 6 or 7 PM to 11 PM di notte (= at night), , from midnight to 2 or 3 AM Notice how some forms may use either simple preposition di, or the relevant compound preposition, as an alternative. The form di mattina has del mattino as an alternative (mattina is feminine, mattino is masculine, but both nouns mean morning).

le dieci di mattina (or le dieci del mattino) = ten o'clock AM le due di pomeriggio or le quattordici = two o'clock PM le dieci di sera or le ventidue = ten o'clock PM le due di notte = two o'clock AM Obviously, time limits are not too strict: le quattro del mattino (4 o'clock AM) could also be le quattro di notte le sei di pomeriggio (6 o'clock PM) could also be le sei di sera etc. etc. Since hours require a plural article, also verb tenses need to be in plural form: sono le cinque = it's five o'clock sono le quindici = it's three o'clock PM sono le cinque = it's five o'clock ...BUT è l'una = it's one o'clock Due to the need of a definite article, only compound preposition are used: dalle due alle quattro = from two to four all'una = at one o'clock sono tornato alle dieci = I came back at ten o'clock The word ora (literally hour, but whose meaning corresponds to English o'clock) is seldom used, either in case the hour might be mistaken with a different numerical category, or to give emphasis to the expression: il treno parte alle ore quattordici = the train leaves at two o'clock PM la bomba esplose alle ore sedici in punto = the bomb exploded at four o'clock PM sharp But omitting the noun, both sentences would be perfectly correct all the same. The last sentence also shows how the expression in punto corresponds to English sharp (referred to an hour). FRACTIONS OF THE HOUR When mentioning fractions of hours, the terms minutes (in Italian: minuti) is usually omitted. The English form past is translated e (= and): le cinque e venti = twenty (minutes) past five le quindici e cinque = five (minutes) past three PM The English form to is translated meno (= less): le otto meno dieci = ten to eight le tre meno cinque = five to three In Italian, the form "e" can be used all round the hour: le sette e quaranta = ten to eight le due e cinquantanove = two fifty-nine (one minute to three) The form "meno" instead is only used for a time length of twenty minutes or less: le nove meno cinque = five to nine le tre meno venti = twenty to three

So 7:50 could be either le sette e cinquanta (more formal) or le otto meno dieci (more colloquial). Instead 4:35 would always be le quattro e trentacinque.

A very colloquial form is also mancano ..... minuti alle ...., which uses the verb mancare = to lack, with the meaning of "a few minutes (are lacking) to reach the given hour": sono le sette meno dieci = it's ten to seven mancano dieci minuti alle sette = it's ten minutes to seven sono le due meno cinque = it's five to two mancano cinque minuti alle due = it's five minutes to two sono le dieci meno uno = it's one to ten manca un minuto alle dieci = it's one minute to ten Unlike the verb essere in the previous form, here mancare refers to the number of minutes, not to the hour: for this reason the last sentence above needs a singular inflection (manca), since un minuto (= one minute) is singular. When using this colloquial form, the word minuti (or minuto if singular) must be used. This form exists also without a verb: mancano dieci minuti alle sette = it's ten (minutes) to seven dieci minuti alle sette = ten (minutes) to seven mancano cinque minuti alle due = it's five (minutes) to two cinque minuti alle due = five (minutes) to two

When the time fraction is ..:15, ..:30 or ..:45 minutes, the expressions un quarto (a quarter), mezza (half) and tre quarti (three quarters) are commonly used:

le cinque e un quarto = a quarter past five le otto e mezza = half past eight (notice the feminine form mezza, related to ora = hour) le due e tre quarti (or le tre meno un quarto) = two forty-five (or a quarter to three) le sei meno un quarto = a quarter to six Also in this case it is possible to use the form manca un quarto alle .... 5:45 = un quarto alle cinque (literally a quarter to five), though other colloquial alternatives could be le cinque e tre quarti, or le sei meno un quarto, while the "official" form (in timetables, etc.) would be le cinque e quarantacinque. Since un quarto is singular, notice how the verb inflection too (manca) is singular. MEZZOGIORNO, LA MEZZA, MEZZANOTTE The Italian word for mid-day is mezzogiorno, and it can be used in place of le dodici (12 AM); unlike the latter, mezzogiorno does not need an article, and since it is singular, it requires singular verb tenses. Also fractions of the hour can be referred to mezzogiorno: è mezzogiorno = it's mid-day sono le dodici = it's twelve o'clock partiranno a mezzogiorno e venti = they will leave at twenty (minutes) past twelve partiranno alle dodici e venti = they will leave at twenty (minutes) past twelve era mezzogiorno e tre quarti = it was twelve forty-five erano le dodici e tre quarti = it was twelve forty-five sarà mezzogiorno meno un quarto = it might be a quarter to twelve saranno le dodici meno un quarto = it might be a quarter to twelve

As you see, mezzogiorno rejects the definite article, thus requiring simple prepositions, and is singular; le dodici instead needs the article, therefore it requires compound prepositions, and is a plural form. The specific time 12:30 is commonly referred to as la mezza (the half), but it is only used alone. è quasi la mezza = it's almost half past twelve torno da scuola alla mezza = I come back from school at half past twelve The Italian for midnight is mezzanotte, and it it is often preferred to le dodici (12 PM), since the latter is more often used for 12 AM. Also either alone or in fractions of the hour. Also mezzanotte can be used with fractions of the hour; as mezzogiorno, it rejects an article, it needs simple prepositions, and behaves as a singular noun. è mezzanotte = it's midnight tornò a mezzanotte e cinque = he/she came back at five (minutes) past midnight fino a mezzanotte meno un quarto = until a quarter to midnight da mezzanotte alle due = from midnight to two o'clock

7.6 TIME ADVERBS & DURATION FORMS Before introducing duration forms, it is useful to memorize a few adverbs related to time, some of which have already been used in the previous exercises: try to learn them, little by little, as they occur quite often, both in texts and in common speech. oggi today domani tomorrow dopodomani the day after tomorrow ieri yesterday the day before yesterday (this Italian adverb requires a definite article) l'altroieri adesso ora spesso frequentemente qualche volta talvolta di rado raramente

now now (remember that, as a noun, ora means hour) often frequently sometimes (literally: "some time") sometimes seldom rarely

prima dopo durante

before after during

sempre mai

always never

These adverbs follow the same scheme as adjectives: they may be used either before or after the main subject. Which of the two positions depends on which part of the sentence is more emphasized, since in Italian language the last part of the sentence usually carries more "stress": uso molto spesso il computer = I use the computer very often (emphasis on the computer) uso il computer molto spesso = I use the computer very often (emphasis on very often)

di rado lavoro = I seldom work (slight emphasis on work) lavoro di rado = I seldom work (seldom is more emphasized) The two adverbs sempre and mai, instead, are used according to a further rule, which will be the subject of a future paragraph. By now, simply memorize their meaning.

DURATION FORMS The simple preposition da (or its compound, depending on whether the subject requires a definite article or not) is used to express the starting time of a duration, thus translating several English forms: • the form as of ...: da giovedì = as of thursday da oggi = as of today dal 13 maggio = as of May 13th • the form since ...: da giugno del 1958 = since June 1958 dall'altroieri = since the day before yesterday da mercoledì scorso = since last wednesday da quel giorno = since that day • the form from ..., when followed by to ... (see below for the second part of this expression): dal 1975 al 1980 = from 1975 to 1980 da settembre a ottobre = from September to October dalle cinque alle nove = from five (o'clock) to nine da adesso in poi = from now on The simple preposition a ... indicates the end of a time length. Remember that when a is followed by a vowel (especially another a), it changes to ad. This preposition translates English to, when introduced by from (same case as above): da lunedì a domenica = from monday to sunday dal lunedì alla domenica = from (every) monday to (every) sunday dalle cinque alle sette = from five (o'clock) to seven da maggio ad agosto = from May to August (notice ad instead of a, due to agosto) But, as explained in paragraph 7.5, the same preposition a is also used for stating an hour, as English at: alle sette e mezza = at half past seven alle nove meno dieci = at ten to nine all'una e venti = at twenty past one a mezzanotte = at midnight When a time length has no definite origin, and only the finishing time is stated, fino a ... is used to express the latter, translating several English forms: • the form until (or till): fino a sabato = until saturday fino a domani = until tomorrow fino alle cinque = until five o'clock • the form up to ... (also generally used with numbers, measures, etc.): fino al 1950 = up to 1950 fino ad ora = up to now (notice ad instead of a, because of ora) fino al quindici = up to number fifteen fino a sei metri = up to six metres fino a qui = up to here • the form through ...: catalogo dei prezzi fino al 31 giugno = price catalogue through June 31st questa tessera è valida fino al 2001 = this card is valid through 2001 Sometimes, when the deadline is not a given day but a month, a year, etc. (as in the second sample sentence), the adjective tutto = all is added to the form (fino a tutto ...), to indicate that the month or year mentioned is included within the period. Therefore, the above-mentioned sentence would often be: questa tessera è valida fino a tutto il 2001

The English preposition for ..., expressing duration, is translated by preposition per ...: per cinque settimane = for five weeks ho lavorato lì per cinque giorni = I have worked there for five days l'ingresso è gratis per tutto il 1995 = the entrance is free for the whole (year) 1995 In expressing time length, English always uses for + the duration of the action, but Italian also uses another form: da + the duration of the action. This is the only tricky bit in translating these forms into Italian, so be sure to focus it well. lavoro da due anni = I have been working for two years non vedo Paolo da cinque mesi = I haven't seen Paul for five months la radio non funziona da due settimane = the radio has not been working for two weeks piove da due giorni = it has been raining for two days In Italian, this form is rather different from the previous one, although it might seem similar in English: ho lavorato per cinque settimane = I have worked for five weeks this sentence mainly gives stress to the time length of the action, and little importance is given to when the action started; lavoro da cinque settimane = I have been working for five weeks the English form gives stress to the fact that the action has taken place habitually for the given time (i.e. "I have worked every day for a time length of five weeks"), while the Italian form carries a meaning of "I have been working every day starting from five weeks ago": this is why preposition da is used, as if to say "from a starting moment, five weeks ago". So, as a practical rule, preposition per gives a sense of duration in time as any similar English form, while da always has a meaning of "time elapsed from that moment", either referring to the future (translating English from, as of, etc. as explained in an earlier part of this paragraph), or in the past, as in this case, though in English it has to be turned into a different form. Also notice that when preposition da is used for English since, the Italian tense always refers to the latest moment of the action, as if looking at the action back in time, while the English tense refers to the starting moment of the action, or anyway to an earlier time than its end: non vedo Paolo dal 1975 = I have not seen Paul since 1975 vedo (present tense) is referred to "now", while have seen (present perfect tense) refers to "1975" dormo da due ore = I have been sleeping for two hours dormo (present tense) is referred to "now", while have been refers to "two hours ago" Also when the action happens in the past, there is a difference between the Italian tense and the English one: non vedevo Paolo dal 1975 = I had not seen Paul since 1975 vedevo (imperfect tense) is referred to the time of the sentence, while had seen (present perfect tense) refers to an earlier time ("1975") dormivo da due ore = I had been sleeping for two hours dormivo is referred to the time of the sentence, while had been refers to an earlier time ("two hours before") ADVERBS prima, dopo, durante The English adverb before is translated prima. In Italian it is always followed by preposition di when introducing a noun or a date; instead, it is followed by conjunction che (that) when introducing a subordinate clause, requiring subjunctive tenses. This page only focuses the first case (prima di ...): prima di giugno = before June prima del 1970 = before 1970 prima di domani = before tomorrow lunedì viene prima di martedì = monday comes before tuesday The same adverb may also translate before in sequences (almost suggesting a progression in time): il sette viene prima dell'otto = number seven comes before number eight la M viene prima della N = (letter) M comes before (letter) N The adverb after is translated dopo. In Italian it is usually not followed by any preposition (although di is needed in a very limited number of situations, which will be explained in a future paragraph).

dopo giugno = after June dopo il 1970 = after 1970 dopo i fatti di ieri = after yesterday's events martedì viene dopo lunedì = tuesday comes after monday Also in this case, dopo can be used for sequences, as well: l'otto viene dopo il sette = number eight comes after number seven la F viene dopo la E = (letter) F comes after (letter) E The adverb during ... is translated durante ... (without any preposition), and it is used in the same way as in English: durante la vacanza = during the holiday durante l'anno = during the year abbiamo mangiato il popcorn durante la partita = we eat the popcorn during the match

8.1 PERSONAL PRONOUNS USED AS A DIRECT OBJECT In paragraph 4.1 we have already met personal pronouns as subjects of a sentence. When these pronouns are used in other cases, they work in a different way according to which verbal tense is used. At first sight they will probably appear complicated, but if you follow the page step by step they will turn out to be easier to learn than you might think. The standard personal pronouns used as direct object are: singular 1st person me me 2nd person you (singular) te lui him lei her 3rd person it (masculine) esso it (feminine) essa

plural noi us voi you (plural) loro them

You will notice how only some of them change. There is a curious coincidence between the Italian and English form for the 1st singular person (me), although be sure to pronounce it "meh", with a "narrow" e sound (i.e. acute e, like "may" omitting the final "y"). But for each of these pronouns, Italian also has a parallel form, somewhat shorter than the previous one, which is used either as an individual word (not bound to the following word) or as a suffix (bound at the end of the word). I will therefore refer to these ones respectively as "short" forms or as suffixes, according to how they behave, while "full" forms will be the ones already mentioned (me, te, lui, etc.): singular plural 1st person mi (for me) ci (for noi) me us 2nd person ti (for te) you (singular) vi (for voi) you (plural) lo (for lui and esso) li (for loro) them (masculine) him, it 3rd person la (for lei and essa) le (for loro) them (feminine) her, it

Notice how "short" forms (or suffixes) do no longer make a difference between masculine/feminine and neutre genders. As said in earlier paragraphs, Italian language is affected by this difference very little.

USE OF PERSONAL PRONOUNS AS DIRECT OBJECT At first, we shall focus the use of pronouns as direct objects. INFINITIVE As a general rule, infinitive tense uses the suffix pattern, dropping the last vowel of the verb: vedere = to see, to watch vedermi = to see me vederci = to see us vederti = to see you vedervi = to see you, plural vederlo = to see him vederli = to see them (masculine) vederla = to see her vederle = to see them (feminine) This same pattern is used with any other verb:

mangiare = to eat - mangiarlo = to eat it salutare = to greet - salutarvi = to greet you (plural) notare = to notice - notarli = to notice them (masculine) capire = to understand - capirci = to understand us It is also possible to use the other form, not as a suffix though, by simply placing the pronoun after the verb. This gives the pronoun a somewhat stronger emphasis: vedere me = to see me vedere te = to see you vedere lui = to see him vedere lei = to see her

vedere noi = to see us vedere voi = to see you, plural vedere loro = to see them

These expressions have a sense of "to see specifically me (or you, etc.), not somebody else". To summarize direct object pronouns used with the infinitive tense: common form infinitive-suffix

emphatic form infinitive + pronoun

INDICATIVE TENSES All indicative tenses require the pronoun to be used before the verb. mi vedo = I see myself (literally: I see me) ti vedo = I see you lo vedo = I see him la vedo = I see her vi vedo = I see you (plural) li vedo = I see them (masculine) le vedo = I see them (feminine) The same pattern is valid with any person: mi vedi = you see me ti vedono = they see you lo vediamo = we see him la vede = he/she sees her li vedono = they see them ci vede = he/she sees us ci vedete = you see us (plural) As for infinitive discussed above, also indicative tenses may use a full pronoun after the verb, but this will give specific emphasis to the pronoun: mi vedi = you see me may also be turned into vedi me (meaning you see me, not somebody else) ci vedete = you see us may also be turned into vedete noi etc. etc. In these cases, even more stress may be obtained by specifying the subject's own pronoun: mi vedi = you see me (no emphasis) vedi me = you see me (strong emphasis on "me") tu vedi me = you see me (everything is emphasized)

It should be noticed that the "short" form of personal pronouns (mi, ti, etc.) is also used for reflexive forms, with a meaning of myself, yourself, etc. Reflexive forms will be dealt with in paragraph 8.3, so for the time being we shall disregard this aspect, using "short" pronouns only as already explained above (i.e. me, you, him, etc.).

All patterns shown in the examples above (in present tense) may be used with any other indicative tense: ti vedevo = I saw you lo vedrò = I'll see him la vidi = I saw her mi hanno visto = they have seen me ti avevano visto = they had seen you etc. etc.

So, to summarize direct object pronouns for any indicative tense: common form "short" pronoun + verb

emphatic form verb + "full" pronoun

GENDER AND NUMBER OF PAST PARTICIPLE Discussing compound tenses in previous paragraphs, it had been stated that the Italian past participle (in the above case, visto) is gender- and number-insensitive when the auxiliary verb is avere, while it is genderand number-sensitive when the auxiliary verb is essere (ar required by many intransitive verbs). When using personal pronouns as a direct object, though, also participles supported by verb avere require a match with gender and number of the pronoun. Focus the following examples: ho visto un treno = I have seen a train ho visto quattro treni = I have seen four trains ho visto una farfalla = I have seen a butterfly ho visto tre farfalle = I have seen three butterflies ...BUT lo ho visto = I have seen it (masculine in Italian) li ho visti = I have seen them (masculine) la ho vista = I have seen it (feminine in Italian) le ho viste = I have seen them (feminine) In the first group of sentences, participle visto is in masculine singular form ("standard" form), gender- and number-insensitive because supported by auxiliary verb avere. In the second group of sentences, the same participle becomes gender- and number-sensitive, because personal pronouns are used as objects. Obviously, this rule applies to every other person: hai visto un amico = you have seen a friend lo hai visto = you have seen him hanno visto una mostra = they have seen an exhibition la hanno vista = they have seen it (neutre turns feminine in Italian) avevamo visto molte nuvole = we had seen many clouds le avevamo viste = we had seen them (feminine) avranno visto la televisione = they might have watched the TV la avranno vista = they might have watched it (feminine) ha visto molti film = he/she has seen many movies li ha visti = he/she has seen them (masculine)

avevo visto le indicazioni = I had seen the notices le avevo viste = I had seen them (feminine)

PRONOUNS LO AND LA FOLLOWED BY INFLECTIONS OF VERB AVERE In the same way that definite articles la and lo are shortened (elision) by dropping their last vowel and taking an apostrophe when followed by a vowel (i.e. l'occhio, l'aria, l'edera, l'uovo, etc.), also pronouns spelled in the same way undergo the same elision when they are followed by inflections of verb avere (almost every inflection of this verb starts with a...). Also when verbal inflections start with ha..., the elision occurs because h is mute, considered as a mere graphic sign, simply to tell the verb from other similar words spelled without an h (see again paragraph 4.4 about this topic). As a general rule: • the change always occurs when la comes either before a... or ha...: la abbiamo = l'abbiamo la hai = l'hai la hanno = l'hanno • the change might occur when lo comes either before a... or ha..., but you may also leave things as they are (as a free choice): lo avevate is correct, but also l'avevate is OK lo hai, but also l'hai • no change occurs when any other personal pronoun (li, le, mi, ti, ci, vi) comes either before a... or before ha... Therefore, some of the sentences given in the previous example (see above) need a slight "retouch": lo hai visto is correct, but it can also be spelled (and pronounced) l'hai visto la hanno vista must be spelled (and pronounced) l'hanno vista la avranno vista must be spelled (and pronounced) l'avranno vista Instead, other ones do not change, according to the general rules explained above.

Although it might appear complicated, as a final note to this page I would like to show a comparison between a transitive verb supported by auxiliary verb avere, and an intransitive verb supported by essere. The sample verbs will be vedere (to see, to watch), and tornare (to return, to come back). As usual, focus the examples before the discussion: (egli / ella) ha visto (egli) è tornato (ella) è tornata he/she has seen he/it has come back she has come back (essi / esse) hanno visto they have seen (masc. and fem.)

(essi) sono tornati they have come back (masc.)

(esse) sono tornate they have come back (fem.)

You can easily notice how the past participle visto is gender- and number-insensitive, because supported by verb avere (which is transitive). Past participle tornato, instead, supported by verb essere, needs to match the gender and number of the sentence's subject. Now let's see what happens to visto by using a personal pronoun as direct object (obviously we cannot give tornato a direct object, being this verb intransitive).

lo ha visto he/she has seen him/it

l'ha vista ( = la ha vista after the elision) he/she has seen her

li ha visti he has seen them (masc.)

le ha viste he has seen them (fem.)

Can you notice the big difference? Now visto is no longer insensitive, though what it will match is the gender and number of the object (i.e. of the pronoun), not the subject's. This is a very important concept, which should be focused and understood before going any further, to avoid getting mixed up with the two situations. Summarizing once again, past participles supported by avere only become gender- and number-sensitive when the object is a personal pronoun: in this case they match the object (i.e. the same personal pronoun). In any other case they use the "standard" form (masculine singular). The part participle of intransitive verbs requiring essere, instead, always has to match the subject's own gender and number. Since these verbs are intransitive, they will never have personal pronouns as direct object (nor any other direct object at all).

8.2 PERSONAL PRONOUNS IN DATIVE CASE Dative (from the Latin dare = to give) is the case which indicates the receiver of an action ("you gave something to me", or "you gave me something"), either materially or in a metaphoric sense ("he tells something to you", "you buy him something", etc.). As for direct objects, Italian has two possible ways of translating dative: by using a "full" personal pronoun, or by using a "short" form. The "full" pronouns are the same as direct object's ones, but to show dative case they must be introduced by simple preposition a (or ad if followed by a vowel), meaning to: singular plural 1st person a me to me a noi to us 2nd person to you (singular) a te a voi to you (plural) to him a lui to her a lei 3rd person a loro to them ad esso to it (masculine) ad essa to it (feminine)

The "short" pronouns too are the same as direct object's ones, except for 3rd persons, which have different ones. These forms do no longer require preposition a: singular plural 1st person mi to me ci to us 2nd person to you (singular) to you (plural) ti vi gli to him, to it 3rd person loro (no change) to them le to her, to it

The 3rd plural form loro does not behave as all the other short forms: the latter are sometimes used as suffixes, and sometimes used before the verb; loro instead always behaves as the "full" pronouns, following the verb. Anyway, this will be explained in detail. Since many of the pronouns used for dative case are in common with the ones used as direct object, according to the action described by the verb they will either mean me or to me, you or to you, him or to him, etc. etc.

USE OF PERSONAL PRONOUNS IN DATIVE CASE Their use is very similar to direct object. INFINITIVE As a general rule, the infinitive tense uses the "short" pronouns as suffixes, dropping the last vowel of the tense's inflection (vowel e): regalare = to give (a present, a gift) regalarmi = to give (to) me regalarci = to give (to) us regalarti = to give (to) you regalarvi = to give (to) you, plural regalargli = to give him regalare loro = to give them regalarle = to give her

The direct object of the sentence always follows the pronoun suffix: regalarti una penna = to give you a pen regalarle un anello = to give her a ring regalarvi un'automobile nuova = to give you a new car regalare loro un libro = to give them a book Notice how only loro does not bind to the verb because, as previously mentioned, this pronoun is only used as a "full" form, following the verb not as a suffix, although it belongs to the "short" pronouns. The same forms shown above can be used with any other verb: dare = to give - dargli = to give (to) him passare = to pass - passarle = to pass (to) her comprare = to buy - comprarvi = to buy (for) you (plural) scrivere = to write - scivere loro = to write (to) them Obviously, only verbs who express a "giving" action would require dative case. So, according to the verb, you can use the same pronoun suffixes as dative or as direct object: dare = to give - darci una penna = to give us a pen (-ci is dative) vedere = to see - vederci = to see us (-ci is direct object) scrivere = to write - scivervi una lettera = to write you (plural) a letter (-vi is dative) ringraziare = to thank - ringraziarvi per il regalo = to thank you (plural) for the present (-vi is direct object) 3rd persons, instead, have different "short" forms, according to whether they are used for dative or for direct object: dare = to give - dargli una penna = to give him a pen (-gli can only be dative) vedere = to see - vederlo = to see him/it (-lo can only be direct object) scrivere = to write - sciverle una lettera = to write her a letter (-le can only be dative) ringraziare = to thank - ringraziarla per l'invito = to thank her for the invitation (-la can only be direct object) comprare = to buy - comprare loro un regalo = to buy them a present (loro is dative) rimproverare = to reproach - rimproverarli per il ritardo = to reproach them for the delay (-li can only be direct object) For the sake of precision, it should be said that loro may sometimes act also a direct object, see previous paragraph 8.1, though with an emphatic sense (meaning "right them, not somebody else"), sparingly used. So in most cases loro acts as a dative.

Some verbs which in English do not require a dative in Italian do so, since they are followed by preposition a, although they do not express a "giving" action. A few examples: chiedere a = to ask (somebody) domandare a = to ask (somebody) credere a = to believe in (somebody, something) portare a = to bring / take to (somebody), to fetch (somebody) prendere a = to take from rubare a = to steal from (somebody) strappare a = to grab, snatch from (somebody, something) togliere a = to take away from (somebody, something) In most cases, this preposition a is not an actual dative, but simply a reminiscence of Latin preposition a (= from) which has survived in Italian. However, in the case a verb is followed by preposition a it requires the same pronouns as in the "real" dative case. chiedermi = to ask me domandarti = to ask you credergli = to believe in him prenderle = to take from her rubarci = to steal from us strapparvi = to snatch from you [plural] togliere loro = to take away from them EMPHATIC FORM Also for dative case it is possible to use the other form, i.e. the "full" pronoun after the verb, though this requires the use of preposition a. This form gives much more emphasis to the pronoun: regalare a me = to give to me (meaning "to me, not to others") regalare a te = to give to you regalare a loro = to give to them Notice how loro never binds to the verb, but only in this last case it requires preposition a. Without the preposition a, these pronouns would indicate a direct object. In this emphasized form, direct object has to be used before the pronoun: regalare la penna a me = to give the pen to me (meaning "to me, not to others") regalare un libro a te = to give a book to you regalare qualcosa a loro = to give something to them So, to summarize dative case for the infinitive tense: common form emphatic form without direct object

infinitive-suffix

infinitive + a + "full" pronoun

with direct object

infinitive-suffix + direct object

infinitive + direct object + a + "full" pronoun

INDICATIVE TENSES All indicative tenses require the "short" pronouns before the verb. mi regalo = I give (to) myself (literally: I give me) ti regalo = I give (to) you gli regalo = I give (to) him le regalo = I give (to) her vi regalo = I give (to) you (plural) regalo loro = I give (to) them

Two observations: • ci (to us) cannot be used with the 1st singular person, exactly as it happens for direct object (see previous paragraph), because it would mean "I give (to) us", which is nonsense, but it can be normally used with all other persons: ci regali = you give (to) us ci regala = he/she gives (to) us ci regalano = they give (to) us, etc... • loro is always used after the verb, although it has the same meaning as the "short" pronoun forms. Also indicative tenses may use the other form, i.e. a "full" pronoun, always after the verb, to give the pronoun a greater emphasis: le regalo un libro = I give her a book (plain form, no emphasis) ...may also be turned into: regalo un libro a lei (emphasis on her) ...but also into this other form: a lei regalo un libro (emphasis on her) Notice how in the first emphasized form, when "full" dative pronouns are used, the direct object (i.e. un libro) comes before the pronoun, meaning "I give a book to her (not to somebody else)". The second form, instead, uses again the same "full" dative pronoun, but this time at the beginning of the sentence, with a meaning of "I give a book to her (while I give others something else)". Here is another example: gli scriverò una lettera = I will write to him a letter (no emphasis) scriverò una lettera a lui, "I will write a letter to him" ("...not to somebody else") a lui scriverò una lettera, again emphasis on "to him", meaning something like "...instead to others I will simply talk"

So, to summarize dative case for all indicative tenses: common form

emphatic forms

without direct object

"short" pronoun + verb

verb + a + "full" pronoun

with direct object

"short" pronoun + verb + direct object

verb + direct object + a + "full" pronoun and, with different meaning, a + "full" pronoun+ verb + direct object

USING DATIVE AND OBJECT PRONOUNS IN THE SAME SENTENCE Now let's try to put together in one same sentence a dative pronoun and a direct object one. In such sentences, the dative pronoun always comes before the object one. When this happens, all dative pronouns whose final vowel is i (mi, ti, ci, vi) turn it into e (me, te, ce, ve), while gli, le and loro all turn into glie- . No change occurs to the object pronoun, which comes immediately after. An example: io rubo la bicicletta a te = I steal the bycicle from you (no pronoun, i.e. as in the emphatic form) io ti rubo la bicicletta = I steal from you the bycicle (dative pronoun ti has been used) io la rubo a te = I steal it from you (object pronoun la has been used) io te la rubo = I steal it from you (ti has turned into te before la)

The full table of "dative + object" pronoun combinations is as follows: dative + object = combination

dative + object = combination

first person

mi " " "

+ lo + la + li + le

= me lo = me la = me li = me le

ci " " "

+ lo + la + li + le

= ce lo = ce la = ce li = ce le

second person

ti " " "

+ lo + la + li + le

= te lo = te la = te li = te le

vi " " "

+ lo + la + li + le

= ve lo = ve la = ve li = ve le

gli / le "" "" ""

+ lo + la + li + le

= glielo = gliela = glieli = gliele

loro " " "

+ lo + la + li + le

= glielo = gliela = glieli = gliele

third person

Here are more examples: tu porti il giornale a noi = you take the newspaper to us tu ce lo porti = you take it to us noi regaliamo la penna a te = we give the pen to you noi te la regaliamo = we give it to you egli domanda l'ora a voi = he asks the time to you egli ve la domanda = he asks it to you io offro una birra a loro = I offer a beer to them io gliela offro = I offer it to them tu chiedi le chiavi a lui = you ask him for the keys tu gliele chiedi = you ask him for them If you find this pattern difficult, don't worry, it's a common feeling: one of the trickiest parts of the Italian grammar is to put together different pronouns in the same sentence. As already explained in the previous paragraph 8.1, when object pronouns are followed by a verb whose opening sound is similar to the last sound of the pronoun (i.e. -vowel vowel-), an elision occurs for phonetic reasons, and the pronoun takes an apostrophe: te lo ho dato = I gave it to you becomes te l'ho dato ve la offro = I offer it to you becomes ve l'offro ce la apri? = will you open it for us? [note: present tense in Italian] becomes ce l'apri? te li invieremo a casa = we will send them to you at home becomes te l'invieremo a casa me le elencherete = you will list them for me becomes me l'elencherete gliela ho rubata = I stole it from him / her becomes gliel'ho rubata glieli ha comprati = he / she bought them for him / her becomes gliel'ha comprati The elision may be omitted with plural pronouns li, le, but with singular ones lo, la or with compounds of glie- it is more correct to use it. In fact, the elision with plural pronouns might sometimes reduce the quantity of information expressed with the sentence: te l'invieremo may be the contraction of each of the following: te lo invieremo / te la invieremo = we will send him / her / it to you te li invieremo / te le invieremo = we will send them to you So omitting the elision with plural pronouns reduces the risk of misunderstanding.

Only trying again and again you will become confident with these pronoun combinations, but to do so you ought to know well all individual ones, both the object and the dative ones. So the first step is to learn well the tables shown in paragraph 8.1 and 8.2 (this page).

9.1 SUBJUNCTIVE BASIC CONCEPTS AND PRESENT TENSE Subjunctive tenses are not easy to handle for English speakers, simply because it is difficult to tell when these tenses are required. Subjunctive does not exist in English, with the only exception of the past tense used for the 1st singular person (if I were you). Italian subjunctive has four tenses: • PRESENTE (present) • IMPERFETTO (past) • •

these are simple tenses, with their own inflections; PASSATO (pefect) TRAPASSATO (pluperfect) these are compound tenses, respectively made of present subjunctive + past participle, and past subjunctive + past participle.

WHEN TO USE SUBJUNCTIVE Subjunctive expresses several concepts; therefore, it is not left as a free choice, but has to be used when required: • uncertainty, doubt, possibility (that something may happen or not) I wonder whether you are there (= you may either be there or not) it would be better if she returned (= she may have returned yet, or not) it is useless for them to go there (= they may still either go there, or not) I'm not sure that he can make it (= he may either make it or fail) •

one's own personal judgement, comments, remarks it is better for you to go (in Italian this is turned into it is better that you go, see further on) it is wise for them to study this subject it is unfair that they blame you for this it is nasty for them not to report this

whishing, hoping, one's own thoughts I thought that they might come (= it was my own consideration) we hope that you may leave (= it is not sure you will be able to) they didn't imagine that he would have failed (= it was their own consideration)

orders, demand I order that you come back (= an order is like a wish, until it comes true) he wants you to go (in Italian this is turned into he wants that you go, see further on)

joy, sorrow, surprise, fear, anger (personal feeling about somebody or something) I'm happy that you phoned me they regret that you did not come I'm surprised that she is there they fear that I might get into trouble

denying I deny that this is true they denied that they were there he denied that they might have come

One element in common for all these categories is that subjunctive is always used in subordinate clauses, introduced by a conjunction (more often that). In Italian, the conjunction that is translated che. When a subordinate clause expressing any of the above mentioned meanings is introduced by che, a subjunctive tense is needed. This conjunction has also a number of compounds, which end with ...-ché (note the accented é). Each of them introduces a subordinate sentence, for which subjunctive is required: affinché = so that I will return so that you may leave lend me the brush, so that I can paint the wall benché = although, despite he left for Paris, although he had no money despite the car was broken, I arrived in time perché = in order to, in order for, so that I came back in order for you to see me he opened the window so that we could take a look inside (note that perché also means why and because, but with these shades of meaning subjunctive is not required) purché = provided that you can enter, provided that you wear a tie the show will take place, provided it doesn't rain a meno che = unless we will leave, unless you change your mind you cannot stay here, unless you are a member prima che = before look at this before he returns let's go away before it is too late sebbene = although (same as benché) although he was ill, he came here it's beautiful, although it is a bit expensive nonostante = despite or notwithstanding (same as benché) I did not listen to him, despite he was asking for help despite the temperature grew hot, I liked the place Also the conjunction se = if, whether is always followed by a subjunctive tense, if the sentence introduces a conditional clause: if we had known, we would have gone away earlier if I were rich, I wouldn't have to work so hard had you gone there, you would have met him = [Italian form] if we had been at home, we would have met him should they come, I'll prepare something special = [Italian form] if they come, I'll prepare something special However, since conditional tenses have not been introduced yet (they will be discussed in chapter 13), for the time being no Italian sentence referring to this particular case will be shown. Do you think subjunctive is complicated? Don't worry, it's not only your impression: many Italians too find the use of subjunctive difficult to handle. Some people don't even use these tenses at all. But for the same reason, who is able to use subjunctive properly is considered a good speaker. To use an indicative tense (or any other tense) when subjunctive is required, would not cause a misunderstanding of the sentence, but it would surely sound wrong.

It is finally time to face the first subjunctive inflections. The following tables show three regular verbs, each one belonging to a different conjugation: lavare = (1st, to wash), prèndere (2nd, to take), and aprire (3rd, to open). Although the use of subjunctive is difficult, compared to indicative tenses a simplification is that all three singular persons are identical in the present tense, and two of them are the same in the past (imperfect) tense.

CONGIUNTIVO PRESENTE (present subjunctive) singular

plural

(che io) lavi (che tu) lavi (che egli / ella) lavi

----- 1st conjugation ----(that) I wash (that) you wash (sing.) (that) he/she washes

(che noi) laviamo (che voi) laviate (che essi / esse) lavino

1st person 2nd person 3rd person

(che io) prenda (che tu) prenda (che egli / ella) prenda

----- 2nd conjugation ----(that) I take (that) you take (sing.) (that) he/she take

(that) we take (che noi) prendiamo (that) you take (plur.) (che voi) prendiate (che essi / esse) prendano (that) they take

1st person 2nd person 3rd person

(che io) apra (che tu) apra (che egli / ella) apra

----- 3rd conjugation ----(that) I open (that) you open (sing.) (that) he/she opens

(che noi) apriamo (che voi) apriate (che essi / esse) aprano

1st person 2nd person 3rd person

(that) we wash (that) you wash (plur.) (that) they wash

(that) we open (that) you open (plur.) (that) they open

All the inflections of the third plural person carries the stress on the antipenultimate syllable (àprano, prèndano, làvino), as the corresponding indicative ones do (àprono, prèndono, làvano). credo che lavino il cane molto spesso = I think that they wash the dog very often spero che prenda la giusta decisione = I hope that he / she takes (= will take) the right decision pensiamo che il negozio apra alle 8:00 = we think that the shop opens at 8 o'clock sebbene prendano il treno, arrivano sempre tardi = although they take the train, they always arrive late spero che la banca apra prima che voi prendiate il denaro da casa = I hope that the bank opens before you take the money from home SUBJUNCTIVE IN SENTENCES WITH A DIFFERENT STRUCTURE Sometimes, sentences that in Italian contain the conjunction che and require a subjunctive tense, in English may have a different structure, thus may be less easy to tell. A first case is when the verb of the primary sentence is to want, used in the following pattern: to want somebody / something to.... (verb) which in Italian turns into to want that somebody / something.... (verb) For instance: the boy wants the dog to sit, in Italian turns into the boy wants that the dog sits, in which sits

will be subjunctive. These are a few more examples, in which the verb in red colour shows where subjunctive should be used: the teacher wants you to come = [Italian form] the teacher wants that you come I want the car to be ready = [Italian form] I want that the car is ready his mother wants him to return = [Italian form] his mother wants that he returns they want you not to remain there = [Italian form] they want that you do not remain there This change specifically concerns the verb volere (to want), NOT others (e.g. I asked you to stay; they helped us to carry the luggage; we put him to sleep; etc. do not require subjunctive) Since volere is an irregular verb, its full conjugation will be shown in a further paragraph, but for the time being it is useful to become confident with its present indicative tense, in order to start practicing this structure in exercises. VOLERE (to want) PRESENT INDICATIVE 1st person 2nd person 3rd person

singular (io) voglio (tu) vuoi (egli / ella) vuole

I want you want (sing.) he/she wants

plural we want (noi) vogliamo you want (pl.) (voi) volete (essi / esse) vogliono they want

Here are a few sample sentences: voglio che tu insista = I want you to insist (literally: I want that you insist) vogliamo che i nostri amici tornino presto = we want our friends to come back soon vuole che vi divertiate = he / she wants you to have fun vuoi che la tavola sia pronta per le otto? = do you want the table to be ready by eight o'clock?

Another difference in structure occurs when the primary sentence is impersonal (e.g. it is good..., it is right..., it is useless..., etc.): in such case, in English often makes use of the preposition for: it is wise for him to read books; it is good for the student to rehearse the lesson; it is good for wine to be stored in a cellar; etc. Therefore, this structure is: for + (subject of the subordinate sentence) + infinitive. This does not exist in Italian, which uses a different structure: che + subjunctive. To understand how this is obtained, we must split the example into its two parts. it is wise for him to read books È È he reads books it is wise for him it is good for wine to be stored in a cellar È È wine is stored in a cellar it is good for it So the Italian way of turning these sentences is: it is wise that he reads books and it is good that wine is stored in a cellar (the verbs requiring subjunctive are in red) These are a few more examples in which the Italian structure uses the conjunction that, and the following verb requires a subjunctive tense (shown in red): it is bad for him to smoke = [Italian form] it is bad that he smokes it is better for the shop to stay open = [Italian form] it is better that the shop stays open it is customary for me to work at night = [Italian form] it is customary that I work at night it is good for the flowers to be watered = [Italian form] it is good that the flowers are watered it is dangerous for us to remain there = [Italian form] it is dangerous that we remain there The student should practice these changes until fully confident: turning similar sentences into the Italian form before translating them is a good exercise for telling where subjunctive tenses have to be used.

Obviously, not all sentences that start with it is (adjective) for... are impersonal ones, in which the conjunction that may replace the preposition for: it is better for us to go = [Italian form] it is better that we go it is famous for what happened here = "it" refers to a city or a site, that cannot be used it is difficult for you to take a train = [Italian form] it is difficult that you take a train it is handy for mending things = "it" refers to some kind of tool, that cannot be used it is sad for them not to come = [Italian form] it is sad that they don't come it is amusing for both adults and children = "it" refers to a game, a show, etc. it is important for both adults and children to read the instructions = [Italian form] it is important that both adults and children read the instructions If that cannot replace for, there is no need to use subjunctive: indicative tenses will be used (as in English). However, the presence of the conjunction that is still not enough for requiring a subjunctive tense, which has to be used only when the verb has one of aforesaid shades of meaning (uncertainty, opinions, wishes, demand, personal feelings and denying). In the following sentences the verbs in red are the ones that require subjunctive. All the others are translated with indicative tenses: it is useless for you to come = [Italian form] it is useless that you come Æ subjunctive (you may still decide whether to come or not) he knew that you were sleeping Æ indicative (it is a fact that you were sleeping) this is useless for us Æ indicative (that cannot replace for, there is no subordinate clause) he denied that we had been there Æ subjunctive (is is a denial) knowing that she was there, he too came Æ indicative (it is a fact that she was there) I think that this may be of some help Æ subjunctive (it is a personal opinion) we hope that you will have a good time Æ subjunctive (it is a wish) they noticed that she was not there Æ indicative (it is a fact that she was not there) they wanted him to stay = [Italian form] they wanted that he stayed Æ subjunctive (it is a command) Sometimes the threshold between the meanings that require subjunctive and other meanings is faint: I believe that this happened Æ subjunctive (it is a personal opinion) I know that this happened Æ indicative (it is an actual fact) I suspect that this happened Æ subjunctive (it is a personal opinion) I deduce that this happened Æ indicative (it is an actual fact) I think that this happened Æ in this case, it may be either of the two, depending on the context: • I think that this happened, but I'm not sureÆ subjunctive (it is a personal opinion) • I think that this happened because nobody was thereÆ indicative (it is an actual fact) (in the latter case, subjunctive is sometimes used, although indicative would be more appropriate) Therefore, particular care should be taken in telling which sentence requires a subjunctive tense and which does not, before attempting the translation (the first exercise of this paragraph specifically deals with this). Only practice and experience will avoid having to think every time whether subjunctive is needed or not.

THE USE OF PERSONAL PRONOUNS WITH SUBJUNCTIVE Since the three singular persons have the same inflection, personal pronouns are very often added, not to mistake whom the verb refers to. For instance, the sentence è meglio che prenda l'autobus is not very clear, because according to the person it refers to it may have four different meanings: • è meglio che io prenda l'autobus = it is better for me to take the bus • è meglio che tu prenda l'autobus = it is better for you to take the bus • è meglio che egli prenda l'autobus = it is better for him to take the bus • è meglio che ella prenda l'autobus = it is better for her to take the bus Therefore, the use of personal pronouns with subjunctive is much more common than with indicative tenses, especially for singular persons. But when the subject is clearly understood from the context, there is no real need to use them: (io) sono stanco, è meglio che prenda l'autobus = I'm tired, it is better (for me) to take the bus (tu) sei stanco, è meglio che prenda l'autobus = you are tired, it is better (for you) to take the bus and so on. This is also the case of conditional sentences, dealt with in chapter 13, in which the subjunctive tense is followed by the conditional one: the latter makes clear whom the verb refers to, without the use of a

pronoun.

SUBJUNCTIVE AND FUTURE TENSES Since subjunctive does not have any future tense, it is never used when the sentence specifically contains this tense. These are the same examples shown before, with both present and future tenses: only the former take subjunctive. credo che lavino il cane molto spesso = I think that they wash the dog very often (subjunctive) credo che laveranno il cane molto spesso = I think that they will wash the dog very often (indicative) pensiamo che il negozio apra alle otto = we think that the shop opens at 8 o'clock pensiamo che il negozio aprirà alle otto = we think that the shop will open at 8 o'clock

However, remember that in colloquial language it is common to use a present tense for a future action happening very close in time (e.g. later during the day, tomorrow, within the week, etc.), whereas in English the future tense is normally used. In these cases, subjunctive will be used for the present tense. spero che verrete presto = I hope you will come soon spero che veniate presto (colloquial) crede che le scorte non basteranno fino a domani = he/she thinks that the provisions won't last until tomorrow crede che le scorte non bastino fino a domani (colloquial) pensiamo che presto il tempo cambierà = we believe that soon the weather will change pensiamo che presto il tempo cambi (colloquial)

9.2 SUBJUNCTIVE PAST TENSE The past tense of subjunctive (imperfetto) is used when the action expressed in a conditional sentence is not sure: if I came...; in the case you went...; should he call...; etc. Since conditional sentences will be discussed in paragraph 10.1, after having introduced conditional tenses, only the part of the sentence needing subjunctive will be shown in this page. CONGIUNTIVO IMPERFETTO (past subjunctive) singular

1st person 2nd person 3rd person 1st person 2nd person 3rd person 1st person 2nd person 3rd person

----- 1st conjugation ----(that) I washed (that) you washed (sing.) (that) he/she washed ----- 2nd conjugation ----(that) I took (che io) prendessi (that) you took (sing.) (che tu) prendessi (che egli / ella) prendesse (that) he/she took ----- 3rd conjugation ----(that) I opened (che io) aprissi (that) you opened (sing.) (che tu) aprissi (that) he/she opened (che egli / ella) aprisse (che io) lavassi (che tu) lavassi (che egli / ella) lavasse

plural

(che noi) lavassimo (che voi) lavaste (che essi / esse) lavassero

(that) we washed (that) you washed (pl.) (that) they washed

(that) we took (che noi) prendessimo (that) you took (pl.) (che voi) prendeste (che essi / esse) prendessero (that) they took (che noi) aprissimo (che voi) apriste (che essi) aprissero

(that) we opened (that) you opened (pl.) (that) they opened

A first consideration is that the inflection of the third singular person is not exactly as the first two, since it changes the last vowel into e.

A second observation is that also the first plural person has stress on the antipenultimate syllable (lavàssimo, prendèssimo, aprìssimo), in the same way as the third plural persons usually have. se io lavassi il cane... = if I washed the dog... nel caso prendeste l'autobus... = in the case you (plural) took the bus... se aprissero la porta... = if they opened the door... Past subjunctive is only required when the other part of the sentence uses a conditional tense. The difference will be easy to understand focusing these examples (by now, disregard the conditional inflection): se mi incontri, ti inviterò a pranzo = if you meet me, I will invite you to lunch (no subjunctive required: present indicative for "meet", future for "will invite") se mi incontrassi, ti inviterei a pranzo = if you met me, I would invite you to lunch (past subjunctive required for "met", conditional required for "would invite")

volete che io rimanga = you (plural) want me to stay (literally: "you want that I stay") (as explained in paragraph 9.1, present indicative for "want", present subjunctive for "stay") vorreste che io rimanessi = you would like me to stay (literally: "you would like that I stayed") (past subjunctive required for "would like", conditional required for "stay") Further examples will be shown in paragraph 10.1.

9.3 SUBJUNCTIVE PRESENT AND PAST TENSES OF VERBS ESSERE AND AVERE These are the tables of the same subjunctive tenses discussed in the previous two paragraphs. Take your time to learn them, since they will be required for the two compound tenses which will be discussed in the following paragraph. Besides being auxiliary verbs, though, they may be also used alone, according to the same rules explained in paragraphs 9.1 and 9.2.

~ ESSERE ~ CONGIUNTIVO PRESENTE (present subjunctive) singular plural 1st person (che io) sia (that) I are (che noi) siamo (that) we are 2nd person (che tu) sia (that) you are (sing.) (che voi) siate (that) you are (pl.) 3rd person (che egli / ella) sia (that) he/she is (che essi / esse) siano (that) they are

CONGIUNTIVO IMPERFETTO (past subjunctive) singular plural 1st person (che io) fossi (that) I were (che noi) fossimo (that) we were 2nd person (che tu) fossi (that) you were (sing.) (che voi) foste (that) you were (pl.) 3rd person (che egli / ella) fosse (that) he/she were (che essi / esse) fossero (that) they were

~ AVERE ~ CONGIUNTIVO PRESENTE (present subjunctive) singular plural 1st person (che io) abbia (that) I have (che noi) abbiamo (that) we have 2nd person (che tu) abbia (that) you have (sing.) (che voi) abbiate (that) you have (pl.) 3rd person (che egli / ella) abbia (that) he/she has (che essi / esse) abbiano (that) they have CONGIUNTIVO IMPERFETTO (past subjunctive) singular plural 1st person (che io) avessi (that) I had (che noi) avessimo (that) we had 2nd person (che tu) avessi (that) you had (sing.) (che voi) aveste (that) you had (pl.) 3rd person (che egli / ella) avesse (that) he/she had (che essi / esse) avessero (that) they had

A few samples of their use: credo che tu abbia la febbre = I think that you have a fever (notice how a personal pronoun is needed in this case, because abbia may be referred to any singular person). credevo che tu avessi la febbre = I thought that you had a fever (same as above, but in the past). vive bene, nonostante sia povero = he lives well, despite he is poor (notice how a personal pronoun is not really needed in this case, because the verb of the primary clause, vive, is clearly a third singular person). viveva bene, nonostante fosse povero = he lived well, despite he was poor (same as above, but in the past). Past subjunctive is only required when the other part of the sentence uses a conditional tense. The difference will be easy to understand focusing these examples (by now, disregard the conditional inflection): se mi incontri, ti inviterò a pranzo = if you meet me, I will invite you to lunch (no subjunctive required: present indicative for "meet", future for "will invite") se mi incontrassi, ti inviterei a pranzo = if you met me, I would invite you to lunch (past subjunctive required for "met", conditional required for "would invite")

volete che io rimanga = you (plural) want me to stay (literally: "you want that I stay") (as explained in paragraph 9.1, present indicative for "want", present subjunctive for "stay") vorreste che io rimanessi = you would like me to stay (literally: "you would like that I stayed") (past subjunctive required for "would like", conditional required for "stay") Further examples will be shown in paragraph 9.4.

9.4 SUBJUNCTIVE PERFECT AND PLUPERFECT TENSES These two compound tenses express the same concepts as the simple ones, but in the past. So, a few examples are:

"I don't know what he does", requiring a present subjunctive; "I don't know what he did", requiring a past subjunctive; "I don't know what he has done", requiring a perfect subjunctive; "I don't know what he had done", requiring a pluperfect subjunctive. Since past subjunctive is also used for subordinate clauses in conditional sentences (see paragraph 9.2), pluperfect subjunctive is used for the same kind of clause in the past: "if you came..." requires a past subjunctive; "if you had come..." requires a pluperfect subjunctive. These compound tenses are made in the same way as the indicative ones (auxiliary verb + past participle of the main verb), though the two auxiliaries essere and avere use subjunctive inflections. CONGIUNTIVO PASSATO (perfect subjunctive) singular

plural

(che noi) abbiamo lavato (che voi) abbiate lavato (che essi / esse) abbiano lavato

(that) we have washed (that) you have washed (pl.) (that) they have washed

1st person 2nd person 3rd person

----- 1st conjugation ----(that) I have washed (che io) abbia lavato (that) you have washed (sing.) (che tu) abbia lavato (che egli / ella) abbia lavato (that) he/she has washed ----- 2nd conjugation ----(that) I have taken (che io) abbia preso (that) you have taken (sing.) (che tu) abbia preso (that) he/she has taken (che egli/ella) abbia preso

(che noi) abbiamo preso (che voi) abbiate preso (che essi / esse) abbiano preso

(that) we have taken (that) you have taken (pl.) (that) they have taken

1st person 2nd person 3rd person

----- 3rd conjugation ----(that) I have opened (che io) abbia aperto (that) you have opened (sing.) (che tu) abbia aperto (che egli/ ella) abbia aperto (that) he/she has opened

(che noi) abbiamo aperto (che voi) abbiate aperto (che essi / esse) abbiano aperto

(that) we have opened (that) you have opened (pl.) (that) they have opened

1st person 2nd person 3rd person

CONGIUNTIVO TRAPASSATO (pluperfect subjunctive) singular

plural

1st person 2nd person 3rd person

----- 1st conjugation ----(that) I have washed (che io) avessi lavato (that) you have washed (sing.) (che tu) avessi lavato (che egli / ella) avesse lavato (that) he/she has washed ----- 2nd conjugation ----(that) I have taken (che io) avessi preso (that) you have taken (sing.) (che tu) avessi preso (che egli / ella) avesse preso (that) he/she has taken

1st person 2nd person

----- 3rd conjugation ----(that) I have opened (that) you have opened (sing.)

(che noi) avessimo aperto (che voi) aveste aperto

(that) he/she has opened

(che essi / esse) avessero aperto (that) they have opened

1st person 2nd person 3rd person

3rd person

(che io) avessi aperto (che tu) avessi aperto (che egli / ella) avesse aperto

(che noi) avessimo lavato (che voi) aveste lavato (che essi / esse) avessero lavato

(that) we have washed (that) you have washed (pl.) (that) they have washed

(che noi) avessimo preso (che voi) aveste preso (che essi / esse) avessero preso

(that) we have taken (that) you have taken (pl.) (that) they have taken (that) we have opened (that) you have opened (pl.)

se (io) lavassi il cane... = if I washed the dog... nel caso (voi) prendeste l'autobus... = in the case you (plural) took the bus... se (esse) aprissero la porta... = if they (feminine) opened the door... Past subjunctive is only required when the other part of the sentence uses a conditional tense. The difference will be easy to understand focusing these examples (by now, disregard the conditional inflection): se (tu) mi incontri, (io) ti inviterò a pranzo = if you meet me, I will invite you to lunch (no subjunctive required: present indicative for "meet", future for "will invite")

se (tu) mi incontrassi, (io) ti inviterei a pranzo = if you met me, I would invite you to lunch (past subjunctive required for "met", conditional required for "would invite")

(voi) volete che (io) rimanga = you (plural) want me to stay (literally: "you want that I stay") (as explained in paragraph 9.1, present indicative for "want", present subjunctive for "stay") (voi) vorreste che (io) rimanessi = you would like me to stay (literally: "you would like that I stayed") (past subjunctive required for "would like", conditional required for "stay")

9.5 SUBJUNCTIVE PERFECT AND PLUPERFECT OF VERBS ESSERE AND AVERE These are the tables of the same subjunctive tenses discussed in the previous two paragraphs. Take your time to learn them, since they will be required for the two compound tenses which will be discussed in the following paragraph. Besides being auxiliary verbs, though, they may be also used alone, according to the same rules explained in paragraphs 9.1 and 9.2. ~ ESSERE ~ CONGIUNTIVO PASSATO (perfect subjunctive) singular (che io) sia stato (that) I have been (che io) sia stata (che tu) sia stato (that) you have been (sing.) (che tu) sia stata (che egli) sia stato (that) he/she has been (che ella) sia stata

1st 2nd 3rd

plural (che noi) siamo stati (che noi) siamo state (che voi) siate stati (che voi) siate state (che) essi siano stati (che esse) siano state

(that) we have been (that) you have been (pl.) (that) they have been

CONGIUNTIVO TRAPASSATO (pluperfect subjunctive) 1st 2nd 3rd

singular (che io) fossi stato (that) I had been (che io) fossi stata (che tu) fossi stato (that) you had been (sing.) (che tu) fossi stata (che egli) fosse stato (that) he/she had been (che ella) fosse stata

plural (che) noi fossimo stati (that) we had been (che noi) fossimo state (che) voi foste stati (that) you had been (pl.) (che voi) foste state (che essi) fossero stati (that) they had been (che esse) fossero state

~ AVERE ~ CONGIUNTIVO PASSATO (perfect subjunctive) 1st 2nd 3rd

singular (that) I have been (che io) abbia avuto (that) you have been (s.) (che tu) abbia avuto (che egli / ella) abbia avuto (that) he/she has been

plural (che noi) abbiamo avuto (che voi) abbiate avuto (che essi / esse) abbiano avuto

(that) we have been (that) you have been (p.) (that) they have been

CONGIUNTIVO TRAPASSATO (pluperfect subjunctive) 1st 2nd 3rd

singular (that) I had been (che io) avessi avuto (that) you had been (s.) (che tu) avessi avuto (che egli / ella) avesse avuto (that) he/she had been

plural (che noi) avessimo avuto (che voi) aveste avuto (che essi / esse) avessero avuto

(that) we had been (that) you had been (p.) (that) they had been

Subjunctive uses the same rules as indicative tenses: • transitive verbs use auxiliary avere, most intransitive ones use essere; • when the auxiliary verb is essere, past participles are gender- and number-sentive. EXAMPLES . . . . . . . verb comprare = to buy (transitive, using auxiliary avere) non sappiamo chi abbia comprato il giornale = we don't know who bougth the newspaper (literally: ...who has bought the newspaper) non sapevamo chi avesse comprato il giornale = we didn't know who had bought the newspaper se tu avessi comprato il giornale... = if you had bought the newspaper... (or had you bought the newspaper...)

. . . . . . . verb partire = to leave (intransitive, using auxiliary essere) credi che Paolo e Marco siano partiti? = do you think that Paul and Mark have left? credevi che Paolo e Marco fossero partiti? = did you think that Paul and Mark had left? se Paolo e Marco fossero partiti... = if Paul and Mark had left...

. . . . . . . verb rìdere = to laugh (intransitive, though using auxiliary avere) pensa che abbiano riso = he/she thinks that they laughed pensava che avessero riso = he/she thought that they had laughed se avessero riso... = if they had laughed... (or had they laughed...)

10.1 DIMINUTIVE Some suffixes can be used with nouns, to indicate that they are small, large or bad. They are all gender- and number-sensitive, so they have to match the noun's own gender and number. This page will discuss diminutive. Some inflections indicate that the noun is generically small, in most cases referring to its actual size, but sometimes having a more metaphoric sense (i.e. "cute", "refined", etc). The two most common diminutive suffixes are -ino / -ina and -etto / -etta. uccello = bird uccellino = little bird uccelletto = little bird strada = road stradina = small or narrow road stradetta = small or narrow road ragazzi = boys ragazzini = small boys, children ragazzetti = small boys, children palle = balls palline = small balls pallette = small balls Some nouns, among which the above-mentioned examples, may use both inflections. Other nouns, though, usually follow only one of the two. The other form would either sound very unusual, or even wrong, because it may have a bad sound, or sometimes it may have a different meaning. gatto = cat gattino = small cat, kitten (never "gattetto", which would sound horrible) muro = wall muretto = small or low wall (the form "murino" is an adjective referring to mice!) borsa = bag borsetta = small bag, lady's bag (the form "borsina" is very unusual) pezzo = piece pezzetto = small piece ("pezzino" is very unusual) If you are in doubt, the inflection ...etto is the most common of the two, and with few exceptions it may be used even in those cases where ...ino is preferred.

There is also a third suffix for diminutive, -ello / -ella, used with a fewer number of words. albero = tree alberello = small tree asino = donkey asinello = small, young donkey

porzione (feminine) = portion porzioncina = small portion Usually, words which take -ello may not take -ino or -etto as an alternative.

When the noun's singular inflection is ...e (which may be either masculine or feminine), the suffix behaves as if the noun ended with ...o (for masculine) or ...a (for feminine): rete (feminine) = net retina = small or thin net dolore (masculine) = pain doloretto = slight pain lume (masculine) = lamp lumetto = small lamp chiave (feminine) = key chiavetta = small key It is very important to match the noun's gender, because in some cases the other gender has a completely different meaning: casa (feminine) = house casetta (or casina) = little house ...BUT casino = brothel (slang) So gender can really make a big difference!! For this reason, in forming diminutives the original noun's gender should always remain unchanged: pezzo (masculine) = piece, fragment pezza (feminine) = cloth, fabric, rag ...therefore pezzetto = small piece pezzetta = small piece of cloth

For some nouns, diminutive forms are not made by simply adding the two suffixes, but require a lengthening of the noun's root (additional parts are shown in lighter blue). cuore (masculine) = heart cuoricino = small heart (the form "cuorino" does not exist) cane (masculine) = dog cagnolino = little dog (the form "canino" is the adjective referring to a dog, or the name of the canine tooth) porzione (feminine) = portion porzioncina = small portion vento = wind venticello = slight wind, breeze There is no fixed rule for lengthening the root of the noun, when this is required, but in many cases (see previous examples) -ic- is added before the ordinary suffix.

Some nouns are actual diminutives, although they are considered as individual words because of their meaning, in which a different idea than that of "small size" may be expressed. In this case, their gender does not necessarily match.

gallo (masculine) = rooster gallina (feminine) = chicken (i.e. "small rooster") spazzola (feminine) = brush spazzolino (masculine) = tooth-brush (i.e. "small brush") pane = bread panino = sandwich (i.e. "small bread") carro (masculine) = chariot carrello (masculine) = trolley carretto (masculine) = cart Students should be well aware of the fact that some nouns end with ...ino, ...etto, and similar inflections, without being diminutives at all. For many of these "false diminutive nouns", other words phonetically corresponding to their non-diminutive form may exist, but they often have a different gender, and their meaning is usually completely different: pulce (feminine) = flea pulcino (masculine) = chick canto (masculine) = song, singing cantina (feminine) = cellar desto, desta = awake (adjective) destino (masculine) = destiny, fate casta (feminine) = social rank castello (masculine) = castle pasto (masculine) = meal pastello (masculine) = crayon For several words such as the ones above (especially with -ello) a non-diminutive form does not even exist: pisello = pea ("piso" does not exist) cancello = gate ("cancio" does not exist) catino = tub ("cato" does not exist) giardino = garden ("giardo" does not exist) All these nouns can be misleading, so care should be taken not to misunderstand them. However, these words too may take a real diminutive suffix, thus appearing as "double diminutives": cancello = gate cancelletto = small gate catino = tub catinella (notice the change of gender) = small tub gallina = hen gallinella = small hen Very few nouns allow a real "double diminutive": pezzo = piece pezzetto = small piece pezzettino = (very) small piece

boccia = flask, decanter boccetta = small bottle or flask boccettina = tiny bottle, vial

There is another diminutive suffix, -uccio / -uccia, which is used with a limited number of nouns, because rather than "small" it usually carries a meaning of "humble, poor, cheap", especially when -ino, -etto, or ello can be also used with the same word. vestito = dress vestituccio = humble, cheap dress in contrast with vestitino = small, cute dress cavallo = horse cavalluccio = toy horse, hobby-horse in contrast with cavallino = young, cute horse bottega = shop, workshop botteguccia = humble, small shop This suffix does not often occur in spoken language now, but it may still be found in written texts. For an even more limited number of words, a further diminutive suffix is -uolo / -uola, which has become rather obsolete, since in most cases the common ones already discussed may be used, and are now preferred in common speech: chiesa = church chiesuola = small church (obsolete, but sometimes found in written texts) chiesetta = (same as above, currently used) laccio = boot-lace, bind lacciuolo = small lace, or metaphorically a limitation (obsolete) laccetto = (same as above, currently used) donna = church donnicciuola = trivial woman, or sissy (referred to a male person) donnetta = (same as above, now more common than the previous form)

synopsis of diminutive suffixes masculine singular

feminine singular

masculine plural

feminine plural

-ino

-ina

-ini

-ine

-etto

-etta

-etti

-ette

-ello

-ella

-elli

-elle

less

common

suffixes

-uccio

-uccia

-ucci

-ucce

-uolo

-uola

-uoli

-uole

10.2 AUGMENTATIVE Augmentative indicates that the noun is large, big, great, etc., more often in the sense of "large size", but sometimes with the meaning of "important" too. There is only one augmentative inflection: -one / -ona (plurals -oni / -one). Notice how the masculine singular and the feminine plural are the same (-one). martello (hammer) ~ martellone (big hammer) martelli (hammers) ~ martelloni (big hammers) piede (masculine, foot) ~ piedone (big foot) piedi (feet) ~ piedoni (big feet) palazzo (building) ~ palazzone (tall, large building) palazzi (buildings) ~ palazzoni (tall, large buildings) ruota (wheel) ~ ruotona (large wheel) ruote (wheels) ~ ruotone (large wheels) chiave (feminine, key) ~ chiavona (large key) chiavi (keys) ~ chiavone (large keys) borsa (bag, handbag) ~ borsona (large bag) borse (bags, handbags) ~ borsone (large bags) It is important to know the simple form of nouns (in particular whether they are masculine or feminine), otherwise it could be difficult to tell if a given augmentative is masculine singular or feminine plural. For instance, nasone and casone sound similar, although the former is singular (from naso, nose), and the latter is plural (from case, houses). Obviously, when augmentative is used within a sentence, the article and often the verb too will help to tell both gender and number: il nasone = the big book (singular, masculine) le casone = the big houses (plural, feminine) However, since augmentative gives the noun a meaning of "big, large, huge", etc., especially in common speech the great majority of feminine nouns changes gender when this suffix is appended. For instance: la faccia = the face (feminine) ...BUT il faccione = the large face (masculine) la pistola = the gun (feminine) ...BUT il pistolone = the big gun (masculine) la stanza = the room (feminine) ...BUT lo stanzone = the big room (masculine) la pietra = the stone (feminine) ...BUT il pietrone = the big stone, the rock (masculine) This is only apparently confusing: in fact, the opportunity of turning almost every plural augmentative into masculin gender, helps to avoid any risk of doubt whether the noun is masculine singular or feminine plural. The beginner student might think of this as:

masculine singular, -one masculine plural, -oni used as the standard augmentative

feminine singular, -ona feminine plural, -one only used in limited cases

In spoken language, feminine plural augmentative changes to masculine for a cultural reason, i.e. something big, huge, tall, etc. would sound "more masculine than feminine", especially when the large size gives the word a rougher, less delicate meaning. However, feminine plural augmentative does exist. For this reason, some nouns may have both forms, although the feminine one is less used than the masculine. la pietra = the stone (feminine) la pietrona = the big stone (feminine) il pietrone = the big stone (masculine, sounds rougher, heavier, etc.) la finestra = the window (feminine) la finestrona = the big window (feminine) il finestrone = the huge window (masculine, sounds wider) la donna = the woman (feminine) la donnona = the tall / fat lady (feminine) il donnone = the mighty / fat lady (masculine, sounds more stout and heavy) la corda = the string, the rope (feminine) la cordona = the thick rope (feminine) il cordone = the thick / braided rope (masculine, sounds thicker) la spada = the sword (feminine) la spadona = the big sword (feminine) lo spadone = the big sword (masculine, sounds longer and heavier) Virtually, any feminine noun may be turned into masculine when using augmentative. There are also several words which were born as augmentatives, but achieved their own individual meaning, such as: la mela = the apple (feminine) il melone = the melon (i.e. "big apple", masculine) la porta = the door of a room (feminine) il portone = the entrance, the door of a building (i.e. "large door", masculine) la tromba = the trumpet (feminine) il trombone = the trombone (i.e. "big trumpet", masculine) la palla = the ball (feminine) il pallone = the balloon, or the foot-ball (i.e. "big ball", masculine) la copia = the copy il copione = the (printed) script of a film, a play, etc. Finally, there are several words which only resemble augmentatives, not having any relation with the noun they seem to derive from, or not having such form at all: matto = the madman mattone (masculine) = the brick canto = song, singing cantone (masculine) = corner of a street pista = the race track, or trail pistone (masculine) = piston

occasione (feminine) = occasion, opportunity canzone (feminine) = song pressione (feminine) = pressure carbone (masculine) = coal stazione (feminine) = station situazione (feminine) = situation These words may be regarded as "false augmentatives".

10.3 PEJORATIVE Pejorative gives the noun a sense of "bad, nasty, ugly", etc. There is only one pejorative inflection: -accio / -accia (plurals -acci / -acce). tavolo (table) ~ tavolaccio (old, broken table) errore (masculine, mistake) ~ erroraccio (bad mistake) libri (books) ~ libracci (cheap / evil books) vita (life) ~ vitaccia (hard life) bicicletta (bycicle) ~ biciclettaccia (cheap bycicle) scarpe (feminine, shoes) ~ scarpacce (horrible / worn out shoes) roba (stuff, things) ~ robaccia (trivia / nasty stuff) posti (places) ~ postacci (bad places) momento (moment) ~ momentaccio (bad moment) tempo (weather) ~ tempaccio (bad weather) A fewer number of nouns may use pejorative than the ones which may use diminutive or augmentative. Also in this case, beware of "false pejorative" words: abbraccio = hug impaccio = difficulty, straits traccia = trace, trail

11.1 ADJECTIVES RELATED TO GEOGRAPHIC SITES Adjectives expressing a relation with geographic sites such as towns, regions and countries use suffixes, very similar to the English ones, with only a few differences. It is important to notice how in Italian all adjectives referring to countries do not use a capital (uppercase) letter, as they do in English. Also notice that when names are made of two separate words (i.e. New Zealand, South Korea, etc.), the relevant Italian adjective often merges them into one word.

A common standard suffix is -ano, corresponding to the English suffix -an, used in many cases (though not so frequently as in English): Italia (Italy) >> italiano (Italian) Roma (Rome) >> romano (roman) Venezia (Venice) >> veneziano (venetian) Sicilia (Sicily) >> siciliano (sicilian) America (America) >> americano (American) Corea del Sud (South Korea) >> sudcoreano (South Korean) ...etc. etc. In some cases, the suffix becomes -tano (a "t" is added), and the root of the word might slightly change too: Napoli (Naples) >> napoletano (neapolitan) Amalfi (Amalfi, small island near Naples) >> amalfitano (from Amalfi) Another very common suffix is -ese, often matching the same English one (but not always): Milano (Milan) >> milanese (milanese) Rimini (Rimini) >> riminese (from Rimini) Calabria (Calabria region) >> calabrese (from Calabria) Francia (France) >> francese (French) Malta (Malta) >> maltese (Maltese) Islanda (Iceland) >> islandese (Icelandic) Cina (China) >> cinese (Chinese) Giappone (Japan) >> giapponese (Japanese) Canada (Canada) >> canadese (Canadian) ...etc. etc. In a few cases, an "n" is added to the suffix: Parma (Parma, northern Italian city) >> parmense (from Parma) Stati Uniti (United States) >> statunitense (from the US) Nicaragua (Nicaragua) >> nicaraguense (Nicaraguan) Panama (Panama) >> panamense (Panamese) Costa Rica (Costa Rica) >> costaricense (from Costa Rica) Some adjectives ending with -ese slightly change the noun's root before the suffix; this happens more often than with -ano: Svezia (Sweden) >> svedese (Swedish) Inghilterra (England) >> inglese (English) Scozia (Scotland) >> scozzese (Scottish) Portogallo (Portugal) >> portoghese (Portuguese) Nuova Zelanda (New Zealand) >> neozelandese (New Zealander) Londra (London) >> londinese (Londoner) Another suffix which matches English -an is -ino:

Tunisia (Tunisia) >> tunisino (Tunisian) Marocco (Morocco) >> marocchino (Moroccan) Argentina (Argentina) >> argentino (Argentinean) Parigi (Paris) >> parigino (Parisian) Ginevra (Geneve) >> ginevrino (from Geneve) A few adjectives use suffix -eno: Cile (Chile) >> cileno (Chilean) Armenia (Armenia) >> armeno (Armenian) Iraq (Iraq) >> iracheno (Iraqi) A very similar suffix is -egno (derived from the Spanish -eño), for two adjectives referring to Central American countries: Ecuador (Ecuador) >> ecuadoregno (Ecuadorean) El Salvador (El Salvador) >> salvadoregno (Salvadorean) A less common suffix is -ico, in some cases matching the English suffix -ic: Arabia (Arabia) >> arabico, but also arabo (Arabic) Libia (Lybia) >> libico (Lybian) Caucasia (Caucasia) >> caucasico (caucasian) NOTE - arabico is used for geographic names which refer to Arabia as a land (i.e. deserto arabico = Arabic desert); arabo instead refers to language and culture (i.e. lingua araba = Arabic language; cultura araba = Arabic culture; etc.) A few changes may occur to the root of the noun when the adjective keeps the old form from Latin: Gran Bretagna (Great Britain) >> britannico from Latin Britannia, (British) A particular suffix is -olo, used in a few cases: Spagna (Spain) >> spagnolo (Spanish) Romagna (Romagna region) >> romagnolo (from Romagna) Another particular suffix is -iota, used in a rather limited number of cases: Cipro (Cyprus) >> cipriota (from Cyprus) Kenya (Kenya) >> keniota (Kenian) For a number of adjectives, the suffix is simply -o: Russia (Russia) >> russo (Russian) Grecia (Greece) >> greco (Greek) Iugoslavia (Yugoslavia) >> iugoslavo (Yugoslavian) Argentina (Argentina) >> argentino (Argentinean) Turchia (Turkey) >> turco (Turk) Repubblica Ceca (Czech Republic) >> ceco (Czech, not to be confused with cieco = blind) Also in this case the root of the noun may change: Croazia (Croatia) >> croato (Croatian) Slovenia (Slovenia) >> sloveno (Slovenian) For others, the suffix is lengthened in -acco: Polonia (Poland) >> polacco (Polish) Slovacchia (Slovakia) >> slovacco (Slovak) And -one is also used in a few cases: Estonia (Poland) >> estone (Estonian) Lapponia (Slovakia) >> lappone (Laplandic) Lettonia (Latvia) >> lettone (Latvian) (for the pronounciation of these adjectives, see further down).

Finally, for some countries adjectives are specific, since they use a non-standard suffix: Lazio (Latium region) >> laziale (from Latium) Belgio (Belgium) >> belga (Belgian)

A totally different adjective is used in the following case: Germania (Germany) >> tedesco (German)

As for pronounciation, most adjectives carry stress on their antepenutimate syllable (i.e. on the first vowel of the suffix): • (-ano) italiàno; romàno; • (-ese) francése; inglése; (with acute accented "e") • (-ense) statunitènse (notice how "e" turns to a grave accent) • (-ino) tunisìno; marocchìno; • (-eno) cilèno; rumèno; • (-egno) ecuadorègno; salvadorègno; • (-olo) spagnòlo; romagnòlo; • (-acco) polàcco; slovàcco; ...BUT • (-iota) these adjectives carry stress on vowel "o": cipriòta; keniòta; etc.; • (-ico) these adjectives carry stress on the antepenultimate syllable: lìbico; britànnico; etc. • (-one) also these adjectives are stressed on the antepenultimate syllable: lèttone; èstone; • (-o) these adjectives carry stress on the penultimate syllable (i.e. on the last vowel before the suffix): rùsso; tùrco; grèco; etc. etc. Adjectives with non-standard prefixes do not follow a given rule; in most cases the stressed syllable is the penultimate: laziàle; tedésco; bèlga; etc.

Summarizing suffixes and accents in a table, for easier learning: (standard suffixes) .....àno .....ése .....ènse .....ìno .....èno .....ègno .....òlo .....àcco .....-iòta .....`.ico (non-standard suffixes) ......`..

Obviously, as any other adjective, also these ones need to match both gender and number of the noun to which they are referred (see paragraphs 2.1 to 2.3). Adjectives whose singular form ends with -e, are both masculine and feminine; this is also true for the very few ones whose last vowel is -a in both genders. sono romano (I am roman, masculine); sono romana (I am roman, feminine); siamo romani (we are roman, masculine); siamo romane (we are roman, feminine) sono francese (I am French, both masculine and feminine) siamo francesi (we are French, both masculine and feminine) sono statunitense (I am from the US, both masculine and feminine) siamo statunitensi (we are from the US, both masculine and feminine) sono tunisino (I am Tunisian, masculine); sono tunisina (I am Tunisian, feminine); siamo tunisini (we are Tunisian, masculine); siamo tunisine (we are Tunisian, feminine) sono armeno (I am Armenian, masculine); sono armena (I am Armenian, feminine);

siamo armeni (we are Armenian, masculine); siamo armene (we are Armenian, feminine) sono britannico (I am British, masculine); sono britannica (I am British, feminine); siamo britannici (we are British, masculine); siamo britanniche (we are British, feminine) sono cipriota (I am from Cyprus, both masculine and feminine); siamo ciprioti (we are from Cyprus, masculine); siamo cipriote (we are from Cyprus, feminine) sono croato (I am Croatian, masculine); sono croata (I am Croatian, feminine); siamo croati (we are Croatian, masculine); siamo croate (we are Croatian, feminine) sono belga (I am Belgian, both masculine and feminine); siamo belgi (we are Belgian, masculine); siamo belghe (we are Belgian, feminine) sono tedesco (I am German, masculine); sono tedesca (I am German, feminine); siamo tedeschi (we are German, masculine); siamo tedesche (we are German, feminine)

For cities which keep their foreign names (Kiev, Tucson, Helsinki, etc.), the use of prepositions is usually preferred to a suffix. Simple prepositions di (of, from) and da (from) are used in these cases: è di Phoenix (he/she is from Phoenix) or viene da Phoenix (he/she comes from Phoenix) siamo di Valencia (we are from Valencia) or veniamo da Valencia (we come from Valencia) However, with names of famous and larger cities (especially the ones whose name has an Italian version), an adjective is also commonly used: sei di Londra (you are from London) or sei londinese (you are a londoner) sei di Parigi (you are from Paris) or sei parigino sei di Berlino (you are from Berlin) or sei berlinese When it comes to countries, a suffix may be used in all cases, but prepositions too may be often used, especially in case of uncertainty about which is the right adjective. In this case, though, a compound preposition is needed (see paragraph 5.2): their use with geographic names is discussed in paragraph 11.3.

11.2 MORE ABOUT GEOGRAPHIC NAMES It should be noticed that the Italian names of geographic regions countries have a definite gender, and in most cases require a definite article, unlike English ones. Some are masculine, while some others are feminine, which of the two depending on the last vowel of the name. Names ending with ...o and ...i are usually masculine: Lazio (Latium region); Belgio (Belgium); Marocco (Morocco); Regno Unito (United Kingdom); etc. Stati Uniti (United States); Emirati Arabi Uniti (United Arab Emirates); etc. notice how only the noun's inflection has been highlighted in red (i.e. States, Emirates), not the adjective's, which simply matches the noun both for gender and number Names ending with ...a are usually feminine: Alsazia (Alsace region); Borgogna (Burgundy region); Italia (Italy); Francia (France); Spagna (Spain); etc. Names ending with ...e can be either masculine or feminine, according to whether they are singular (masculine) or plural (feminine): masculine (with very few wxceptions) Brasile (Brazil); Piemonte (Piedmont region); Artide e Antartide (Arctica and Antarctica); etc.

feminine Filippine (Philippines); Azzorre (Azores); etc. NOTE - plural geographic names ending with "e" usually refer to the noun isole = islands, simply omitted. For regions and countries whose names end with a consonant, because they keep their foreign name, a masculine gender is usually adopted, except for names referring to groups of islands (see note above): masculine (singular) Liechtenstein; Kansas; Yorkshire; Pakistan; Madagascar (single island, thus masculine); etc. Therefore: il Liechtenstein, il Kansas, lo Yorkshire, etc. feminine (plural) Mauritius; Seichelles; Shetland; etc. (all names referring to isole = islands) Therefore: le Mauritius, le Seichelles, etc. In the same way, if a name refers to a natural feature, such as a desert, a river, an ocean, etc. it keeps the same feature's gender. The word referring to the feature itself, instead, in many cases may be omitted. fiume (masculine) = river il fiume Tevere; il Tevere = the (river) Tiber il fiume Volga; il Volga = the (river) Volga il fiume Isar; l'Isar = the (river) Isar il fiume Tamigi; il Tamigi = the (river) Thames For very few rivers whose name suggests a feminine gender (Italian ones, and no more than two or three famous non-Italian ones), an exception is made: la Dora Baltea (feminine) = the Dora Baltea ...BUT il fiume Dora Baltea = the river Dora Baltea la Senna (feminine) = the Seine ...BUT il fiume Senna = the river Seine mare (masculine) = sea NOTE - in given names, the word mare is phonetically shortened to mar; this is not a rule, but it is the most common form used, both in spoken and written language. il mar Mediterraneo; il Mediterraneo = the Mediterranean (Sea) il mar Ionio; il Mediterraneo = the Ionian (Sea) il mar Baltico; il Baltico = the Baltic (Sea) il mar Baltico; il Baltico = the Baltic (Sea) When the adjective alone might be mistaken (Red Sea, Dead Sea), or in compound names (Sea of Japan, etc.) the word for sea is always required. In compound names, mare is often used in full. il mar Nero = the Black Sea il mar Morto = the Dead Sea il mar (or mare) del Giappone = the Sea of Japan il mar (or mare) dei Caraibi = the Caribbean Sea il mar (or mare) del Nord = the North Sea oceano (masculine) = ocean l'Oceano Atlantico; l'Atlantico = the Atlantic (0cean) l'Oceano Pacifico; il Pacifico = the Pacific (0cean) l'Oceano Indiano (only form used) = the Indian 0cean monte (masculine) = mountain, hill il Monte Bianco; il Bianco = the Mont Blanc il Monte Everest; l'Everest = Mount Everest, the Everest

il Monte Olimpo; l'Olimpo = Mount Olympus, the Olympus il Monte K2; il K2 = the K2

11.3 ARTICLES AND PREPOSITIONS WITH GEOGRAPHIC NAMES CONTINENTS, COUNTRIES AND REGIONS When speaking of a country, a region, a continent, etc., in Italian a definite article is usually required (while in English this does not happen). Names such as France, China, India, Europe, America etc. in Italian are referred to as "the France", "the China", "the India", "the Europe", "the America", etc. The article is affected by the name's gender and number, according to the same rules followed by any other noun (see paragraph 2.4). Continents, countries, states, regions, etc. are more often given a masculine gender, despite the names end with different vowels, or even with a consonant (original names). il Messico = Mexico il Vaticano = the Vatican il Colorado il Giappone = Japan lo Zimbabwe il Mississippi il Malawi il Laos il Bahrain l'Ecuador l'Iraq (plural nouns) gli Stati Uniti = the United States gli Emirati Arabi = the Arab Emirates The names whose last vowel is -a are usually feminine. l'Italia = Italy la Corea = Korea l'Argentina la Bielorussia = Belarus la Nuova Zelanda = New Zealand l'Europa = Europe l'Asia l'Oceania la Sardegna = Sardinia la Virginia (feminine plural nouns, always referred to groups of islands) le Filippine = the Philippines le Barbados = Barbados (Islands) le Fiji = Fiji (Islands) But when a name is the original one, it may sometimes be masculine, despite the final -a. il Canada lo Sri Lanka il Nebraska il Nevada Few countries, among which very small ones, reject the article: Taiwan Hong Kong Andorra

San Marino Samoa Singapore They are almost treated as city names rather than country names, as shown in these examples: vengono dalla Malesia = they come from Malaysia ...BUT vengono da Singapore = they come from Singapore il governo della Slovenia = the government of Slovenia ...BUT il governo di San Marino = the government of San Marino dalla Thailandia al Vietnam = from Thailand to Vietnam ...BUT da Taiwan a Hong Kong = from Taiwan to Hong Kong la capitale della Spagna = Spain's capital ...BUT la capitale di Andorra = Andorra's capital

The names of countries, continents and regions always require prepositions to be compound (preposition + article). Only preposition in, as an exception, causes the article to be dropped. il Piemonte = Piedmont (region) la Germania = Germany (country) with prepositions: with prepositions: del Piemonte = Piedmont's, of Piedmont della Germania = Germany's, of Germany, German al Piemonte = to Piedmont alla Germania = to Germany dal Piemonte = from Piedmont dalla Germania = from Germany col Piemonte = with Piedmont con la Germania = with Germany sul Piemonte = about Piedmont, over Piedmont sulla Germania = about Germany, over Germany per la Germania = for Germany per il Piemonte = for Piedmont tra la Germania = between Germany tra il Piemonte = between Piedmont fra la Germania = between Germany fra il Piemonte = between Piedmont ...BUT ...BUT in Germania = in Germany in Piemonte = in Piedmont In the same way: dell'Asia = of Asia ...BUT in Asia = in Asia dall'Europa = from Europe ...BUT in Europa = in Europe fra la Borgogna e la Normandia = between Burgundy and Normandy ...BUT in Borgogna e in Normandia = in Burgundy and in Normandy The compound preposition nel / nella (i.e. in + article), though, may be used when the name is followed by a geographic adjective (i.e. Western Samoa, Upper Volta, Northern Ireland, etc.), and it is always required when the name is followed by an adjective expressing non-geographic qualities (ancient Egypt, rainy Britain, small Andorra, etc.). in Germania = in Germany nella Germania Occidentale or in Germania Occidentale = in West Germany nella Germania del XV secolo = in 15th century Germany in America = in America nel Nordamerica or in Nordamerica = in North America

nel freddo Nordamerica = in the cold North America in Oriente = in the Orient, in the East nel Medio Oriente or in Medio Oriente = in the Middle East nell'affascinante Oriente = in the fascinating East in Africa = in Africa nell'Africa Centrale or in Africa Centrale = in Central Africa nell'Africa misteriosa = in the misterious Africa To express this in four general rules: • simple preposition in can only be used for country names and continent names alone (i.e. without an adjective); • if the country's name is plural (United States, Philippines, etc.), only a compound preposition (nei, negli, nelle) may be used; • when the noun comes with an adjective, if the latter expresses a quality (old Europe, sunny Spain, etc.), only the compound preposition (nel, nello, nella) may be used; • both simple and compound prepositions are allowed when the adjective may be considered as a part of the country's or continent's name (Middle East, South Africa, North America, etc.).

CITIES City names reject articles, thus all prepositions used are simple ones. Varsavia = Warsaw with prepositions: di Varsavia = Warsaw's, of Warsaw, Warsaw a Varsavia = to Warsaw da Varsavia = from Warsaw con Varsavia = with Warsaw su Varsavia = about Warsaw, over Warsaw per Varsavia = for Warsaw tra Varsavia = between Warsaw fra Varsavia = between Warsaw in Varsavia = in Warsaw Only in the case an adjective is appended (mediaeval Rome, gorgeous Paris, etc.) a definite article is required, as if indicating "one among many cities" (prehistoric Rome, ancient Rome, mediaeval Rome, modern Rome, etc.). In Italian, all city names are feminine (città, city, is feminine) and, obviously, singular. la vecchia Varsavia = (the) old Warsaw with prepositions: della vecchia Varsavia = old Warsaw's, of old Warsaw, old Warsaw alla vecchia Varsavia = to old Warsaw dalla vecchia Varsavia = from old Warsaw con la vecchia Varsavia = with old Warsaw sulla vecchia Varsavia = about old Warsaw, over (the) old Warsaw per la vecchia Varsavia = for old Warsaw tra la vecchia Varsavia = between old Warsaw fra la vecchia Varsavia = between old Warsaw nella vecchia Varsavia = in old Warsaw

CHOOSING THE RIGHT PREPOSITION WITH GEOGRAPHIC NAMES Italian and English use different prepositions with verbs indicating movement or position. MOVEMENT While English always uses to (you go to Italy, he travels to Asia, he returns to Berlin, etc.), Italian uses preposition in for continents and countries, and preposition a for cities. In both cases the simple form of the preposition is used.

NOTE - verb andare (to go) is irregular, and will be fully discussed in a future paragraph; for the sake of an easy comprehension, only one inflection (vado = I go) has been used in the following examples. io vado in Asia, in Europa, in Oceania

I go to Asia, to Europa, to Oceania

io vado in Spagna, in Danimarca, in Grecia I go to Spain, to Denmark, to Greece ...BUT io vado a Firenze, a Londra, a Los Angeles

I go to Florence, to London, to Los Angeles

POSITION English uses in (I stay in Italy, he was born in Asia, he works in Berlin, etc.), whereas Italian uses the same prepositions in for continents and countries, and a for cities. vivere = to live lavorare = to work dormire = to sleep io vivo in Asia, in Europa, in Oceania

I live in Asia, in Europa, in Oceania

lavoravano in Spagna, in Danimarca, in Grecia they worked in Spain, in Denmark, in Greece ...BUT hai dormito a Firenze, a Londra, a Los Angeles you slept in Florence, in London, in Los Angeles To memorize easily the correct use of these prepositions, try to think of them as "used for wide places" (continents, countries, in) and "for smaller places" (cities, a), both for movement and position.

12.1 COMPARATIVE part I A quality, expressed as an adjective, can be compared between two sides or terms (two nouns, two pronouns, a noun and a pronoun, etc.) by means of comparatives. first term adjective second term that boy is taller than this girl your suitcase was as heavy as mine he is less intelligent than his brother this car is more expensive than what you think

When the quality of the first term compared is greater than the second, in Italian this is called comparative of majority. To show this, English either adds suffix ...-er to the adjective, or uses the adverb more in front of it. In Italian, only the latter pattern is used, by placing the adverb più (more) before the adjective, and preposition di for than. It should be noticed that when nouns are involved in a comparison, they very often require an article. According to the rules concerning compound prepositions, explained in paragraph 5.2, when the article is definite the preposition links to it and becomes compound, while indefinite articles do not link to the preposition. il ghiaccio è più freddo dell'acqua = ice is colder than water (notice the use of compound preposition) un topo è più piccolo di un gatto = a mouse is smaller than a cat (notice the use of simple preposition) tu sei più giovane di me = you are younger than me le Ferrari sono più; costose delle Ford = Ferraris (Ferrari cars) are more expensive than Fords (Ford cars) l'attesa fu più lunga del previsto = the wait was longer than what was expected il suo cuore era più duro della pietra (or ...di una pietra) = his heart was harder than stone l'aereo ha viaggiato più veloce del suono = the plane (has) travelled faster than sound Only few nouns do not require an article with comparatives. In particular, the article is rejected by: • names (names of persons, cities, etc.); • personal pronouns; • seasons of the year (see paragraph 7.2). il mio amico è più magro di te = my friend is thinner than you Roma è più grande di Napoli = Rome is larger than Naples noi eravamo più bravi di loro = we were (we used to be) more clever than them Elena sarà più svelta di Marco = Helen will be faster ~ quicker than Mark febbraio è più corto di gennaio = February is shorter than January As in English, if the second term has already been introduced by a previous sentence, it is possible to omit it.

questa automobile è più grande della tua, ma è anche più vecchia (della tua) = this car is bigger than yours, but it is also older (than yours) erano sorelle, ma Giulia era molto più alta (di sua sorella) = they were sisters, but Julie was much taller (than her sister)

When the quality of the first term is lesser or smaller than the second one, in Italian it is called comparative of minority. It always uses adverb meno (less), as in English. Articles and prepositions work in the same way as majority comparative. la luna è meno distante del sole = the moon is less distant than the sun la bicicletta era meno veloce dell'autobus = the bycicle was less fast than the bus tu sei meno alto di me = you are less tall than me alcuni gas sono meno pesanti dell'aria = some gases are less heavy than air marzo è meno freddo di febbraio = March is less cold than February Maria è stata meno timida di suo fratello = Mary has been less shy than her brother Also in this case, if both terms have already been introduced before the comparative, the second one can be omitted. giochiamo tutti nella stessa squadra, ma io sono meno bravo (degli altri) = we all play in the same team, but I am less clever (than the others). sono meno veloci di noi, perché sono meno giovani (di noi) = they are less fast than us, because they are less young (than us)

12.2 COMPARATIVE part II When the same quality level is expressed, in Italian this is called comparative of equality: first term adjective second term that tree was as tall as a house she is as old as his brother your books are as many as mine To express this concept, English uses ... as (adjective) as .... Italian uses the following form: ... tanto (adjective) quanto ... in which tanto... means as much... and quanto means as. tu sei tanto veloce quanto Marco = you are as fast as Mark questa penna è tanto nuova quanto quella = this pen is as new as that one erano tanto bravi quanto voi = they were as clever as you However, in colloquial speech, this comparative often changes to: ... (adjective) quanto ... (i.e. tanto is omitted) or ... (adjective) tanto quanto ... (i.e. tanto is shifted to the second term of comparison) They both have the same meaning.

la loro casa è bella quanto la tua = their house is as beautiful as yours Paolo è alto tanto quanto suo fratello = Paul is as tall as his brother (literally: Paul is as much tall as his brother) il mio computer è nuovo tanto quanto il tuo = my computer is as new as yours Although the previous form (tanto ... quanto) is more correct, in common speech these other forms are commonly used, which of the two depending on the sentence (there is no specific rule for this). For instance: la neve è tanto fredda quanto il ghiaccio = snow is as cold as ice la neve è fredda quanto il ghiaccio la neve è fredda tanto quanto il ghiaccio are all possible, although the first one is stylistically the best.

There is also a further comparative form expressing similarity, which may be used in a limited number of cases: ... (adjective) come ... In this case come acts exactly as quanto in previous expressions. This form gives the sentence a more emphatic meaning, as in sayings and idiomatic expressions, in which a person or an object are compared to something which traditionally represents the maximum grade of a given quality (either an actual quality, or only one believed to be so by common beliefs). This is a selection of such expressions: bianco come la neve = as white as snow nero come il carbone = as black as coal pesante come il piombo = as heavy as lead leggero come una piuma = as light as a feather duro come la pietra (or ...come la roccia) = as hard as stone (or ...as rock) tenero come il burro = as tender as butter lento come una lumaca (or ...come una tartaruga) = as slow as a snail (or ...as a tortoise) veloce come una lepre (or ...come il vento) = as fast as a hare (or ...as wind) furbo come una volpe = as cunning as a fox stupido come una gallina = as stupid as a hen testardo come un mulo = as stubborn as a mule muto come un pesce = as silent (literally dumb) as a fish Especially in spoken language, non-standard expressions in the form mentioned above may be created, according to the speaker's own personal experience. For instance, a woman may tell a friend: « Il nostro nuovo capo è bello come un attore di Hollywood » = « Our new boss is as handsome as a Hollywood actor » Obviously, an abuse of such "personalized" comparatives should be avoided, for the sake of common understanding.

In a smaller number of cases, comparatives can also be used to express the level of two different qualities which refer to one same subject. In this case, not the two terms (nouns / pronouns) are compared, but the two qualities (adjectives). le sue ricette sono tanto raffinate quanto gustose = his/her recipes are as much refined as they are tasty è un artista tanto bravo quanto modesto = he is a clever artist as much as he is modest If a comparative of majority is expressed (see previous paragraph), the second adjective is introduced by simple preposition che (not by preposition di, or any of its compounds). quella bicicletta sembra più bella che robusta = that bycicle seems more beautiful than sturdy la studentessa era più intelligente che diligente = the (girl) student was more intelligent than hardworking

TABLE OF COMPARATIVES

COMPARATIVE OF MAJORITY (A is greater than B) ... più (adjective) di ... comparing two nouns/pronouns ... (adjective)-er / more (adjective) than ... ... più (1st adjective) che (2nd adjective) comparing two adjectives ... more (1st adjective) than (2nd adjective)

COMPARATIVE OF MINORITY (A is lesser than B) ... meno (adjective) di ... comparing two nouns/pronouns ... less (adjective) than ... (the comparative of minority between adjectives is not commonly used)

COMPARATIVE OF EQUALITY (A is equals to B) ... tanto (adjective) quanto ... comparing two nouns/pronouns ... as (adjective) as ... ... (adjective) come ... [1] ... as (adjective) as ... ... tanto (1st adjective) quanto (2nd adjective) comparing two adjectives ... as much (1st adjective) as (2nd adjective) [1] - only in a limited number of expressions and sayings

12.3 RELATIVE SUPERLATIVE Superlative grades of adjectives express the maximum level of a quality. They either compare an individual subject to the group or category he belongs to (relative superlative), or they express a high quality level without making a comparison (absolute superlative). Relative superlative corresponds to the English forms the (adjective)...est (i.e. the highest, the fattest, the darkest, etc.), and the most... (adjective) (the most interesting, the most exciting, etc.). To obtain this in Italian, the adverb più is used; it is the same adverb used for comparative of majority (see paragraph 12.1), but by adding a definite article in front of più the maximum grade is expressed. più nuovo di ... = newer than ...

il più nuovo (di ...) = the newest (of ...)

Also the opposite, i.e. the minority relative superlative, can be regularly formed, by replacing il più with il meno (the least), whereas in English this pattern is not used as much as in Italian. il meno giovane (di...) = the least young (of...) In this case, probably the eldest would be preferred to the least young. Both the adjective and the article have to match the subject's number (i.e. singular or plural), according to the general rules. However, the article's and adjective's gender points to the group or category the subject belongs to (which is not always the same gender of the subject itself). The following sample sentences analyze in detail the choice of the article. Marco è il più alto dei nostri amici = Mark is the tallest of our friends

The subject is Marco (singular, masculine); the group or category the subject belongs to is amici (plural, masculin). Therefore, the article and adjective required are singular (as Marco) and masculine (as amici). Among singular masculine articles, il, lo, l' (see paragraph 2.4), in this case the first of the three will be chosen because it matches phonetically the following word (più). la balena è il più lungo dei mammiferi = the whale is the longest among mammals Here the subject of the sentence is balena (singular, feminine), the category is mammiferi (masculine, plural). The article and the adjective required are singular (as balena) and masculine (as mammiferi, despite the subject is feminine). Try yourself this analysis with the following examples: il cane è il più fedele degli animali = the dog is the most faithful among animals il Monte Everest è la più alta delle montagne = Mount Everest is the highest among (all) mountains era il più anziano dei miei insegnanti = he was the oldest among my teachers la matematica è la più interessante delle materie scolastiche = maths is the most interesting among school subjects By turning the sentence the other way round this match is easier to understand: il più lungo dei mammiferi è la balena = the longest among mammals is the whale In the aforesaid sentence, the article il and the adjective lungo are masculine, because evidently referred to mammiferi (masculine), but they are singular as the noun balena. Here are further examples: la pizza è il più famoso dei piatti italiani = pizza is the most famous among Italian dishes (pizza feminine singular - piatti masculine plural) Turning the sentence the other way round, we have: il più famoso dei piatti italiani è la pizza = the most famous among Italian dishes is pizza (pizza feminine singular - piatti masculine plural) More examples: il coraggio è la più importante delle virtù = courage is the most important among virtues (coraggio masculine singular - virtù feminine plural: being a truncated word, singular and plural are identical) i batteri sono le più minute delle specie viventi = bacteria are the tiniest among living species (batteri masculine plural - specie feminine plural) Note that the preposition di does not express a real comparison, as it does with comparative, but only the subject's belonging to a category or group (i.e. di = of), although in English di would be often translated as among. As an alternative to preposition di, the group or category may be also introduced by the prepositions tra or fra, both meaning among. They are easier to use for who is not yet familiar with compound prepositions (see paragraph 5.2), since fra and tra never bind to the following article: they always remain simple prepositions followed by the article. il whisky è la più forte delle bevande alcoliche = whisky is the strongest among alcoholic drinks il whisky è la più forte fra le bevande alcoliche = whisky is the strongest among alcoholic drinks Carlo era il più alto dei nostri amici = Charles was the tallest among our friends Carlo era il più alto fra i nostri amici = Charles was the tallest among our friends Roma era la più grande delle città antiche = Rome was the largest among ancient cities Roma era la più grande fra le città antiche = Rome was the largest among ancient cities When using il meno (minority relative superlative), fra or tra are preferrred to di: il topo è il meno grande dei mammiferi = the mouse is the least large (= the smallest) among mammals il topo è il meno grande fra i mammiferi (preferrable) = the mouse is the least large (i.e. the smallest) among mammals

la Moldavia è la meno ricca delle nazioni europee = Moldavia is the least rich among the European countries la Moldavia è la meno ricca fra le nazioni europee (preferrable) = Moldavia is the least rich among the European countries Sentences that contain a relative superlative may be turned the other way round, i.e. opening the sentence with among.... In this case, the use of fra (or tra) is preferred to di; alternatively, tutti or tutte (all) is added after fra (tra) or di. il whisky è la più famosa tra le bevande alcoliche = whisky is the most famous among alcoholic drinks fra le bevande alcoliche la più famosa è il whisky = among alcoholik drinks, the most famous one is whisky fra le bevande alcoliche il whisky è la più famosa = among alcoholik drinks, whisky is the most famous one fra tutte le bevande alcoliche il whisky è la più famosa = among all alcoholik drinks, whisky is the most famous one fra tutte le bevande alcoliche la più famosa è il whisky = among all alcoholik drinks, whisky is the most famous one di tutte le bevande alcoliche il whisky è la più famosa = (same as above) di tutte le bevande alcoliche la più famosa è il whisky = (same as above) Roma era la più potente delle città antiche = Rome was the most powerful among the ancient cities fra le città antiche Roma era la più potente = among the ancient cities, Rome was the most powerful one fra le città antiche la più potente era Roma = among the ancient cities, the most powerful one was Rome fra tutte le città antiche Roma era la più potente = among all the ancient cities, Rome was the most powerful one fra tutte le città antiche la più potente era Roma = among all the ancient cities, the most powerful one was Rome di tutte le città antiche Roma era la più potente = (same as above) di tutte le città antiche la più potente era Roma = (same as above) The part of the sentence shifted to the bottom is the one that receives more emphasis. In English too the sentence can be turned the other way round, but one has to be added, whereas in Italian no addition is required. When the sentence starts with among..., in Italian the definite article may be replaced with the relevant demonstrative pronoun: fra le bevande alcoliche il whisky è la più famosa = among alcoholik drinks, whisky is the most famous one fra le bevande alcoliche il whisky è quella più famosa = (same as above) fra tutti i nostri amici Carlo è il più alto = among all our friends, Charles is the tallest fra i nostri amici Carlo è quello più alto = (same as above) di tutti i fiori le rose sono i più tradizionali = among all flowers, roses are the most traditional ones di tutti i fiori le rose sono quelli più tradizionali = (same as above) In this case the demonstrative pronoun has the same function as the ones discussed at the end of paragraph 5.5 (see DEMONSTRATIVE ADJECTIVES USED AS PRONOUNS): it stands in front of an adjective without a noun, although in this case the grade of the adjective is relative superlative. quella famosa ~ quella più famosa = the famous one ~ the most famous one quello alto ~ quello più alto = the tall one ~ the tallest one quelli tradizionali ~ quelli più tradizionali = the traditional ones ~ the most traditional ones Also the definite article, when used instead of the demonstrative pronoun, acts in the same way. la più famosa ~ quella più famosa = the most famous one il più alto ~ quello più alto = the tallest one i più tradizionali ~ quelli più tradizionali = the most traditional ones Also note how in the third couple of sentences shown above, le rose (feminine) is followed by i or by quelli (both masculine), because referred to fiori, the masculine noun.

A slightly different way of expressing the same sentences without changing the meaning is: the dog is the most faithful among animals which can be turned into the dog is the most faithful animal In Italian, the position of the adjective can be either before or after the noun (see paragraph 2.5). More often, sentences in which the adjective is part of a relative superlative follow a "noun - relative superlative" ordering. For instance: il cane è l'animale più fedele = the dog is the most faithful animal The ordering is l'animale (noun) più fedele (relative superlative). Compared to the form previously discussed, the main change which takes place is the article: the phonetic match is now with the noun (animale), and no longer with più. Gender and number, instead, remain unchanged. Here are more samples of previous sentences turned into this form, plus a few new ones (always focus the article!): la balena è il mammifero più lungo = the whale is the longest mammal il coraggio è la virtù più importante = courage is the most important virtue il cervello è l'organo umano più complesso = the brain is the most complex human organ il whisky è la bevanda alcolica più forte = whisky is the strongest alcoholic drink la pizza è il piatto italiano più famoso = pizza is the most famous Italian dish The last three sentences also show how if the noun already has an adjective (i.e. bevanda alcolica; piatto italiano), the relative superlative comes after both of them (bevanda alcolica più forte; piatto italiano più famoso). Although the "noun - relative superlative" is the most common case, there are sentences in which the "relative superlative - noun" is preferred. There is no specific rule for them, but they sound somewhat more emphatic, and often occurs in popular sayings, titles of books or films, etc. These are a few examples: la più grande scoperta del secolo = the greatest discovery of the century il più ricco abitante del quartiere = the richest inhabitant of the district la più bella poesia del libro = the most beautiful poem of the book However, the "alternative forms", less emphatic, would be perfectly accepted, although the article should be sometimes changed for a phonetic match with the noun: la scoperta più grande del secolo = the greatest discovery of the century l'abitante più ricco del quartiere = the richest inhabitant of the district la poesia più bella del libro = the most beautiful poem of the book

12.4 ABSOLUTE SUPERLATIVE The absolute superlative expresses the maximum grade of a quality, without any comparison. English does not have an absolute superlative, so it is difficult to express its meaning exactly: in most cases it would be almost identical to very + adjective (i.e. very nice, very tall, very old, etc.), or even extremely + adjective. But in Italian absolute superlatives express the quality in an even higher grade than by using adverb very or extremely. Absolute superlatives are not really "emphatic" expressions, and their use in common speech, as well as in literature, is very common.

Absolute superlative is obtained by attaching to adjectives the suffix -issimo, which behaves as an ordinary adjective (i.e. -issimo is for masculine singular, -issima for feminine singular, -issimi for masculine plural

and -issime for feminine plural). The accent (stress) is always carried by the first i of the suffix (-ìssimo, etc.). la mia casa è molto nuova = my house is very new la mia casa è nuovissima = my house is very new questo racconto è molto bello = this novel is very nice questo racconto è bellissimo = this novel is really very nice ha due cani molto piccoli = (he/she) has two very small dogs ha due cani piccolissimi = he/she has two very small dogs sono molto stanche = they (feminine) are very tired sono stanchissime = they (feminine) are extremely tired So absolute superlative is quite easy to use. It should only be noticed that if an adjective has the -e inflection for both masculine and feminine singular and -i for masculine and feminine plural (facile, facili; breve, brevi; utile, utili; importante, importanti; etc., see also paragraph 2.1), in absolute superlative grade they are turned into the more common pattern (-o for masculine and -a for feminine). un esempio molto facile = a very easy example un esempio facilissimo = a really easy example una spiegazione molto utile = a very useful explanation una spiegazione utilissima = a very useful explanation uomini molto importanti = very important men uomini importantissimi = very important men sono regole molto utili = they are very useful rules sono regole utilissime = they are extremely useful rules Only very few adjectives use a different suffix, -errimo. Among the ones more commonly used are misero (poor, miserable, wretched), integro (whole, integer, or upright, honest), aspro (sour, or harsh, rough, difficult). In linking this suffix to the adjective, not only the last vowel, but two or three letters of the root are dropped: una vita miserrima = a very miserable life un giudice integerrimo = an absolutely incorruptible judge tre salite asperrime = three extremely difficult ascents The -errimo superlative is indeed used in literature, but not very often in everyday's speech. With the three aforesaid adjectives, the use of an adverb is more commonly preferred: molto aspro (very harsh); davvero misero (really miserable); etc. Obviously, the use of the suffix -issimo with these few adjectives is never allowed.

13.1 CONDITIONAL BASIC CONCEPTS VERBS AVERE AND ESSERE Conditional tenses require a knowledge of subjunctive ones, because in many cases they both occur in the same sentence. If you are not confident with subjunctive yet, it would be better to rehearse the relevant pages (paragraphs 9.1 through 9.5). In Italian, conditional has two tenses: • CONDIZIONALE PRESENTE (present conditional) • CONDIZIONALE PASSATO (past conditional) The first one has specific inflections, while the second one is a compound tense made of present conditional + past participle of verb avere for transitive verbs, essere for intransitive ones. Therefore, these two auxiliary verbs will be discussed first. CONDIZIONALE PRESENTE avere (to have) singular plural 1st person avrei I would have avremmo we would have 2nd person avresti you would have (singular) avreste you would have (plural) 3rd person avrebbe he/she/it would have avrebbero they would have

essere (to be) singular plural 1st person sarei I would be saremmo we would be 2nd person saresti you would be (singular) sareste you would be (plural) 3rd person sarebbe he/she/it would be sarebbero they would be

In all inflections, stress falls on ...re... (avrèi, avrèsti, avrébbe, sarèi, sarésti, etc.). Curiously, the pronounciation of vowel "e" is grave for the inflection of the first singular person, i.e. it has an "open" sound (avrèi; sarèi), while in all other persons it is acute, i.e. "closed" sound (sarésti; avrésti; sarébbe; avrébbe; sarémmo; avrémmo; etc.). However, e is never accented in normal spelling. This topic may be completely disregarded by beginners. Try to become confident with the inflections of these two verbs, since you will need them for the past conditional tense of all the others. CONDIZIONALE PASSATO avere singular plural 1st person avrei avuto I would have had avremmo avuto we would have had 2nd person avresti avuto you would have had (singular) avreste avuto you would have had (plural) 3rd person avrebbe avuto he/she/it would have had avrebbero avuto they would have had

essere 1st person 2nd person 3rd person

singular sarei stato / stata saresti stato / stata sarebbe stato / stata

I would have had you would have had (sing.) he / she would have had

plural saremmo stati / state we would have had you would have had (pl.) sareste stati / state sarebbero stati / state they would have had

All accents fall again on ...re.... When essere is used as an auxiliary verb, the following past participle is number- and gender-sensitive, requiring masculine or feminine according to the subject of the sentence. This has already been discussed with compound indicative tenses, and will be shown again in detail in the following paragraph.

13.2 CONDITIONAL VERBS OF THE THREE CONJUGATIONS The standard inflections of the present conditional tense are similar to the ones of irregular verbs essere and avere: the only difference is that they start with a vowel (-e... for the 1st and 2nd conjugation, -i... for the 3rd), which links to the verb's root. CONDIZIONALE PRESENTE

1st person 2nd person 3rd person

1st conjugation - domandare (to ask for) singular plural domanderei I would ask domanderemmo we would ask you would ask (plural) domanderesti you would ask (singular) domandereste domanderebbe he/it (she) would ask domanderebbero they would ask

1st person 2nd person 3rd person

2nd conjugation - perdere (to lose) singular plural perderei I would lose perderemmo we would lose you would lose (plural) perderesti you would lose (singular) perdereste perderebbero they would lose perderebbe he/it (she) would lose

3rd conjugation - capire (to understand) singular plural 1st person capirei I would understand capiremmo we would understand 2nd person capiresti you would understand (singular) capireste you would understand (plural) 3rd person capirebbe he/she would understand capirebbero they would understand In all inflections the stress is carried by the ...re... syllable.

The past conditional tense will be illustrated with transitive verbs at first, and then with intransitive ones, to remark the difference of auxiliaries, and the consequence this brings on number- and gender-sensitivity. CONDIZIONALE PASSATO 1st conjugation - domandare (to ask - transitive) 1st person 2nd person 3rd person

singular I would have asked avrei domandato you would have asked (s.) avresti domandato avrebbe domandato he/it (she) would have asked

plural avremmo domandato avreste domandato avrebbero domandato

we would have asked you would have asked (pl.) they would have asked

2nd conjugation - perdere (to lose - transitive) 1st person

singular avrei perso

I would have lost

plural avremmo perso we would have lost

2nd person 3rd person

you would have lost (s.) he/it (she) would have lost

avresti perso avrebbe perso

you would have lost (pl.) avreste perso avrebbero perso they would have lost

NOTE: the past participle of verb perdere may be either perso or perduto: any of the two may be used. 3rd conjugation - capire (to understand - transitive) singular plural 1st person avrei capito I would have understood avremmo capito we would have understood 2nd person avresti capito you would have understood (s.) you would have understood (pl.) avreste capito 3rd person avrebbe capito he/it (she) would have understood avrebbero capito they would have understood

Notice how past participles (domandato; perso; capito) never change, being both number- and genderinsensitive. Intransitive verbs have the same present conditionals as transitive ones, but their past conditional requires auxiliary verb essere. Therefore, past participles become number-sensitive and gender-sensitive, in the same way an adjective would be. 1st conjugation - stare (to stay, to remain - intransitive) 1st person 2nd person 3rd person

singular sarei stato / stata saresti stato / stata sarebbe stato / stata

I would have stayed you would have stayed (sing.) he/she would have stayed

plural saremmo stati / state sareste stati / state sarebbero stati / state

we would have stayed you would have stayed (plur.) they would have stayed

2nd conjugation - cadere (to fall - intransitive) 1st person 2nd person 3rd person

singular I would have fallen sarei caduto / caduta saresti caduto / caduta you would have fallen sarebbe caduto / caduta he/she would have fallen

plural saremmo caduti / cadute we would have fallen you would have fallen sareste caduti / cadute sarebbero caduti / cadute they would have fallen

3rd conjugation - uscire (to go out, to come out - intransitive) singular plural 1st person sarei uscito / uscita I would have gone out saremmo usciti / uscite we would have gone out 2nd person saresti uscito / uscita you would have gone out you would have gone out sareste usciti / uscite 3rd person sarebbe uscito / uscita he/she would have gone out sarebbero usciti / uscite they would have gone out

13.3 CONDITIONAL THE USE OF CONDITIONAL TENSES Hypothetical sentences express something which "might happen" or "might have happened", usually stating a condition under which something may take place, and then expressing the action or the consequence (i.e. what would happen). For instance: if you had followed my advice, you would have arrived earlier. "To follow the advice" is the initial condition, "to arrive earlier" is the consequence. The first part (the condition statement) is a primary sentence, and in Italian it requires a subjunctive tense. The second part (the consequence) is a subordinate sentence, and requires a conditional tense. If I took a degree, I would earn more money If I had taken a degree, I would have earned more money If I took a degree and If I had taken a degree are primary sentences, stating the initial condition, and in Italian they require past subjunctive and pluperfect subjunctive, respectively. I would earn more money and I would have earned more money, instead, are subordinate sentences, stating

the consequence, and in Italian require present conditional and past conditional, respectively. In certain cases, these tenses have an opposite ordering: If I were lucky, yesterday I would have won the lottery If I had bought a car, now I could travel In these cases, also the Italian tenses would have to be combined in the same reversed order: past subjunctive and past conditional (first sentence), pluperfect subjunctive and present conditional (second sentence). However, the primary sentence always requires a subjunctive tense, and the secondary sentence always a conditional tense. The italian word for if, introducing most conditional sentences, is se. Other possible expressions which conditional sentences start with are qualora and nel caso che (both meaning in the case that). Some examples: (tornare = to return and cenare = to have dinner) se (io) tornassi tardi, cenerei al ristorante = if I should return late, I would have dinner at the restaurant (visitare = to visit and conoscere = to know) se (tu) avessi visitato Roma, ora conosceresti il Vaticano = if you had visited Rome, now you would know the Vatican (telefonare = to phone and perdere = to lose) se (noi) avessimo telefonato, non avremmo perso questo tempo = if we had phoned, we wouldn't have wasted this time Notice how pronouns have been shown in a pale colour, to indicate that with subjunctive tenses sometimes they are used, both in spoken and in written language. This topic is also discussed further down in the page. It is also possible to invert the position of the primary and subordinate sentences. cenerei al ristorante se tornassi tardi = I would have dinner at the restaurant if I returned late (...not if I returned at the usual time) conosceresti il Vaticano se (tu) avessi visitato Roma = you would know the Vatican if you had visited Rome (...but you didn't) non avremmo perso questo tempo se avessimo telefonato = we wouldn't have lost (wasted) this time if we had phoned (...but we didn't) So this form usually gives the primary sentence a slightly stronger emphasis, remarking the hypothetical condition more than the consequence. In any of the two forms, it is very important to use the right subjunctive and conditional tenses, as a mismatch is commonly frowned upon, being the correct match a typical sign of good knowledge of the language. If you are not confident yet with past and pluperfect subjunctive tenses, it would be better to rehearse them again in paragraphs 9.2, 9.3 and 9.4. Especially in spoken language, when subjunctive is followed by a conditional tense, personal pronouns io and tu (I and you) may be omitted. As mentioned in paragraph 9.1, when subjunctive alone is used, it needs these personal pronouns, because the inflections of the 1st and 2nd singular persons are identical: se io avessi molto denaro = if I had a lot of money se tu avessi molto denaro = if you had a lot of money But if a conditional tense follows the subjunctive, the right person can be understood without the need of a pronoun: se (io) avessi molto denaro comprerei una moto = if I had a lot of money, I would buy a motorbike se (tu) avessi molto denaro compreresti una moto = if you had a lot of money, you would buy a motorbike In these cases, io and tu are often omitted, but this is left as a free choice, being such omission more colloquial.

In written language, instead, both pronouns are often used, especially if the language level is formal. Also other pronouns (3rd singular, and all plural ones) may be either used or omitted.

OTHER KINDS OF SENTENCES REQUIRING CONDITIONAL TENSES Conditional tenses are also used in other sentences, such as: I would have lunch with you, but I am late for the office. We would have visited the place, but we would have stayed there only a short time. This kind of sentence is completely different from the ones discussed so far. Conjunction "but" simply links two short individual sentences, none of which is a consequence (i.e. they are both primary ones). I would have lunch with you - I am late for work We would have visited the place - We would have stayed there only a short time The first part always requires a conditional tense, since it expresses something hypothetical (which might happen, or might have happened in the past). The second part, instead, requires indicative, as in any simple sentence (first example), or another conditional tense (second example) when the following sentence too is hypothetical: (conditional - indicative) pranzerei con te, ma sono in ritardo per l'ufficio = I would have lunch with you, but I am late for the office (conditional - conditional) avremmo visitato il posto, ma saremmo rimasti là solo per poco tempo = We would have visited the place, but we would have stayed there only for a short time The italian words for conjunction but are ma and però. The former can be used in any case, so to avoid any doubt you might prefer to use ma. It is a common mistake for poor Italian speakers and for children to use both conjunctions ("ma però"), but this is incorrect, and should always be avoided. (conditional - indicative) comprerei questa giacca, ma è stretta = I would buy this jacket, but it is small (conditional - conditional) comprerei questa giacca, ma vorrei una taglia più larga = I would buy this jacket, but I would like a larger size avrebbe mangiato un gelato, peró i negozi erano chiusi = he/she would have eaten an ice-cream, but the shops were closed avrebbe mangiato un gelato, peró avrebbe preferito un panino = he/she would have eaten an ice-cream, but he/she would have preferred a sandwich sarebbe stata una bella festa, però il brutto tempo l'ha rovinata = it would have been a nice party, but the bad weather has spoiled it sarebbe stata una bella festa, però gli ospiti sarebbero arrivati tardi in ogni caso = it would have been a nice party, but the guests would have arrived late in any case saremmo venuti con Marco, ma era occupato = we would have come with Mark, but he was busy saremmo venuti con Marco, ma saremmo tornati con Paolo = we would have come with Mark, but we would have returned with Paul studierei il francese, ma la scuola di lingue aprirà fra un anno = I would study French, but the language school will open in one year time studierei il francese, ma continuerei anche lo studio del tedesco = I would study French, but I would also keep studying German se vendesse i terreni guadagnerebbe molto denaro, ma la villa perderebbe il suo valore = if he sold the grounds he would earn a lot of money, but the villa would lose its value se avessero giocato bene avrebbero pareggiato l'incontro, ma persero nel finale = if they had played well, they would have drawn the match, but they lost in the end

The last two sentences show a synopsis of previous cases: a hypothetical sentence (primary and subordinate sentence), requiring subjunctive + conditional tenses, followed by a third sentence, requiring a conditional tense (first of the two samples) and an indicative tense (second one).

A third kind of sentence in which conditional tenses are used is to express wishes or expectations, such as: I would like this house to be a castle We would have liked her to become a professional His boss would have liked him to stay In Italian, this form is always turned into "I would like that my house was a castle", or "we would have liked that she had become a professional", etc. In these sentences, that is always translated che. The second part of the sentence, introduced by that, requires either a past subjunctive or a pluperfect subjunctive (if you don't feel confident with them, see again paragraph 9.1). The verbs more often used for this kind of sentence are very few, mainly: • volere (to want, but also to wish, to like), transitive; • piacere (to enjoy, to like), though used in reflexive form (see paragraph 8.3): piacermi, piacerti, etc., which is intransitive, thus requiring auxiliary verb essere for compound tenses; • avere piacere (to have the pleasure or to be a pleasure), transitive, used in a more limited number of cases, being a rather formal expressions). These are samples showing the aforesaid forms with both a transitive and an intransitive verb, in present and past tenses. Vorrei che voi mangiaste = I would like you to eat Vorrei che voi veniste = I would like you to come Avrei voluto che voi aveste mangiato = I would have liked you to eat Avrei voluto che voi foste venuti / venute = I would have liked you to come Mi piacerebbe che voi mangiaste = I would like you to eat / it would be nice if you eat Mi piacerebbe che voi veniste = I would like you to come / it would be nice if you came Mi sarebbe piaciuto che voi aveste mangiato = I would have liked you to eat / it would have been nice if you had eaten Mi sarebbe piaciuto che voi foste venuti / venute = I would have liked you to come / it would have been nice if you had come Avrei piacere che voi mangiaste = I would be a pleasure for me if you eat Avrei piacere che voi veniste = I would be a pleasure for me if you came Avrei avuto piacere che voi aveste mangiato = it would have been a pleasure for me if you had eaten Avrei avuto piacere che voi foste venuti / venute = it would have been a pleasure for me if you had come

In spoken language, conditional tenses used alone may express an offer, or a wish, or a request for something in a more polite or formal way. (gradire = to enjoy food/drinks and preferire = to prefer) Gradisci un bicchiere di birra? = Would you enjoy (like) a glass of beer? Gradiresti un bicchiere di birra? (more formal) = Would you enjoy (like) a glass of beer? No grazie, preferisco un po' di whisky. = No thanks, I prefer a little whisky. No grazie, preferirei un po' di whisky. = No thanks, I'd prefer a little whisky. Voglio una camicia verde della mia taglia. = I want a green shirt in my size. Vorrei una camicia verde della mia taglia. = I would like a green shirt in my size. Questa va bene? = Is this one OK? Questa andrebbe bene? = Would this one be OK?

In asking for something in a shop, a store, etc. the expression vorrei... (I would like...) is a standard which can be used with any kind of goods (food, clothes, etc.). However, be aware that the verb volere means to to want, and it is used for actual requests, while verb piacere (to like) gives the previous expression a different meaning, more or less as I wish it was so, or I feel like having..., I would enjoy.... In this case, piacere is used again in reflexive form (piacermi, piacerti, piacergli, ecc.). vorrei un gelato = I would like an ice-cream (said by the customer in asking for the ice-cream) mi piacerebbe un gelato = I would like an ice-cream = I feel like having an ice-cream (as a wish, a thought, a comment, etc.) Also verb andare (to go), when used in reflexive form, has a similar meaning of to feel like having..., though this is rather colloquial. When the verbs piacere and andare express wishes, personal pronouns have to be used to turn the verb into its reflexive form, as explained in paragraph 8.3: ti piacerebbe un panino? = would you like (feel like having) an ice-cream? gli piacerebbe un panino? = would he like an ice-cream? ti andrebbe un panino? = would you like an ice-cream? (colloquial) vi andrebbe un panino? = would you (plural) like an ice-cream? (colloquial) Also auxiliary verbs have to be chosen according to the verb used: transitive verbs (volere, gradire) require auxiliary avere, while intransitive verbs, as well as reflexive forms, require auxiliary essere. avrebbe voluto un hamburger = he would have liked a hamburger avrebbe gradito un hamburger = he would have enjoyed a hamburger (with verbs in reflexive form) gli sarebbe piaciuto un hamburger he would have liked a hamburger gli sarebbe andato un hamburger he would have enjoyed a hamburger (more colloquial)

14.1 IMPERATIVE THE INFLECTIONS Imperative expresses a command (sit down; come here; bring me the book; etc.), but it can also express an invitation to do or to have something: have some cake; take a seat; feel free to ask; etc. In Italian, a specific imperative inflection only exists for singular and plural 2nd persons. 1st and 3rd persons have no imperative inflection, so the present subjunctive tense also acts as imperative, when the latter tense is required, although with different shades of meaning. In particular, imperative would rarely be used for the 1st plural person (i.e. may we do something), and different expressions would probably be preferred. Note that the use of conjunction che has to be used to express an imperative meaning of subjunctive tenses. Without mentioning che, the same inflection would sound more like an actual subjunctive. IMPERATIVO essere 1st person 2nd person 3rd person

singular che (io) sia (tu) sii che (egli / ella) sia

1st person 2nd person 3rd person

singular che (io) abbia (tu) abbi che (egli / ella) abbia

may I be be! (singular) let (make) him/her be

plural che (noi) siamo may we be be! (plural) (voi) siate che (essi / esse) siano let (make) them be

avere may I have have! (singular) let (make) him/her have

plural may we have che (noi) prendiamo have! (plural) (voi) prendete che (essi / esse) prendano let (make) them have

Imperative has one simple tense (no past tenses, nor future tense, nor compound tenses); therefore, avere and essere are never required as auxiliaries, and their imperative inflections only have the actual meaning of be!, have!, etc.. 1st conjugation - pensare (to think) singular 1st person che (io) pensi 2nd person (tu) pensa 3rd person che (egli / ella) pensi

may I think think! (singular) let (make) him/her think

plural che (noi) pensiamo (voi) pensate che (essi / esse) pensino

may we think think! (plural) let (make) them think

2nd conjugation - prendere (to take) 1st person 2nd person 3rd person

singular che (io) prenda (tu) prendi che (egli / ella) prenda

may I take take! (singular) let (make) him/her take

plural che (noi) prendiamo (voi) prendete che (essi / esse) prendano

may we take take! (plural) let (make) them take

3rd conjugation - sentire (to feel) singular 1st person che (io) senta 2nd person (tu) senti 3rd person che (egli / ella) senta

may I feel feel! (singular) let (make) him/her feel

plural che (noi) sentiamo (voi) sentite che (essi / esse) sentano

In pronouncing imperative inflections, the accent (stress) is as follows:

may we feel feel! (plural) let (make) them feel

(essere) (avere) (1st conjugation) (2nd conjugation) (3rd conjugation)

sìi àbbi pènsa prèndi sènti

siàte abbiàte pensàte prendéte sentìte

Although it is not an important detail - beginners may completely disregard this topic - it is curious how the syllable carrying the stress in singular inflections is pronounced with a grave e sound (pènsa, prèndi, etc.), while in plural inflections, the accent shifts onto the next syllable and the same e becomes acute (pénsàte, préndéte, etc.). This remark only concerns the spoken language, as in normal spelling no accent at all is used, except in very few cases (where imperative may be mistaken with some other tense).

14.2 IMPERATIVE WITH PRONOUNS - NEGATIVE IMPERATIVE - GENERAL USE IMPERATIVE WITH PERSONAL PRONOUNS Due to the difference between the "real" imperative inflections (2nd persons) and all the others (subjunctive), when personal pronouns have to be used, they link as suffixes to the 2nd persons of imperative, while they come before the verb in all other persons of this tense. Here are examples of pronouns used for reflexive forms: 1st conjugation - mangiarsi (to eat, to eat up, to have food) singular 1st person che (io) mi mangi 2nd person (tu) mangiati 3rd person che (egli / ella) si mangi

may I eat eat! (singular) let (make) him/her eat

plural may we eat che (noi) ci mangiiamo eat! (plural) (voi) mangiatevi che (essi / esse) si mangino let (make) them eat

2nd conjugation - prendersi (to take, to choose, to have as a choice) singular 1st person che (io) mi prenda 2nd person (tu) prenditi

may I have have! (singular)

3rd person che (egli / ella) si prenda let (make) him/her have

plural che (noi) ci prendiamo (voi) prendetevi che (essi / esse) si prendano

may we have have! (plural) let (make) them have

3rd conjugation - vestirsi (to get dressed, to dress up as a choice) singular 1st person che (io) mi vesta may I dress up 2nd person (tu) vestiti dress up! (singular) 3rd person che (egli / ella) si vesta let (make) him/her dress up

plural che (noi) ci vestiamo (voi) vestitevi che (essi / esse) si vestano

may we dress up dress up! (plural) let (make) them dress up

Take care in pronouncing the 2nd singular persons with the accent (or stress) on the first syllable, as explained above: màngiati, vèstiti, etc. In fact, changing the position of the stress gives different words: mangiàti means eaten (past participle of verb mangiare, in plural form), while vestìti means either dressed (again, past participle of vestire, plural form), or clothes. In written language, imperative inflections such as these ones are sometimes spelled with an accented vowel, not to be mistaken.

This other example, instead, shows personal pronouns used as an object of the verb: 2nd conjugation - prendermi (to catch me, or to take for me, to fetch me) singular 1st person che (io) mi prenda may I catch myself [1] 2nd person (tu) prendimi catch me! (singular) 3rd person che (egli / ella) mi prenda let him/her catch me ...

plural ----catch me! (plural) (voi) prendetemi che (essi / esse) mi prendano let them catch me ...

[1] only theorical; this inflection matches the "colloquial reflexive" form of the verb, may I catch (myself), described in paragraph 8.3 Obviously, when a pronoun is used as an object, as in the example above, it does not change according to the person (1st, 2nd, 3rd), as it does, instead, for reflexive forms. In other words, if a pronoun is used as an object, the action of the verb is always received by the same object, i.e. the pronoun, in this case mi (you catch me, he catches me, etc.). Instead, in reflexive forms, the action expressed by the verb is received by the same subject who does it: for each person a different pronoun is required (i.e. I help myself; you help yourself; he helps himself; etc.). NEGATIVE IMPERATIVE It is formed by adding non (not) in front of the verb, as usual. Only for the 2nd singular person a change occurs: imperative is replaced by infinitive. mangiare = to eat (tu) mangia! = eat! (tu) non mangiare! = don't eat! (non mangia! means he/she does not eat!) prendere = to take (tu) prendi! = take! (tu) non prendere! = don't eat! pensare = to think (tu) pensa! = think! (tu) non pensare! = don't think! All other persons form the negative imperative in the same way other tenses do, i.e. by simply adding non: che (egli / ella) mangi! = let (make) him / her eat! che (egli / ella) non mangi! = let (make) him / her not eat! (voi) prendete! = take! (plural) (voi) non prendete! = don't take! (plural) che (essi / esse) dormano! = let (make) them sleep! (plural) che (essi / esse) non dormano! = let (make) them not sleep! (plural) When a personal pronoun is attached to the verb, non always comes before the pronoun: (tu) non vestirti! = don't dress yourself up! (vestirti = vestire + -ti) (tu) non ti vestire! (other form) che (essi / esse) non si liberino! = let (make) them not free themselves! (voi) non mangiatelo! = don't eat it! (mangiatelo = mangiate + -lo) (voi) non lo mangiate! (other form) As shown above, the 2nd singular and plural persons, "real" imperative inflections, allow a double form when used with pronouns: • one with the pronoun added as a suffix to the verb (infinitive for the singular person, indicative for the plural person); • one in which the pronoun is used before the verb (same tenses). Note how in these cases it is useless to repeat the personal pronoun, placed in brackets in the previous forms, because it would be redundant. non perderti! = don't lose yourself! (perderti = perdere + -ti) non ti perdere! (other form)

non perdetelo = don't lose it! (perderlo = perdere + -lo) non lo perdete! non muoverti! = don't move yourself! (muoverti = muovere + -ti) non ti muovere! non muovetevi = don't move yourselves! non vi muovete! non sporcarmi! = don't make me dirty! (sporcarmi = sporcare + -mi) non mi sporcare! non sporcatemi = don't make me dirty! non mi sporcate! Any of the two may be freely chosen, in spoken language as well as in written language: they are equivalent. THE USE OF IMPERATIVE Besides having the meaning of a command, also in Italian imperative may be used for inviting somebody to do something. In the latter case, English often softens the invitation with please. Although prego (please) can be used in Italian, as well, it is often omitted: what makes the expression sound as an offer, a more "pushy" request, or a command, is especially the voice's pitch and intonation. Sometimes the same verb leaves no doubt about the imperative's meaning: mettiti comodo! = put yourself at ease! (mettere = to put) prenditi un'altra tazza di caffè! = have another cup of coffee! assaggia questo vino! = (have a) taste (of) this wine! rilassati! = relax! (literally: relax yourself) Quite obviously, all the expressions above would never sound as an order or a command. Other verbs, instead, allow a wider range of meanings: for example, let's consider the verb entrare = to enter, go in(to), come in(to). Saying entra! to somebody knocking at the door may have the meaning of come in!, but in a rather informal way: it would be used with a relative, or a friend, or a child. A more polite invitation to come in would be avanti!, literally: (come) forward!. In fact, entra! might even be translated as go inside!, i.e. said by a teacher to a rascal pupil caught sneaking out of the classroom, or by a guard to a runaway convict in pushing him back again into his cell. Therefore, according to a specific context, imperative may have different meanings. In case an imperative might sound too harsh, prego, per favore, or per piacere (all mean please) can be used, more or less as in English: prego, giratevi = please, turn yourselves round (girare = to turn; girarsi = to turn oneself round) prendete altro vino, prego = please, have some more wine scendete giù, per favore = come down, please All of them can stand before or after the imperative, usually separated by a comma. Another way of softening an invitation is to use pure. Pure means also, even, but when it follows an imperative it gives it a meaning of feel free of ...ing: mangiatelo pure = feel free of eating it lasciate pure la valigia in camera = feel free of leaving the suitcase in (your) room fate pure con comodo, c'è ancora tempo = feel free of taking it easy, there is still time (fare con comodo, literally to do with ease, means to take it easy, to take one's time in doing something) IMPERSONAL IMPERATIVE When a command is given as a general condition (i.e. not addressing a given person but simply stating a rule, such as in public notices, or in a warning, etc.), two forms may occur: one using the present subjunctive tense, and one using the infinitive tense.

In the case the command is positive (not negative), both of them may be adopted, although the infinitive one is surely more common. It is obtained by simply using this tense with a general meaning: camminare a destra = walk on the right (also meaning to walk on the right) spegnere il motore = switch off the engine (also meaning to switch off the engine) rallentare = slow down (also meaning to slow down) This is the form most commonly used in traffic signs, or more generally, in notices and warnings for the public. Sometimes it is used with reflexive verbs, which need a pronoun: reggersi al mancorrente = hold yourself / yourselves to the handrail (also meaning to hold oneself to the handrail) muoversi! = move (yourself / yourselves)! (also meaning to move oneself) tenersi dietro la riga gialla = keep yourself / yourselves behind the yellow line (also meaning to keep oneself...) Notice how in this case the reflexive pronoun -si (oneself) is used to address a command to everybody, i.e. it makes it "impersonal". See also paragraph 8.3 for personal reflexive pronouns. The other impersonal imperative form is a bit more complicated, but less used than the previous one, because it sounds rather formal (i.e. used in written documents, in vows, in official statements, etc.). It requires either one or two pronouns. Pronoun si (same as above) is always required, followed by present subjunctive, 3rd singular person. The same expressions shown above in this form would be: si cammini a destra = (let everybody) walk on the right si spenga il motore = (let) the engine be switched off si rallenti = (let everybody) slow down Although subjunctive is also used for 3rd person imperative (as shown in the previous paragraph), here the use of si makes once again the inflection sound "impersonal", i.e. referred to everybody. In the case of a reflexive verb, a further pronoun is required before si: pronoun ci, usually meaning us (as an object), to us, for us, or, in non-imperative reflexive forms, meaning ourselves (as an object), to ourselves, for ourselves, etc. (see paragraphs 8.1 through 8.3). Compare these expressions with the ones previously shown: ci si regga al mancorrente = (let everybody) hold (himself) to the handrail ci si muova! = (let everybody) move (himself)! ci si tenga dietro la riga gialla = (let everybody) keep (himself) behind the yellow line In this form, ci acts as the real reflexive pronoun, not si (in other words, we could say that ci has to be used in place of si, because the latter is already required for making the verb's inflection impersonal). synopsis table for impersonal imperative with ordinary verbs infinitive form (more infinitive common) → subjunctive form (less si + present subjunctive (3rd sing.) common) →

with reflexive verbs infinitive + -si

ci si + present subjunctive (3rd sing.)

The negative of all the forms shown above (negative impersonal imperative), is simply obtained by using non (not) in front of the verb: camminare a destra = walk on the right non camminare a destra = don't walk on the right reggersi al mancorrente = hold yourself / yourselves to the handrail non reggersi al mancorrente = don't hold yourself/yourselves to the handrail si cammini a destra = (let everybody) walk on the right non si cammini a destra = (let everybody) not walk on the right ci si regga al mancorrente = (let everybody) hold (himself) to the handrail non ci si regga al mancorrente = (let everybody) not hold (himself) to the handrail

15.1 FORMAL LEVEL OF SPEECH THE BASICS Italian has two levels of speech: one is the simple level, which has been discussed so far, and one is the formal level. The simple level is used with children, with one's relatives and with friends. It is also used among young people, as a standard. The formal level is used with strangers or people with whom a more superficial relation exists (i.e. a friend's parents, a neighbor, the postman, etc.), especially if the person is clearly older than the speaker, unless any of them specifically ask to use a simple level of speech. The use of the simple level where the formal one would be more appropriate is frowned upon as unpolite, except in the case of non-local natives, whose first language is not Italian, or uncultured people, whose poor knowledge of the language would account for this. The invitation to use a simple level of speech, where the formal one would be required, is almost as saying "let's be friends". In fact, once the simple level of speech has been used with somebody, it may be used again in any further occasion of conversation. To swap back to a formal level, in most cases would mean that the relation, friendship, etc. has split. The simple level of speech needs no further explanation: it's the "plain" form of Italian language, discussed so far in the previous pages. The formal language only differs from the "plain" one when talking to somebody, i.e. when the speaker uses the 2nd persons (singular and plural). Addressing the 2nd singular person, formal language requires the use of the 3rd singular feminine one, while addressing the 2nd plural person, the 3rd plural masculine should be used. This change involves the verb, but also the pronoun (if any). tu sei (simple) · lei è (formal) = you are tu hai (simple) · lei ha (formal) = you have tu mangi (simple) · lei mangia (formal) = you eat tu pensi (simple) · lei pensa (formal) = you think tu leggi (simple) · lei legge (formal) = you read tu perdi (simple) · lei perde (formal) = you lose tu dormi (simple) · lei dorme (formal) = you sleep tu capisci (simple) · lei capisce (formal) = you understand When the 2nd plural person is addressed, the pronoun is always loro, not essi, (in simple level of speech, loro is only used as a direct object, see paragraph 8.1). These samples show the same verbs as above, referred to a plural you. voi siete (simple) · loro sono (formal) = you are voi avete (simple) · loro hanno (formal) = you have voi mangiate (simple) · loro mangiano (formal) = you eat voi pensate (simple) · loro pensano (formal) = you think voi leggete (simple) · loro leggono (formal) = you read voi perdete (simple) · loro perdono (formal) = you lose voi dormite (simple) · loro dormono (formal) = you sleep voi capite (simple) · loro capiscono (formal) = you understand As with other verbs already discussed, the personal pronoun is often omitted.

Generally speaking, the use of formal speech in 2nd singular person is very common, used in everyday's language, and should be practiced throughoutly. The same formal speech in 2nd plural person, instead, is less frequent: it could almost be considered as

"very formal", thus it is often disregarded, without sounding unpolite. Actually, not many native speakers would ever use it at all, although it is advisable for the student at least to be aware that such a form exists for the 2nd plural person. The use of lei for the 2nd singular person is a recent custom: originally, ella was used (i.e. the pronoun for feminine 3rd person, as a subject). In simple speech, lei should refer to the feminine 3rd person only as a direct object. But in the past few decades, ella has become more and more unused, and it is rarely heard today: lei has taken its place also as a subject, in both simple and formal speech, although the former is the "true" correct form. Although using a 3rd person for an actual 2nd person gives the sentence two possible meanings (see further examples), very rarely misunderstanding occurs in spoken language: when talking to somebody, the use of lei is obviously referred to the same person, not to somebody else, unless a third female person was involved by the topic or by the circumstance. lei è molto gentile = you are very kind (it also means she is very kind) ieri lei ha mangiato troppo = yesterday you eat too much (it also means yesterday she eat...) gradirebbe un caffé? = would you like a coffee? (it also means would she like...) prende l'autobus o il taxi? = do you take the bus or a taxi? (it also means does she take...) And for plural persons (same sentences as above): loro sono molto gentili (but voi siete molto gentili would be polite enough) = you are very kind (it also means they are very kind) ieri loro hanno mangiato troppo (ieri voi avete mangiato troppo) = yesterday you eat too much (it also means yesterday they eat...) gradirebbero un caffé? (gradireste un caffé?) = would you like a coffee? (it also means would they like...) prendono l'autobus o il taxi? (prendete l'autobus o il taxi?) = do you take the bus or a taxi? (it also means do they take...) FORMAL SPEECH WITH OTHER TENSES There is no particular difference for the other many tenses: the formal inflections are always the 3rd singular person feminine gender, and the 3rd plural one. lei viaggiò in treno = you travelled by train (literally in train) avrà dormito a Firenze, suppongo = you may have slept in Florence, I suppose se mangiasse meno pasta sarebbe più magro = if you eat less pasta, you would be thinner (plural) loro viaggiarono in treno (but voi viaggiaste in treno is polite enough) = you travelled by train avranno dormito a Firenze, suppongo (but avrete dormito... is also polite) = you may have slept in Florence, I suppose se mangiaste meno pasta sareste più magri = if you eat less pasta, you would be thinner Be careful in using the imperative tense: since the 3rd person is required, there is no "real" imperative inflection, see paragraph 14.1, but only a present subjunctive which acts as imperative. legga qui per favore = read here, please non prema quel pulsante! = don't press that button! telefoni al vicepresidente = phone the vice-president guardi questa foto, prego = look at this photograph, please non chieda il motivo di ciò = don't ask the reason for this prenda pure quanto desidera = feel free of taking as much as you like (plural) leggano qui per favore (but leggete qui per favore would be polite enough) = read here, please non prema quel pulsante! (also non premete...) = don't press that button! telefonino al vicepresidente (telefonate...) = phone the vice-president guardino questa foto, prego (guardate...) = look at this picture, please non chiedano il motivo di ciò (non chiedete...) = don't ask the reason for this prendano pure quanto desiderano (prendete pure quanto desiderate) = feel free of taking as much as you like

15.2 FORMAL LEVEL OF SPEECH PRONOUNS AND ADJECTIVES Now that the basic concepts of formal speech have been introduced, let's see how other parts of the sentence behave. PERSONAL PRONOUNS AS SUFFIXES Also when they are attached to a verb as suffixes, i.e. when they are used as a direct object (paragraph 8.1), these pronouns are used in 3rd singular person feminine gender, and in 3rd plural person. io sono qui per aiutarla = I am here to help you (it also means I am here to help her) sicuramente la riconoscerò = certainly, I will recognize you (also ...I will recognize her) siamo lieti di vederla = we are happy to see you (also we are happy to see her) io la penso spesso = I often think of you (also I often think of her) manderò l'autista a prenderla = I will send the chauffeur to pick you up (also ...to pick her up) sappiamo dove trovarla = we know where to find you (also we know where to find her) (plural) volevamo salutarli = we wanted to greet you, also meaning we wanted to greet them (volevamo salutarvi is polite enough) li ringrazio molto = I thank you very much, also meaning I thank them very much (vi ringrazio molto is polite enough) averli qui è stato un piacere = to have you here (as guests) has been a pleasure, also meaning to have them here... (avervi qui... is OK) As explained above, the 3rd plural person is only used in very formal situations. In most other cases, the ordinary 2nd plural person would be used, still being polite, and much more common. Apparently, these sentences may be translated in two different ways, but in a great majority of cases, the context in which they are used leaves little doubt about their meaning. ORDINARY ADJECTIVES The formal 3rd persons do not bring any particular change to ordinary adjectives, which therefore match the subject's own gender: lei è simpatico = you are pleasant (referred to a man) lei è simpatica = you are pleasant (referred to a woman, but also meaning she is pleasant) lei è gentile = you are kind (referred to both genders, because the adjective ends with -e) lei era bravo = you were clever (referred to a man, despite lei) lei era brava = you were clever (referred to a woman, but also meaning she was clever) lei sarà veloce = you will be fast (referred to both genders) è pronto? = are you ready? (referred to a man) è pronta? = are you ready? (referred to a woman, also meaning is she ready?) Once again, these sentences are very rarely misunderstood, because they would be addressed to the person next to the speaker (not to a third person). Furthermore, in the case they are referred to a man (masculine adjective), lei would obviously mean "formal you" in all cases, never she. POSSESSIVE PRONOUNS AND ADJECTIVES Personal pronouns and personal adjectives too are used in 3rd person when using a formal level of speech. Remember, though, that the gender of these pronouns has to be referred to the object possessed by the subject, not to the subject itself (see paragraph 5.3): questo libro è suo = this book is yours (it also means this book is his) questa penna è sua = this pen is yours (it also means this pen is hers) questa è la sua casa = this is your house (it also means this is her house) questo è il suo cappotto = this is your coat (it also means this is his coat) il suo segretario la attende = your secretary is waiting for you (it also means his secretary is waiting for him) la sua segretaria la attende = your (female) secretary is waiting for you (it also means her secretary is waiting for her)

16.1 INTERROGATIVE PRONOUNS AND

EXCLAMATIVE PRONOUNS (AND THEIR USE AS ADJECTIVES) INTERROGATIVE PRONOUNS The purpose of interrogative pronouns is to replace a noun in interrogative sentences. In Italian, the main ones are: quanto? quale? chi? che? how much? which one? who? what? quanti? quali? how many? which ones? The second one, che, may also come in these other two forms: che cosa? cosa? what? what? In fact, the literal meaning of che cosa? is what thing?, and especially in common speech it is often shortened in cosa?, with the same meaning of what?.

The use of these pronouns is not different from their English equivalents: chi partirà con noi? = who will leave with us? chi è rimasto nell'ufficio = who remained in the office? che avete udito? (che cosa avete udito? / cosa avete udito?) = what did you hear? che indosseranno? (che cosa indosseranno? / cosa indosseranno?) = what will they wear? quale porterai con te? = which one will you take with you? quale avete scelto? = which one did you choose? quanto mangerà? = how much will he / she eat? quanto hanno vinto? = how much did they win? In these cases they are typical pronouns, because the noun they refer to is not mentioned. For instance, what did you hear? likely refers to a noise, while how much did they win? likely refers to money, and so on. Due to phonetic reasons, when che cosa and its short form cosa are followed by inflections of the verb essere whose first sound is that of a vowel, they make an elision: che cosa è? = che cos'è? = what is this? cosa erano diventati? = cos'erano diventati? = what had they become? sai che cosa era? = sai che cos'era? = do you know what it was? con cosa è tornato? = con cos'e tornato? = what did he return with? This often happens with avere, as well; remember that the inflections beginning with a mute h are phonetically treated as if the word began with vowel a. In modern Italian, this elision is often limited to the present indicative tense, either used alone or as an auxiliary verb in forming the passato prossimo tense with other verbs. With all the other tenses of avere, instead, the elision is now less common: che cosa ho per cena? = che cos'ho per cena? = what do I have for dinner? cosa hai in tasca? = cos'hai in tasca? = what do you have in (your) pocket? che cosa hanno ottenuto? = che cos'hanno ottenuto? = what did they obtain?

cosa avete comprato? = cos'avete comprato? = what did you buy? cosa avevano ottenuto? (more often without the elision) = what had they obtained? che cosa avranno trovato? (more often without the elision) = what will they have found? This is not a strict rule, and not spelling the elision would not be considered a real mistake, although it is very common to use it. In spoken language, instead, the elision is obviously not spelled, but in pronouncing the two vowels a (...cosa a...) they sound as one.

INTERROGATIVE PRONOUNS USED AS ADJECTIVES While chi can only be used as a pronoun (i.e. it cannot be followed by a noun), the others may also act as adjectives, when a noun is placed after them. Let's see an example with che: che avete udito? = what did you hear? che cosa avete udito? = (same) cosa avete udito? = (same) (che, che cosa and cosa are pronouns) che rumore avete udito? = what noise did you hear? (che is an adjective referring to rumore) Only che may be used with either purposes. In fact, in che cosa, the first part che is already an adjective of cosa (thing), although the whole expression is used as a pronoun, so that no other noun may follow it. The same rule applies to cosa alone, since it is a short form of che cosa. Also quanto and quale are often used as adjectives. In this case, quanto / quanti may also take feminine inflections, quanta / quante, so to match the gender and number of the following noun. Also quale may take feminine inflections, as well, but since adjectives ending with -e have identical inflections for masculine and feminine, the difference is somewhat disguised. Furthermore, when used as an adjective, the English equivalent of quale is no longer which one, but which... (followed by the noun). quale porterai con te? = which one will you take with you? (quale is a pronoun) quale libro porterai con te? = which book will you take with you? (quale is an adjective referring to a masculine singular noun, libro) quale maglietta porterai con te? = which T-shirt will you take with you? (quale is an adjective referring to a feminine singular noun, maglietta) quali libri porterai con te? = which books will you take with you? (quali is an adjective referring to a masculine plural noun, libri) quali magliette porterai con te? = which books will you take with you? (quali is an adjective referring to a feminine plural noun, magliette) quanto mangerà? = how much will he / she eat? (quanto is a pronoun) quanto pollo mangerà? = how much chicken will he / she eat? (quanto is an adjective referring to a masculine singular noun, pollo) quanta pasta mangerà? = how much pasta will he / she eat? (quanta is an adjective referring to a feminine singular noun, pasta) quanti gelati mangerà? = how many gelati will he / she eat? (quanti is an adjective referring to a masculine plural noun, gelati) quante olive mangerà? = how many olives will he / she eat? (quante is an adjective referring to a feminine plural noun, olive) EXCLAMATIVE PRONOUNS They give a stronger emphasis to an exclamation, although their use is not always necessary. For instance, looking at a nice picture our comment could be either beautiful! (simple exclamation) or how beautiful! (using how as an exclamative pronoun). These pronouns are the same ones used for interrogative sentences. In Italian the following pronouns express an exclamation:

che...! how...!

quanto...! how...! how much...! quanti...! how many...!

Che is followed directly by an adjective, very often bello = nice, lovely (or sometimes good) and brutto = ugly (sometimes bad), and few other adjectives. che bello! = how nice! (masculine singular) che bella! = how nice! (feminine singular) che belli! = how nice! (masculine plural) che belle! = how nice! (feminine plural) Instead quanto may be followed by a verb: quanto ha mangiato! = how much he ate! quanto dormono! = how much they sleep! quanto guadagni! = how much you earn! quanto riderò! = how much I'll laugh! A verb that frequently follows quanto is essere (to be): quanto era povero! = how poor he was! quanto sono gentili! = how kind they are! quanto sarà facile! = how easy it will be! quanto è stata brava! = how clever she has been! quanto fummo stupidi! = how stupid we were! When the sentence contains an adverb, in a few cases the latter may be moved in front of the verb, but more often it stays at the bottom: quanto mangiano poco! = how little they eat! quanto poco mangiano! = (same as above) quanto lavoravate duramente! = how hard you worked! quanto è arrivato tardi! = how late he arrived! quanto si muovono lentamente! = how slowly they move! When quanto is used as a pronoun, as in the aforesaid examples, it is invariable (i.e. no feminine nor plural inflections are required). Exclamative pronouns should be considered adjectives when a noun follows them. In this case the English equivalent of che is what a.... Note how in English an indefinite article is needed for such singular forms (what a lovely house!), while in Italian it is never used: che sbaglio! = what a mistake! che casa! = what a house! che colore! = what a colour! che faccia! = what a face! In Italian also the plural forms alone are used, which in English are not too common: che sbagli! = what mistakes! che case! = what houses! che colori! = what colours! che facce! = what faces! The noun may be followed by a "real" adjective: che sbaglio brutto! = what a bad mistake! che colori vivaci! = what bright colours! che case belle! = what lovely houses! In paragraph 2.5 we discussed how the Italian adjective may be freely shifted before the noun, to leave a greater emphasis on the last word of the sentence: che sbaglio brutto! = what a bad mistake! (emphasis on brutto) che brutto sbaglio! = what a bad mistake! (emphasis on sbaglio)

che case belle! = what lovely houses! (emphasis on belle) che belle case! = what lovely houses! (emphasis on case) Che may also be followed by a noun, but in English the latter would often be translated with an adjective: che orrore! = how horrible! (literally: what a horror!) che fame! = how hungry (I am / you are / etc.)! (literally: what a hunger!) che noia! = how boring! (literally: what a boredom!) che dolore! = how painful! (literally: what a pain!) In these cases che would be an adjective in Italian and a pronoun in English, although the meaning of the exclamation is absolutely the same iin both languages. As seen in the aforesaid examples, also when che is followed by a noun, i.e. it is an adjective, it remains invariable, with no inflections. Quanto, instead, used as an adjective has to match the gender and number of the following noun: quanto vino! = how much wine! quanta roba! = how much stuff! quanti negozi! = how many shops quante ingiustizie! = how many wrongs! Also in this case a "real" adjective may follow or come before the noun: quanto vino rosso! = how much red wine! quanta bella roba! = how much nice stuff! quanti negozi nuovi! = how many new shops quante terribili ingiustizie! = how many terrible wrongs! Note how both quanto and the real adjective match the noun's gender and number: quanto-rosso; quantabella; quanti-nuovi; quante-terribili (because terribile, singular form, ends with -e).

For phonetic reasons, when quanto, quanta, quanti, quante are followed by a noun that starts with the same last vowel of the adjective, the latter may be dropped and replaced by an apostrophe (i.e. an elision may occur), although in modern Italian this tends to happen more and more rarely. Only when the matching vowel is a it is still common to use an apostrophe, although this is not compulsory: quanta acqua è rimasta? = quant'acqua è rimasta? = how much water is left? quanta armonia in questo quadro! = quant'armonia in questo quadro = how much harmony in this painting!

16.2 RELATIVE PRONOUNS part I Relative pronouns are so called because they act as a reference, i.e. they relate two sentences (a primary and a subordinate one) by linking them in one single period. For instance, the boy who came here is your brother links together the boy is your brother (primary sentence) and he came here (subordinate sentence, because it connects to the former one by means of who). In a relative clause different relations are possible between the primary sentence and the subordinate one. They may share either the subject, or the object, or other parts of the sentence. This first paragraph will focus relative pronouns used as a subject and as an object, whose possible combinations are summarized in the following table:

• • • • •

A shows the case in which both sentences share the same noun as a subject: Paul left for Paris + he (Paul) bought a suitcase = Paul, who bought a suitcase, left for Paris B shows the case in which the primary sentence's object is the subject of the subordinate sentence: I miss Paul + he (Paul) left for Paris = I miss Paul, who left for Paris C shows the case in which the subject of the primary sentence becomes the object of the subordinate one: Paul left for Paris + you had met him (Paul) = Paul, whom you had met, left for Paris

• •

D shows the case in which both sentences share the same direct object: I miss Paul + you had met him (Paul) = I miss Paul, whom you had met Each of these cases will be discussed throughoutly, referring to them with letters (A,B,C,D) as in the table above. Note that relative pronouns are referred to as a subject or as an object according to which is their position in the subordinate sentence (not in the primary one).

RELATIVE PRONOUNS AS A SUBJECT (cases A and B ) As already seen in the previous examples, they are pronouns that bind two sentences (a primary and a subordinate one) that share the same subject into one single period. English pronouns used as a subject are who (whose use is normally limited to humans) and that (for a more general purpose). Italian relative pronouns exist in two forms: a full length form, and a short one: FULL FORM masculine il quale (singular) i quali (plural) who / that

feminine la quale (singular) le quali (plural) who / that

SHORT FORM che who / that (masculine/feminine, singular/plural)

Full relative pronouns contain a definite article (il, la, i, le, see paragraph 2.4), which has to match in gender and number the noun it refers to. For instance:

l'attore, il quale ha ricevuto un premio, lavorerà nel prossimo film = the actor, who received an award, will work in the next movie molte donne, le quali attendevano pazientemente, formavano una coda = many women, who were patiently waiting, formed a queue Notice how il quale is masculin singular (referred to attore), while le quali is feminine plural (referred to donne). In modern Italian, in both spoken and written language, all the aforesaid pronouns are often turned into the short pronoun che (number- and gender-insensitive): l'attore che ha ricevuto un premio lavorerà nel prossimo film = the actor who received an award will work in the next movie molte donne che attendevano pazientemente formavano una coda = many women who were patiently waiting formed a queue Any of the two is correct, and the choice of preferring one or the other is mainly a matter of style (which a student may obviously disregard at this stage of learning). However, a few further notes about this topic will be shortly discussed in THE USE OF COMMAS WITH RELATIVE PRONOUNS. In modern Italian it has become a common use to change the long form into the short one in any case: l'attore che ha ricevuto un premio lavorerà nel prossimo film l'attore, che (= il quale) ha ricevuto un premio, lavorerà nel prossimo film molte donne che attendevano pazientemente formavano una coda molte donne, che (= le quali) attendevano pazientemente, formavano una coda A stylistic reason to prefer che is to avoid repeating the same definite article, since the noun very often already has one: il pittore che dipinse questo quadro è un artista famoso = the painter who painted this picture is a famous artist il pittore il quale dipinse questo quadro è un artista famoso = (same as above) The second sentence would not sound too nice, because of the double article il. Instead: Caravaggio, che dipinse questo quadro, è un artista famoso = Caravaggio, who painted this picture, is a famous artist Caravaggio, il quale dipinse questo quadro, è un artista famoso = (same as above) Here the second sentence is perfectly acceptable, and it even sounds better than the first one, although both of them are correct. Students can do well enough by using che in all sentences that match case A.

Now let's see what happens in case B (i.e. when the primary sentence's object is the subject of the secondary sentence): Marco ha spedito la lettera a Paolo, il quale la ricevette ieri = Mark mailed the letter to Paul, who received it yesterday Marco ha spedito la lettera a Paolo, che la ricevette ieri = (same as above) il ragazzo vide le rondini, le quali volavano basse = the boy saw the swallows, which were flying low il ragazzo vide le rondini che volavano basse = (same as above) Either a long or a short pronoun may be used, and both of them are correct.

THE USE OF COMMAS WITH RELATIVE PRONOUNS In choosing a relative pronoun (either full form or short form), the student should notice that che very often provides two slightly different meanings. For instance, focus the following sentences, already mentioned among the previous examples: il pittore che dipinse questo quadro è un artista famoso = the painter who painted this picture is a famous artist il ragazzo vide le rondini che volavano basse = the boy saw the swallows that were flying low

This seems to suggest that the painter whose picture we are looking at is famous (but other painters might not be famous), and that the boy saw the swallows that were flying low (but not those ones that were flying high). In this case no comma should be placed before the relative pronoun. Instead: il pittore, il quale dipinse questo quadro, è un artista famoso = the painter, who painted this picture, is a famous artist il pittore, che dipinse questo quadro, è un artista famoso = (same as above) il ragazzo vide le rondini, le quali volavano basse = the boy saw the swallows, which were flying low il ragazzo vide le rondini, che volavano basse = (same as above) This seems to suggest that the artist, whom we were already speaking of, is famous: the fact that he is also the author of the painting is almost an extra piece of information. In the same way, the boy saw all the swallows, and the fact that they were flying low is an additonal detail. Here is another example: l'attore che ha ricevuto un premio lavorerà nel prossimo film = the actor who received an award will work in the next movie l'attore, il quale ha ricevuto un premio, lavorerà nel prossimo film = the actor, who received an award, will work in the next movie molte donne che attendevano pazientemente formavano una coda = many women who were patiently waiting formed a queue molte donne, le quali attendevano pazientemente, formavano una coda = many women, who were patiently waiting, formed a queue Notice how using the short pronoun che, the actor who received an award and the women who were waiting are almost as a single block, i.e. these senteces describe what the actor who received an award will do, or what the women who formed a queue were doing. We may think that only the actor who received an award will work in the next movie (not those who have not been awarded), or that the many women who were patiently waiting lined up in a queue (but some others did not). In the second example, the primary sentences (the actor will work in the next movie, and many women formed a queue) are almost detached from the subordinate sentences (the actor received an award, and the women were patiently waiting) by the use of a full relative pronoun (il quale, le quali), and the two commas make this division even more definite: the actor will work in the next movie // he received an award; many women formed a queue // they were patiently waiting. So this informs us that the actor will work in the next movie anyway (the fact of winning an award is an additional piece of information), and that all the many women were queuing (the fact of patiently waiting is another extra piece of information). To summarize this, we may say that a full pronoun (il quale, la quale, etc.) detaches the primary sentence from the subordinate one more than che does. But to obtain the same effect, the full form may still be replaced by the short one, provided that a comma is placed before the relative pronoun (in the written language); this also sounds more colloquial in the spoken language. In some cases there is but one possible interpretation, either using the full form or the short one: Marco ha spedito la lettera a Paolo, il quale la ricevette ieri = Mark mailed the letter to Paul, who received it yesterday Marco ha spedito la lettera a Paolo che la ricevette ieri = (same as above) In most cases, also the context of the sentence helps to make clear which is the actual meaning.

RELATIVE PRONOUNS AS AN OBJECT (cases C and D ) The following examples will focus again the difference between relative pronouns used as a subject and as an object:

the thief who broke in stole the jewels the train reached the station that had two platforms the thief that the police caught had stolen the jewels the train reached the station that you had mentioned Now let's split the primary and subordinate sentences into two separate periods; to do so is a very useful excercise for focusing which part is shared by both sentences: the train reached the station the thief stole the jewels B A the station had two platforms the thief broke in the train reached the station the thief had stolen the jewels D you had mentioned the station the police caught the thief Notice the relations between the primary sentence and the subordinate one, that always share one noun. By dividing a period containing a relative clause in its basic parts, it will be very easy for the student to tell whether the pronoun acts as a subject or as an object. In the aforesaid examples, C and D are the sentences in which the pronoun acts as a direct object of the subordinate sentence. In these cases, English uses either whom (for humans) or that, and often the pronoun may even be omitted. Italian, instead, always uses the pronoun che. C

la chiave che il portiere custodisce apre la porta della mia casa = the key that the warden keeps opens the door of my house l'amico che incontrerò oggi insegna matematica = the friend (whom) I will meet today teaches maths i cespugli che ho potato crescono velocemente = the bushes (that) I pruned grow fast The pronoun che has to be always used, because it cannot be omitted as in English.

Case D is when both the primary and the subordinate sentences share a common object. ho comprato questo libro che tu hai già letto = I bought this book that you have already read incontrammo la signora che tua madre aveva aiutato = we met the lady (whom) your mother had helped ha ricevuto le lettere che gli hanno spedito = he / she received the letters (that) they had sent to him / her Once again, che acts as a universal pronoun.

Briefly summarizing the four cases discussed so far, che is very handy in all cases: it is always used as an object, while as a subject it may replace the full forms (il quale, la quale, etc.), which are used more sparingly. RELATIVE PRONOUNS REFERRED TO PERSONAL PRONOUNS The last topic of this paragraph focuses a particular case. As far as now, we discussed relative pronouns referred to nouns (i.e. the boy who we met studies French, or we used the car that our friend gave us, and so on. There are sentences in which the relative pronoun refers to an indefinite person, expressed by a personal pronoun. For instance: he who touches the fire will get burnt, or I will give this book to those whom I see first. In the first example, the subject of the primary sentence is the pronoun he (he will get burnt), though not referring to anybody in particular, because until the fact takes place we cannot tell who he is. In the second example the dative of the primary sentence is to them (I will give the book to them), whom we do not know. Another example is: those who drink should not drive. Once again, we don't know who those actually are. Quite obviously, similar sentences only refer to 3rd persons (either singular or plural); when a 1st or 2nd persons are involved, the subject is always definite and throughoutly defined. For similar sentences, Italian does not use the ordinary personal pronouns discussed in paragraph 4.1 and in paragraph 8.1, i.e. egli / lui, ella / lei, etc., but the following three, which are specifically used for introducing a relative clause: colui he / him

colei she / her

coloro they / them

They are never used alone, because a relative pronoun always follows them, so they always form these compound expressions: FULL FORM masculine colui il quale or colui che he who

feminine

coloro i quali or coloro che those who (masc.)

colei la quale or colei che she who

coloro le quali or coloro che those who (fem.)

SHORT FORM chi (he) who / (she) who / (those) who (masculine/feminine, singular/plural) We may think of these almost as "double pronouns", since they contain both a personal pronoun and a relative pronoun (he who, she who, etc.). The personal pronoun may be either the subject or the object (or any other case) of the primary sentence, but it is always indefinite i.e. it refers to an unknown person: chi beve alcol non può guidare = who drinks alcohol cannot drive alternatively: colui il quale beve alcol non può guidare = he who drinks alcohol cannot drive colui che beve alcol non può guidare = (same as above) colei la quale beve alcol non può guidare = she who drinks alcohol cannot drive colei che beve alcol non può guidare = (same as above) the individual sentences are: qualcuno beve alcol (primary sentence) = somebody drinks alcol egli / ella (qualcuno) non può guidare (secondary sentence) = he / she (somebody) cannot drive ricompensai chi mi ha salvata = I rewarded who saved me alternatively: ricompensai colui il quale mi ha salvata = I rewarded he who saved me ricompensai colui che mi ha salvata = (same as above) ricompensai colei la quale mi ha salvata = I rewarded she who saved me ricompensai colei che mi ha salvata = (same as above) the individual sentences are: ricompensai qualcuno (primary sentence) = I rewarded somebody egli / ella (qualcuno) mi salvò (secondary sentence) = he / she (somebody) saved me Notice how the long form (colui il quale, colei la quale, etc.) may be used also for the direct object, whereas relative pronouns referred to nouns only use long forms (il quale, la quale, ecc.) for the subject, and only the short form (che) in all other cases. A few more examples (try splitting them into their primary and secondary sentences): colui il quale ha detto queste cose è un bugiardo = he who said these things is a lier colui che ha detto queste cose è un bugiardo = (same as above) chi ha detto queste cose è un bugiardo = (he / those) who said these things is a lier (colui and chi are the subject) sceglieranno colei la quale è vestita meglio = they will chose her whom is dressed better sceglieranno colei che è vestita meglio = (same as above) sceglieranno chi è vestita meglio = they will chose (her / those) whom is / are dressed better (colei and chi are the object) coloro le quali hanno superato l'esame saranno assunte dalla compagnia = those (fem.) who passed the exam will be taken in by the company coloro che hanno superato l'esame saranno assunte dalla compagnia = (same as above)

chi ha superato l'esame sarà assunta dalla compagnia = (she / those) who passed the exam will be taken in by the company (coloro and chi are the subject) premiai coloro i quali risposero correttamente = I rewarded (those) whom answered correctly premiai coloro che risposero correttamente = (same as above) premiai chi rispose correttamente = I rewarded whom answered correctly (coloro and chi are the object) mi ha indicato colei la quale sarà eletta presidentessa = he indicated me her who will be elected president mi ha indicato colei che sarà eletta presidentessa = (same as above) mi ha indicato chi sarà eletta presidentessa = he indicated me whom will be elected (female) president (colei and chi are the object) chiameremo coloro le quali hanno finito il lavoro = we shall call those who finished the work chiameremo coloro che hanno finito il lavoro = (same as above) chiameremo chi ha finito il lavoro = we shall call whom finished the work (coloro and chi are the object) Examining these examples, the first thing we notice is that the full relative pronoun contains more information about the subject or the object of the sentence. In fact, the short chi may refer either to one person (singular) or to more people (plural), although it is always dealt with as a singular pronoun, thus it requires singular inflections of the verb: in the third examples of both groups of sentences shown above, we find: coloro le quali hanno superato l'esame saranno assunte chi ha superato l'esame sarà assunta chiameremo coloro che hanno finito il lavoro chiameremo chi ha finito il lavoro Therefore, chi always behaves as a singular pronoun, although it may refer to more than one person. The short pronoun chi may also refer to masculine and to feminine alike. But the other parts of the sentence which are gender-sensitive (nouns, adjectives, past participles, etc.) make clear whether chi refers to masculine or to feminine: chi ha esperienza sarà il nuovo direttore = who is experienced will be the new director (masculine) chi ha lavorato sarà pagata = who worked will be payed (feminine) The student should become familiar with these forms before turning the page, because in the following paragraphs they will be dealt with again, at a further stage.

16.3 RELATIVE PRONOUNS part II COMBINING PREPOSITIONS WITH RELATIVE PRONOUNS

When relative pronouns are not used as a subject or as a direct object they require a preposition, whose simple and compound forms have been discussed in paragraphs 5.1 and 5.2. When a preposition is needed, the full pronoun can no longer be replaced by che, but by cui, whose function is identical (i.e. it is number- and gender-insensitive). Since il quale, la quale, etc. contain a definite article, most simple prepositions bind to the latter, thus forming the relevant compound prepositions that match the article's gender and number. Using cui, instead, the simple preposition is required.

di + il quale = di + i quali =

masculine del quale dei quali di cui

di = of di + la quale = di + le quali =

feminine della quale delle quali di cui

a + la quale = a + le quali =

feminine alla quale alle quali a cui

da + la quale = da + le quali =

feminine dalla quale dalle quali da cui

in + la quale = in + le quali =

feminine nella quale nelle quali in cui

con + la quale = con + le quali =

feminine colla quale or con la quale colle quali or con le quali con cui

su + la quale = su + le quali =

feminine sulla quale sulle quali su cui

whose

a + il quale = a + i quali =

masculine al quale ai quali a cui

a = to

to whom to which

da + il quale = da + i quali =

masculine dal quale dai quali da cui

da = from

from whom from which

in + il quale = in + i quali =

masculine nel quale nei quali in cui

in = in

in whom in which

con + il quale = con + i quali =

masculine col quale or con il quale coi quali or con i quali con cui

con = with

with whom with which

su + il quale = su + i quali =

masculine sul quale sui quali su cui

su = on, over

on whom on which

per + il quale =

masculine per il quale (pel quale is obsolete)

per = for

feminine per + la quale =

per la quale

per + i quali =

per i quali (pei quali is obsolete) per cui

per + le quali =

per le quali per cui

for whom for which

masculine

fra / tra = among, between

(no singular form) fra / tra + i quali = fra / tra i quali fra / tra cui

feminine (no singular form) fra / tra + le quali = fra / tra i quali fra / tra cui

among whom between whom among which between which

These are some examples in which the aforesaid pronouns are used: il libro del quale conosco l'autore è stato pubblicato recentemente = the book whose author I know has been recently published il libro di cui conosco l'autore è stato pubblicato recentemente = (same as above) le attrici alle quali daranno un premio sono sul palcoscenico = the actresses whom a prize will be given to are on the stage le attrici a cui daranno un premio sono sul palcoscenico = (same as above) la casa dalla quale proveniva il fumo era quella più bassa = the house which the smoke came out from was the lowest one la casa da cui proveniva il fumo era quella più bassa = (same as above) questa è una lista di alberghi nei quali abbiamo già dormito = this is a list of hotels which we have already slept in questa è una lista di alberghi in cui abbiamo già dormito = (same as above) gli amici coi quali siamo partiti sono tornati ieri = the friends whom we left with returned yesterday gli amici con cui siamo partiti sono tornati ieri = (same as above) la collina sulla quale salivamo era coperta di nebbia = the hill which we were climbing on was covered with fog la collina su cui salivamo era coperta di nebbia = (same as above) l'esposizione per la quale sono venuti aprirà domani = the exhibition which they came for will open tomorrow l'esposizione per cui sono venuti aprirà domani = (same as above) gli alberi fra i quali è sospesa l'amaca sono saldi = the trees between which the hammock is suspended are steady gli alberi fra cui è sospesa l'amaca sono saldi = (same as above) Using the full forms, note how the gender and number of the relative pronoun always matches the noun that provides a link between the primary and subordinate sentences: il libro del quale conosco l'autore è stato pubblicato recentemente = the book whose author I know has been recently published Dividing this period into its basic sentences: il libro è stato pubblicato recentemente (primary sentence) = the book has been recently published conosco l'autore del libro (subordinate sentence) = I know the author of the book Since the book is the noun shared by the two sentences, the relative pronoun in genitive form (del quale) will refer to il libro, and will match its gender and number (masculine and singular).

Using the short form cui, instead, no specific match is needed. Also note how in English the preposition often shifts to the bottom of the subordinate sentence (i.e. the friends whom we left with...), while in Italian it has to be placed before the relative pronoun (gli amici coi quali siamo partiti), in all cases.

At the end of the previous paragraph 16.2 we mentioned the particular situation in which the relative pronoun refers to a personal pronoun (i.e. he who..., she who..., those who...), and how in Italian such pronouns are translated with colui il quale or colui che, colei la quale or colei che, and coloro i quali / le quali or coloro che). When prepositions are added to these relative pronouns, as in the many cases discussed in this paragraph (i.e. he whose..., he to whom..., he from whom..., he with whom..., etc.), it is no longer possible to use short forms (neither che nor cui). colui del quale = he whose... coloro dei quali = those (masc.) whose... colei della quale = she whose... coloro delle quali = those (fem.) whose... colui del quale scriverò il nome è il vincitore = he whose name I shall write is the winner colui al quale = he to whom... coloro ai quali = those (masc.) to whom...

colei alla quale = she to whom... coloro alle quali = those (fem.) to whom...

coloro alle quali manderemo una lettera sono ammesse alla sessione successiva = those (fem.) whom we will send a letter to are admitted to the next session colui dal quale = he from whom... coloro dai quali = those (m.) from whom...

colei dalla quale = she from whom... coloro dalle quali = those (f.) from whom...

colei dalla quale ho ricevuto il regalo si chiama Stefania = she whom I received the gift from is called Stephanie colui nel quale = he in whom... coloro nei quali = those (masc.) in whom...

colei nella quale = she in whom... coloro nelle quali = those (fem.) in whom...

coloro nei quali credo sono buoni amici = those whom I trust in are good friends colui col quale or colui con il quale = he with whom... coloro coi quali or coloro con i quali = those (m.) with whom...

colei colla quale or colei con la quale = she with whom... coloro colle quali or coloro con le quali = those (f.) with whom...

coloro con le quali viaggiamo dividono con noi l'alloggio = those (fem.) whom we travel share the accomodation with us colui sul quale = he on / upon whom... coloro sui quali = those (masc.) on / upon whom...

colei sulla quale = she on / upon whom... coloro sulle quali = those (fem.) on / upon whom...

coloro sui quali contavamo ci hanno traditi = those whom we relied upon betrayed us colui per il quale = he for whom... colei per la quale = she for whom...

coloro per i quali = those (masc.) for whom... coloro per le quali = those (fem.) for whom...

colei per la quale era tornato lo aspettava = she whom he had returned for was waiting for him coloro fra / tra i quali = those (m.) among whom... coloro fra / tra le quali = those (f.) among whom...

coloro fra i quali divideremo le spese sono piuttosto soddisfatti = those among whom we'll share the expenses are rather satisfied Using the full forms, always remember that the relative pronoun matches the personal pronoun's number and gender. The same structure shown above is also used when the personal pronoun whom the relative pronoun refers to is the object of the primary sentence: colui del quale ho scritto il nome è il vincitore (colui is the subject) = he whose name I wrote is the winner prenderò colui del quale ho scritto il nome (colui is the object) = I'll take him whose name I wrote The student should take care that while in English the preposition is often shifted at the bottom of the subordinate sentence, in Italian its position is always between the personal pronoun and the relative pronoun, i.e. the ordering is as follows: + relative pronoun personal pronoun + preposition (introducing the subordinate sentence) (either subject or object)

Shifting the preposition before the personal pronoun gives the sentence a different meaning, as will be discussed in the second part of paragraph 16.4.

16.4 RELATIVE PRONOUNS part III THE USE OF CHI

At the end of paragraph 16.2 we introduced the case of relative pronouns referring to a personal pronoun. For instance, the boy who lives next door is my friend clearly refers to a specific person (the boy). But he who wins the lottery will become rich refers to an indefinite person, because the winner is not known. A similar case is he who reaches 100 points wins the game, which could also be turned into whoever reaches 100 points wins the game. In English he who, she who, those who, are often shortened simply into who (he who wins the lottery = who wins the lottery). In Italian this situation requires specific personal pronouns (colui, colei, coloro), used only in the case of a relative clause, followed by the standard relative pronouns. Also in this case a short form exists, chi, which corresponds to the shortened English who (= he / she / those who) when the personal pronoun is dropped. FULL FORM masculine colui il quale or colui che he who

feminine

coloro i quali or coloro che those who (masc.)

colei la quale or colei che she who

SHORT FORM chi (he) who / (she) who / (those) who (masculine/feminine, singular/plural)

coloro le quali or coloro che those who (fem.)

We also mentioned that these expressions almost act as "double pronouns", since they contain both a personal and a relative pronoun (i.e. he + who, or she + who, etc.), and that the personal pronoun may be either the subject or the object of the primary sentence: AS A SUBJECT colui il quale / colei la quale vince questa gara parteciperà alla finale = ( / ) who wins this match will take part to the final colui che / colei che vince questa gara parteciperà alla finale = (same as above) chi vince questa gara parteciperà alla finale = who wins this match will take part to the final colui il quale / colei la quale aveva il permesso entrava dall'ingresso principale = ( / ) who had the permit entered from the main entrance colui che / colei che aveva il permesso entrava dall'ingresso principale = (same as above) chi aveva il permesso entrava dall'ingresso principale = who had the permit entered from the main entrance chi dorme non piglia pesci (proverb) = who sleeps does not catch fish AS AN OBJECT il vigile multa colui il quale / colei la quale è senza patente = the traffic warden fines (he / she) who is without a licence iil vigile multa colui che / colei che è senza patente = (same as above) il vigile multa chi è senza patente = the traffic warden fines who is without a licence l'insegnante aveva annotato colui il quale / colei la quale era stato / stata assente = the teacher had noted down (he / she) who had been absent l'insegnante aveva annotato colui che / colei che era stato / stata assente = (same as above) l'insegnante aveva annotato chi era stato assente = the teacher had noted down who had been absent alla fine vedremo chi vince = in the end we'll see who wins

Especially in spoken language, the long forms are less frequently used than chi: they are more often found in solemn statements, in the text of laws, in some proverbs, and sometimes they are used to seek a stylish effect. In some other cases, as shown in the aforesaid examples, the use of a full form would not be correct, or it would sound very strange. However, the student should note how full forms provide a greater amount of information. For instance: chi porta gli occhiali ha problemi di vista = (he / she) who wears glasses has sight problems Now, by using the several full forms: colui il quale porta gli occhiali ha problemi di vista = he who wears glasses has sight problems colei la quale porta gli occhiali ha problemi di vista = she who wears glasses has sight problems coloro i quali portano gli occhiali hanno problemi di vista = those who wear glasses have sight problems coloro le quali portano gli occhiali hanno problemi di vista = (same as above, but feminine) colui che porta gli occhiali ha problemi di vista = he who wears glasses has sight problems colei che porta gli occhiali ha problemi di vista = she who wears glasses has sight problems coloro che portano gli occhiali hanno problemi di vista = those who wear glasses have sight problems coloro che portano gli occhiali hanno problemi di vista = (same as above, but feminine) The use of full forms is somewhat more difficult, as it requires the correct use of the verb's inflections, i.e. singular or plural, and sometimes even the gender of past participles and adjectives has to be correctly matched. Therefore, for who is learning the language it is important to know that these forms exist, but chi will surely be much easier to memorize, and more handy to use.

These "double pronouns" may also be used in all other cases (not only subject and object), in which case a preposition will be needed in front of the relative pronoun. The following examples show one sentence for each preposition, with all the possible forms.

di chi = whose sappiamo il nome di chi parteciperà allo spettacolo = we know the name of whom will take part to the show sappiamo il nome di colui il quale / di colei la quale parteciperà allo spettacolo sappiamo i nomi di coloro i quali / di coloro le quali parteciperanno allo spettacolo sappiamo il nome di colui che / di colei che parteciperà allo spettacolo sappiamo i nomi di coloro che parteciperanno allo spettacolo a chi = to whom danno un premio a chi colpisce il bersaglio = they give a prize to whom hits the target danno un premio a colui il quale / a colei la quale colpisce il bersaglio danno un premio a coloro i quali / a coloro le quali colpiscono il bersaglio danno un premio a colui che / a colei che colpisce il bersaglio danno un premio a coloro che colpiscono il bersaglio da chi = from whom comprammo la radio da chi ci ha venduto la televisione = we bought the radio from whom had sold us the television set comprammo la radio da colui il quale / da colei la quale ci vendette la televisione comprammo la radio da coloro i quali / da coloro le quali ci vendettero la televisione comprammo la radio da colui che / da colei che ci vendette la televisione comprammo la radio da coloro che ci vendettero la televisione in chi = in whom confido in chi mi è amico = I have faith in whom is friendly to me confido in colui il quale mi è amico / in colei la quale mi è amica confido in coloro i quali mi sono amici / in coloro le quali mi sono amiche confido in colui che mi è amico / in colei che mi è amica confido in coloro che mi sono amici / amiche con chi = with whom andremo con chi ha più amici = we'll go with whom has more friends andremo con colui il quale / con colei la quale ha più amici andremo con coloro i quali / con coloro le quali hanno più amici andremo con colui che / con colei che ha più amici andremo con coloro che hanno più amici per chi = for whom per chi è ricco spendere soldi è facile = for he / she who is rich, to spend money is easy per colui il quale è ricco / per colei la quale è ricca spendere soldi è facile per coloro il quali sono ricchi / per coloro le quali sono ricche spendere soldi è facile per colui che è ricco / per colei che è ricca spendere soldi è facile per coloro che sono ricchi / ricche spendere soldi è facile su chi = on whom non contare su chi non è affidabile = don't count on whom is not reliable non contare su colui il quale / su colei la quale non è affidabile non contare su coloro i quali / su coloro le quali non sono affidabili non contare su colui che / su colei che non è affidabile non contare su coloro che non sono affidabili fra chi / tra chi = among whom fecero un sondaggio fra chi aveva visto quel film = they did a survey among whom had seen that movie fecero un sondaggio fra coloro i quali / fra coloro le quali avevano visto quel film fecero un sondaggio fra coloro che avevano visto quel film Note how in the last sentence only the plural forms are possible, since the prepositions tra and fra (among, between) cannot refer to a single person.

For the sake of a good knowledge of the relative clause, the student should focus well the difference between the forms discussed in this page and the ones dealt with in paragraph 16.3), which sometimes look very similar. An example: per chi fuma i sigari quelli cubani sono i migliori = for whom smokes cigars, the Cuban ones are the best per colui il quale fuma i sigari... = for he who smokes cigars... per colei la quale fuma i sigari... = for she who smokes cigars... per colui che fuma i sigari... = for he who smokes cigars... per colei che fuma i sigari... = for she who smokes cigars... Now compare them with the following sentence: colui per il quale ho comprato i sigari è un mio amico = he whom I bought the cigars for is a friend of mine Apparently they have in common colui, per, and il quale. But in this case colui is completely detached from il quale (it stands after the preposition per). Thus, this sentence belongs to the forms discussed in the previous paragraph: colui is the subject, and per il quale introduces the relative clause. Another example: a chi torna chiederò l'informazione = to whom returns I will ask the information a colui il quale torna... = to him who returns... a colei la quale torna... = to her who returns... a colui che torna... = to him who returns... a colei che torna... = to her who returns... Now compare them with this sentence: colei alla quale chiederò l'informazione conosce bene questo posto = she whom I will ask the information to, knows this place well Also in this case we find colei, a and la quale (alla quale = a + la quale). But la quale comes after the preposition a, so colei is the subject and alla quale introduces the relative clause.

16.5 RELATIVE PRONOUNS part IV THE USE OF CIÒ CHE

In the previous paragraph 16.4 we discussed in depth the use of relative pronouns referring to a personal pronoun. Pronouns such as colui, colei, coloro, are only used with human beings. For inanimate objects, a parallel set of pronouns is used: FULL FORM masculine quello che what / the one (that)

feminine quelli che the ones (that)

quella che the one (that)

SHORT FORM ciò che what (masculine, acting as neutre)

quelle che the ones (that)

Ciò had already been mentioned in paragraph 5.5, as a demonstrative pronoun. All these forms work exactly as the ones described in the previous paragraph, although not in all cases a double version is possible (full form / short form): AS A SUBJECT quello che resta del palazzo è un cumulo di macerie = what remains of the building is a heap of rubble ciò che resta del palazzo è un cumulo di macerie = (same as above) quella che visiteremo domani è la città più grande del paese = the one we'll visit tomorrow is the largest city of the country quello che li disturba è tutto questo rumore = what disturbs them is all this noise ciò che li disturba è tutto questo rumore = (same as above) quelle che assaggeremo dopo sono ricette regionali = the ones we'll taste later on are regional recipes AS AN OBJECT il testimone aveva descritto quello che era accaduto = the witness had described what had happened il testimone aveva descritto ciò che era accaduto = (same as above) sostituiranno quelli che sono danneggiati = they will replace the ones that are damaged domani verificheremo quello che hanno fatto = tomorrow we'll check out what they did domani verificheremo ciò che hanno fatto = (same as above) sostituiremo quella che sono danneggiati = we'll replace the ones that are damaged Although this is not a general rule, when the pronoun refers to a specific noun, i.e. when a noun can be actually used to replace the pronoun, in English the one (that)... or the ones (that)... would be used, and in Italian the best choice would be quello che, quella che, quelli che or quelle che, according to what the pronoun refers to. For instance: quella che visiteremo domani è la città più grande del paese = the one we'll visit tomorrow is the largest city of the country (the one could be replaced with the city) sostituiranno quelli che sono danneggiati = they will replace the ones that are damaged (the ones refer to something which has been specifically mentioned in a previous sentence, such as the cables, or the engines, or the lockers, etc.) Instead, when the pronoun refers to something more generic, which no specific noun can replace, the English form would be what..., while in Italian either quello che (always masculine singular) or ciò che may be used. For instance: quello che li disturba è tutto questo rumore = what disturbs them is all this noise ciò che li disturba è tutto questo rumore = (same as above) (what could only be replaced by something generic, such as the problem that...) domani verificheremo quello che hanno fatto = tomorrow we'll check out what they did domani verificheremo ciò che hanno fatto = (same as above) (what is quite generic, for instance the work that...) THE USE OF THESE PRONOUNS WITH PREPOSITIONS Their use with prepositions is similar to the one described in paragraph 16.4, so only a few sentences will be shown, as a further example. non conoscono la provenienza di quello che vendono = they do not know the origin of what they sell non conoscono la provenienza di ciò che vendono = (same as above) presta attenzione a quello che dice l'insegnante = pay attention to what the teacher says presta attenzione a ciò che dice l'insegnante = (same as above) con quello che guadagno comprerò un'automobile = with what I earn I will buy a car con ciò che guadagno comprerò un'automobile = (same as above)

basavano la loro teoria su quello che avevano appreso = they based their theory on what they had learned basavano la loro teoria su ciò che avevano appreso = (same as above) per quello che hanno commesso sono stati condannati = for what they committed, they have been sentenced per ciò che hanno commesso sono stati condannati = (same as above)

17.1 THE USE OF

CAPITAL (UPPERCASE) LETTERS The Italian language uses capital letters more sparingly than the English one. These are the situations in which a capital letter is required: • PERSONAL NAMES Names and surnames are always spelled with a capital letter: Paolo Bianchi Stefania Marini Tommaso Russo •

GEOGRAPHIC NAMES Names of cities, countries, continents, rivers, mountains, seas, etc. Parigi = Paris Spagna = Spain Europa = Europe Danubio = Danube Monte Bianco = Mont Blanc Mar Tirreno = Thyrrenian Sea

PEOPLE OF A NATION Nouns indicating people of a given nation or civilization (the Germans, the Egyptians, the Aztecs, etc.) require a capital letter. Nouns indicating people of a city, a region, etc., as well as all adjectives, instead, are spelled with a small (lowercase) letter. Only people from a given continent are sometimes spelled with a capital letter, as those from a country. i Russi = the Russians but gli uomini russi = the Russian men i Greci = the Greeks but le donne greche = the Greek women gli Etruschi = the Etruscans but le tombe etrusche = the Etruscan tombs gli Statunitensi = the US people but le città statunitensi = the US cities ...AND i londinesi = Londoners i romani = Romans gli asiatici or gli Asiatici = Asians gli americani or gli Americani = Americans In the same way, the names of languages never require capital letters: il francese = French (language) l'italiano = Italian (language) il greco = Greek (language) l'inglese = English (language) lo spagnolo = Spanish (language)

INSTITUTIONS AND SIMILAR ESTABLISHMENTS In names of institutions, associations, etc. all nouns and adjectives require a capital letter, while prepositions do not. Parlamento della Repubblica = the Republic's Parliament Ministero della Pubblica Istruzione = Ministry of Public Education Presidente del Consiglio = President of the Cabinet, Prime Minister, Premier Comitato per la Tutela dell'Ambiente = Committee for the Preservation of the Environment

ADDRESSES Names of streets, squares, etc., require a capital letter, while the specification part (street,

square, lane, etc.) may be spelled either with a capital or with a small letter. Prepositions eventually used in the address name require a small letter. via Torquato Tasso or Via Torquato Tasso piazza Giuseppe Verdi or Piazza Giuseppe Verdi via del Corso or Via del Corso viale delle Milizie or Viale delle Milizie piazza delle Belle Arti or Piazza delle Belle Arti piazza dei Martiri di Belfiore or Piazza dei Martiri di Belfiore •

TITLES OF BOOKS, PAINTINGS AND OTHER WORKS OF ART Usually these names only require a capital letter for the first word of the full name, while all the following ones have small letters. Such titles are usually spelled between quotation marks, or in italics. "Alla ricerca del tempo perduto" = "Remembrance of Thing Past" [novel by Marcel Proust] "Il nome della rosa" = "The Name of The Rose" [novel by Umberto Eco] "Il re e la regina" = "The King And The Queen" [sculpture by Henry Moore] "Tre uomini in barca" = "Three Men In A Boat" [novel by Jerome K.Jerome] However, in titles capital letters are used for personal or geographic names, as in ordinary language: "La creazione di Adamo" = "Adam's Creation" [fresco by Michelangelo Buonarroti] "I racconti di Canterbury" = "The Canterbury Tales" [poem by Geoffrey Chaucer] Capital letters are also used for books which are given special respect: la Sacra Bibbia = the Holy Bible il Corano = the Coran In this case, notice how not the article (first word of the title) but the name itself is in capital letters, without quotation marks, i.e. they are not treated as titles, but as objects with a given name.

HONORIFIC TITLES In most cases honorific titles may be spelled either with a capital letter (more formal) or not, provided that the following name always begins with a capital letter. (sig. = signor = mr.; mister) sig. Mario Rossi or Sig. Mario Rossi (sig.ra = signora = mrs.; mistress) sig.ra Norma Merisi or Sig.ra Norma Merisi (dott. = dottor [masculine] or dottoressa [feminine] = title for graduate person, doctor) dott. Franco Bini or Dott. Franco Bini (prof. = professor [masculine] or professoressa [feminine] = prof.; professor) prof. Chiara Petri or Prof. Chiara Petri (rev. = reverendo [masculine] or reverenda [feminine] = rev.; reverend) rev. Giulio Monti or Rev. Giulio Monti

Capital letters are also sometimes used with an emphatic purpose, to indicate a high moral value of a given subject: l'arte = art l'Arte = art in its best possible sense; the masterpieces; etc. la scienza = science la Scienza = the scientific world; the scientific progress; etc. l'uomo = the man l'Uomo = man; the human race; etc.

17.2 COLOURS USED AS NOUNS AND AS ADJECTIVES

ROSSO

MARRONE

TURCHESE

BIANCO

GIALLO

AMARANTO

CELESTE

GRIGIO

VERDE

ROSA

LILLA

NERO

BLU

ARANCIO

ARGENTO

VIOLA

OCRA

ORO

The table above shows a list of the main colours which in Italian have a specific name. They are selfexplaining, except the last two on the bottom of the right column, argento = silver and oro = gold. A few of them may be referred to with different names. For instance, blu (blue) is commonly used for deeper shades of blue, while azzurro is more often preferred for medium and light shades of the same colour. Marrone is the most common word for brown, although in some compound names (as will be said further on) bruno is sometimes used. Also arancio (orange) is often called arancione, same colour. Many more shades can be described by using the two adjectives chiaro (pale, light) and scuro (deep, dark). A few examples: VIOLA CHIARO

VIOLA

VIOLA SCURO

ARANCIO CHIARO

ARANCIO

ARANCIO SCURO

VERDE CHIARO

VERDE

VERDE SCURO

This scheme may be theoretically used for any colour, although when a pale or deep shade has its own specific name, the latter is preferred (i.e. pink rather than pale red; ochre or tan rather than deep yellow; etc.). Many colours have a specific name taken from a fruit, an animal, a gem, or anything else in nature which may recall the particular shade. A few examples: ROSSO ARAGOSTA (lobster red) ROSSO SANGUE (blood red) VERDE PISELLO (pea green) VERDE MUSCHIO (musk green) BRUNO MOGANO (mahogany brown)

AZZURRO CIELO (sky blue) BLU NOTTE (night blue) GIALLO LIMONE (lemon yellow) GRIGIO TOPO (mouse grey) GRIGIO PERLA (pearl grey)

For the most common ones, usually only the second part is used, i.e. aragosta (lobster) instead of rosso aragosta (lobster red), crema (cream) instead of giallo crema (cream yellow), and so on. But when the shade's name might be misunderstood, it is better to use color (colour) in front of it: color aragosta, color limone, color mogano, etc. Color is the same word colore, shortened for phonetic reasons when it is followed by the name of a shade.

Very few foreign names are also used for colours, and two of them are rather common: BEIGE

BORDEAUX

COLOURS USED AS NOUNS When they are used as nouns, colours require a definite article of masculine gender, which phonetically matches their first letter. The article is needed since the name refers to the word colore (colour), masculine, usually omitted for the most common ones. rosso = red il rosso, il colore rosso = red, the colour red verde = green il verde, il colore verde = green, the colour green azzurro = blue l'azzurro, il colore azzurro = blue, the colour blue viola = violet / purple il viola, il colore viola = violet / purple, the colour violet / purple ocra = ochre l'ocra, il colore ocra = ochre, the colour ochre Therefore, colours are always treated as masculine nouns, and the choice of the article is made according to their first letter. In Italian, as well as in English, it is also possible to use plural forms, which indicate the different shades of a given colour, i.e. the greens, the reds, and so on. But in doing so, these names behave according to the following rule (also valid for adjectives, as will be said further on): • nouns whose ending is masculine (...-o; ...-e) form a normal masculine plural (...-i in both cases); • nouns whose ending is feminine, or however different, do not change, using the same form for both singular and plural. il rosso = red, the colour red i rossi = the reds (the shades of red) l'azzurro = blue, the colour blue gli azzurri = the blues (the shades of blue) il verde = green, the colour green i verdi = the greens (the shades of green) ...BUT il viola = violet, the colour violet i viola = the violets (the shades of violet) il rosa = pink, the colour pink i rosa = the pinks (the shades of pink) Whether the latter nouns are singular or plural can only be told by the article (not by the colour's ending).

COLOURS USED AS ADJECTIVES Once again, when the colour's name has a masculine ending it behaves as a normal adjective, with regular masculine and feminine, singular and plural forms: il vaso giallo = the yellow vase i vasi gialli = the yellow vases la tazza gialla = the yellow cup

le tazze gialle = the yellow cups il vaso verde = the green vase i vasi verdi = the green vases la tazza verde = the green cup le tazze verdi = the green cups Instead, when the ending of the colour's name is not masculine (i.e. feminine, or foreign), the same form is used for both masculine and feminine, singular and plural. il vaso viola = the purple vase i vasi viola = the purple vases la tazza viola = the purple cup le tazze viola = the purple cups il vaso beige = the beige vase i vasi beige = the beige vases la tazza beige = the beige cup le tazze beige = the beige cups

17.3 DIVIDING WORDS INTO SYLLABLES The correct division of Italian words into their relevant syllables is necessary when they have to be split by the right end of a line of text. In fact, a word cannot be freely split, having this to be done specifically between two syllables: dividivisdivisidivisiodivisione sione ione one ne (division) [correct] [wrong] [wrong] [correct] Phonetically speaking, the syllable is the smallest fraction of a word, pronounced as a single sound. There are general rules according to which syllables are defined: the following table should be used as a reference or, even better, learned. According to their sound, consonants are divided into the following categories:

GROUP A

GROUP B

consonants

English sound

category

sound emission

c·g·q

k·g·q

guttural

by applying the base of the tongue to the throat

c · g (before e or i )

ch, j

palatal

by touching the palate with the tongue

t·d

t·d

dental

by applying the tip of the tongue to the front teeth

p·b·f·v

p·b·f·v

labial

by using the lips

s·z

s · tz · dz

sibilant

whose sound is similar to a hiss

m·n

m·n

nasal

by letting air pass through the nasal cavities

l·r

l · r (rolled)

liquid

whose sound is somewhat fluid

The table shows them divided into two groups, A and B, since in forming syllables they often behave in different ways (see samples below). •

The most simple syllables are formed by one consonant followed by one vowel:

matita (pencil) ma - ti - ta ruvido (rough) ru - vi - do pagavo (I payed) pa - ga - vo potare (to prune) po - ta - re sapone (soap) sa - po - ne However, any of the following situations overrides this rule. Any two consonants followed by a vowel belong to the same syllable: treno (train) tre - no scivolare (to slide, to slip) sci - vo - la - re sovrano (sovereign) so - vra - no ladro (thief) la - dro chimica (chemistry) chi - mi - ca segnare (to sign, to mark) se - gna - re In these cases, the first consonant is always from group A (guttural, palatal, dental, labial), sometimes forming with the second consonant a special cluster, i.e. -chi-, -che-, -gli-, -gni-, etc., see paragraph 1.2.

Seldom, three consonants may occur before a vowel in one same syllable, provided that the first one is an s: schivo (shy, bashful) schi - vo scrivere (to write) scri - ve - re strano (strange) stra - no spremere (to squeeze) spre - me - re fischi (whistles) fi - schi stirare (to iron, to flatten) sti - ra - re

Any double consonant must be split into two subsequent syllables: gatto (cat) gat - to mappa (map) map - pa cappotto (coat) cap - pot - to possessore (owner) pos - ses - so - re grattare (to scratch) grat - ta - re carrozza (carriage, wagon) car - roz - za By the effects of this rule, syllables may end with any consonant.

When a nasal or liquid consonant (l, r, m, n) is followed by any other consonant, they have to be split, i.e. as if they were double: tenda (curtain, tent) ten - da perla (pearl) per - la rimbalzo (rebound) rim - bal - zo cantante (singer) can - tan - te trenta (thirty) tren - ta polmone (lung) pol - mo - ne Also in this case a syllable may end with a consonant (l, r, m, n). Instead the reverse order may coexist in the same syllable; due to the sound, this mainly occurs with liquid consonants r and, seldom, l: decreto (decree, bill) de - cre - to padre (father) pa - dre tigre (tiger) ti - gre riflesso (reflex) ri - fles - so vetrina (shop-window) ve - tri - na ladro (thief) la - dro

A vowel alone may form a syllable at the beginning of a word if followed by a consonant: isola (island) i - so - la animale (animal) a - ni - ma - le odore (smell) o - do - re umido (damp, humid) u - mi - do aratro (plough) a - ra - tro evolvere (to evolve) e - vol - ve - re

However, when the following consonant is either nasal or liquid and any further consonant comes after it, i.e. vowel + nasal or liquid consonant + any consonant (such as alt..., enc..., imp..., ond..., urg..., and so on), the first syllable binds to the vowel, to accomplish the previous rule: intero (whole) in - te - ro andare (to go) an - da - re ultimo (last) ul - ti - mo imparare (to learn) im - pa - ra - re urgente (urgent) ur - gen - te onda (wave) on - da Also in the case of an opening vowel followed by any double consonant, the latter has to bind to the vowel; this is consistent with the aforesaid rule according to which all double consonants must be split: anno (year) an - no errore (mistake) er - ro - re accludere (to enclose) ac - clu - de - re eccesso (excess) ec - ces - so appendere (to hang) ap - pen - de -re osservato (observed, looked at) os - ser - va - to illuminare (to give light) il - lu - mi - na - re •

Two subsequent vowels behave in different ways according to whether they form a diphthong, i.e. a single sound which contains two vowels. Diphthongues are formed by the combination of different kinds of vowels: o i and u are called "semivowels", because they have a weaker (shorter, less sharp) sound; o a, e and o are called "strong vowels". a diphthongue is formed by a semivowel and strong vowel, or vice-versa, or by two semivowels: -ia- -ie- -io- -ua- -ue- -uo-ai- -ei- -oi- -au- -eu- -ou-iu- -uiTwo strong vowels (-ae- -ao- -ea- -eo- -oa- -oe-) and all double vowels do not form a diphthong.

Diphthongues are never split, and belong to the same syllable: buono (good) buo - no viale (avenue) via - le chiodo (nail) chio - do Claudio (Claude) Clau - dio quadro (picture, painting) qua - dro schiavo (slave) schia - vo Other combinations have to be split; also in this case vowels alone may form an individual syllable, in any part of the word, to accomplish this rule: idea (idea) i - de - a reato (offence) re - a - to paese (country) pa - e - se Colosseo (Colosseum) Co - los - se - o cooperativo (cooperative) co - o - pe - ra - ti - vo linee (lines) li - ne - e When a word begins with a diphthongue, its first syllable contains both vowels. ieri (yesterday) ie - ri uovo (egg) uo - vo aumento (increase) au - men - to Europa (Europe) Eu - ro - pa Ionio (Ionian) [sea] Io - nio Words with three or more syllables in a row are very scarce; these are two among the most common ones with such a feature: aiuola (flower bed) has four vowels in a row, and its syllables are: a - iuo - la; guaio (mishap) has four vowels in a row, and its syllables are: gua - io. Also in these cases the aforesaid rules are applied, although they appear less evident. In the first case, the break occurs between two strong vowels, while the remaining three, two weak ones and one strong, may stay together (a - iuo). The latter three form a triptongue, i.e. three vowels bound together,

quite a unique cluster in Italian words. In the second case the break occurs between two diphthongues (ua - io).

To summarize the main rules for dividing a word into its syllables, remember that: • all syllables must contain at least one vowel, which is their strong sound, while they do not necessarily need a consonant: syllables without vowels do not exist, while syllables without consonants do exist; • all doubles, i.e. identical letters (either consonants or vowels), must be split; • also nasal or liquid consonants (group B) may not be followed by one from group A (guttural, palatal, dental, labial), while the opposite may occur: A+B is possible, but not B+A; • most syllables end with a vowel, but they may also end with a consonant (no more than one) by effect of the previous rules; • two subsequent and different vowels do not split only if they form a diphthong, elseways they do; • syllables may range in length from a minimum of one letter (a vowel) to a maximum of five letters (i.e. three consonants followed by a diphthongue). There are many monosyllabic words, which cannot be split since they are made of only one syllable. The most common ones are: • definite articles (il, lo, la, i, gli, le); • simple prepositions (di, a, da, in, con, su, per, tra, fra); • several conjunctions (e, o, ma, sì, no, etc.); • most personal pronouns (io, tu, te, ti, lui, lei, gli, le, noi, ci, voi, vi, si etc.); • many indicative pronouns (quel, qui, qua, lì, là); • two numbers (tre, sei); • some short words of daily use (blu, più, già, giù, etc.). Also some short words whose origin is not Italian are monosyllabic: the last consonant (or consonants) they end with cannot be left without a final vowel, thus they cannot be separated from the rest of the word: tram (tramway) bar (bar, cafe) sport (sport) golf (golf, or pullover) gong (gong) smog (smog) sprint (sprint, stamina)

18.1 THE GERUND TENSE ALSO INTRODUCING THE VERB STARE

Gerund is the tense which expresses an action in progress (being, coming, seeing, etc.). The Italian gerund is very easy, modelled on the inflection ...endo, except for verbs of the 1st conjugation, whose penultimate vowel is a (...ando): 1st conj. mangiare (to eat) mangiando (eating) 2st conj. cadére (to fall) cadendo (falling) 2st conj. pèrdere (to lose) perdendo (losing) 3st conj. capire (to understand) capendo (understanding) When gerund is referred to a specific person it behaves as a compound verb, requiring an auxiliary verb. In English this verb is always to be (I am staying, he was watching, etc.), while Italian uses stare, a verb of the 1st conjugation. Stare can be simply translated to be, though it has a specific meaning of to be present, to exist (either for a given condition or for a physical object). Stare is used with the gerund tense of both transitive and intransitive verbs. It has a couple of slightly irregular present inflections (shown in red colour): PRESENTE singular plural 1st person (io) sto I am (noi) stiamo we are 2nd person you are (singular) you are (plural) (tu) stai (voi) state 3rd person (egli / ella) sta he/she/it is (essi / esse) stanno they are

IMPERFETTO 1st person 2nd person 3rd person

singular (io) stavo (tu) stavi (egli / ella) stava

I was you were (singular) he/she/it was

plural (noi) stavamo (voi) stavate (essi / esse) stavano

we were you were (plural) they were

Since this verb will be now used only with gerund, it is enough to practice the aforesaid present and imperfect tenses; others will be discussed in a future paragraph. As in English, the gerund's auxiliary verb may be take the present tense and the past tense (imperfect in Italian), thus obtaining a present gerund and a past gerund. The following tables show both of them for the verb pensare (to think). GERUNDIO PRESENTE 1st person 2nd person 3rd person

singular (io) sto pensando I am thinking you are thinking (s.) (tu) stai pensando (egli / ella) sta pensando he/she is thinking

plural (noi) stiamo pensando we are thinking you are thinking (p.) (voi) state pensando (essi / esse) stanno pensando they are thinking

GERUNDIO PASSATO 1st person 2nd person 3rd person

singular I was thinking (io) stavo pensando you were thinking (s.) (tu) stavi pensando (egli / ella) stava pensando he/she was thinking

plural (noi) stavamo pensando (voi) stavate pensando (essi / esse) stavano pensando

we were thinking you were thinking (p.) they were thinking

In Italian, gerund is used more sparingly than in English. It is required to express either the lapse of time during which an action is carried out, or by which means the other action occurs. comprerò la cena tornando a casa = I will buy the dinner (while) coming home ha guadagnato questo denaro vendendo libri = he/she earned this money (by) selling books ha appreso questa notizia leggendo il giornale = he learned about this news (by / while) reading the paper

In most cases it is also possible to reverse the position of the gerund, to give the other action a stronger emphasis: tornando a casa comprerò la cena = (while) coming home I will buy the dinner vendendo libri ha guadagnato questo denaro = (by) selling books he/she earned this money leggendo il giornale ha appreso questa notizia = (by / while) reading the paper he learned about this news For simple actions in progress, such as I am writing, he was sleeping, etc., proper Italian would require a gerund, as well. In common speech, though, this is very often replaced by present indicative or by imperfect indicative: sto mangiando (more colloquially: mangio) = I am reading stavamo correndo (more colloquially: correvamo) = we were running stanno studiando storia (more colloquially: studiano storia) = they are studying history NOTE In Italian, the gerund is never used to express the verb impersonally, as to describe an activity, as it is in English. For this purpose, in Italian either the infinitive tense or a specific noun referred to the verb are used: leggere (or la lettura) è una cosa positiva = reading is a positive thing odio guardare la televisione = I hate watching the television fumare (or il fumo) è una cattiva abitudine = smoking (or smoke) is a bad habit correre (or la corsa) è uno sport molto comune = running is a very common sport dormire (or il sonno) è la nostra attività preferita = sleeping is our favourite activity

18.2 PRESENT PARTICIPLE AND

PAST PARTICIPLE PRESENT PARTICIPLE The present participle is a tense which in Italian does not act as a verb, becoming either a noun or an adjective. It indicates who carries out the action expressed by the verb, either temporarily or continuously (i.e. as a job, or as a condition). To obtain the present participle, the standard inflections ...ante (1st conjugation) and ...ente (2nd and 3rd conjugations) are applied to the root of the verb. English has no matching tense, so that the Italian present participle may be translated in most cases either with a noun whose suffix is ...er or with an adjective in the shape of a gerundive (...ing).

1st conjugation lavare (to wash) navigare (to sail) camminare (to walk) 2nd conjugation

lavante (he who washes, washing, washer) navigante (he who sails, sailing, sailer) camminante (he who walks, walking, walker)

vedere (to see, to watch) perdere (to lose) chiedere (to ask for)

vedente (he who sees, seeing) perdente (he who loses, loser) chiedente (he who asks for, asking, asker)

3rd conjugation coprente (he who covers, covering) coprire (to cover) capente (he who understands, understanding) capire (to understand) morente (he who dies, dying) morire (to die) A few verbs of the 3rd conjugation may use a double inflection, i.e. the ordinary one (...ente) and one with an i added (...iente). For instance, dormire (to sleep) has both dormente and dormiente, while nutrire (to nourish) has nutriente, much more common than nutrente (regular participle). The same for partorire (to give birth, to deliver a baby), whose form partoriente is always preferred to the regular one. The use of present participles in modern Italian is somewhat limited; many of the ones still found come from archaic verbs no longer used (i.e. they are no longer considered participles, but nouns or adjectives), or they are often irregular, or follow the archaic Latin verb, or come from a modified root of a normal verb, or are even based on verbs that do not exist. il mittente della lettera = the sender of the letter (from the Latin verb mittere = to send) l'acquirente = the buyer (from the verb acquistare = to buy, with an irregular present participle) il brigante = the brigand, the bandit (from the almost obsolete verb brigare = to intrigue, to scheme for) piccante = hot, spicy (from a theorical verb piccare, which does not actually exist) il garante del patto = the guarantor of the deal (from the verb garantire = to guarantee, with a contracted participle) l'inserviente = the shop-boy, the assistant, the servant (from the verb servire = to serve, with an extra i, plus preposition in) In everyday's speech not many present participles are used, but some of them are quite common: una persona non udente = a non-hearing person, a deaf person (from udire = to hear) l'acqua bollente = the boiling water (from bollire = to boil, to be boiling) una cosa importante = an important thing (from importare = to matter, to be of importance) il giocatore vincente = the winning player (from vincere = to win) l'agente di polizia = the police officer, the policeman (from agire = to act, to take action) il battente della porta = the door's knocker (from battere = to hit, to knock) il sole nascente = the rising sun (from nascere = to be born, literally the sun being born) The reason for which not many present participles are used is that for many activities a specific nouns exists to describe he or she who carries out the action, and they do not necessarily match the present participle of the verb. For instance: l'attaccante = the forward of a team (present participle of attaccare = to attack) ...BUT il difensore = the defender (noun from difendere = to defend) il cantante = the singer (present participle of cantare = to sing) ...BUT l'attore = the actor (noun from agire = to act, take action) il sorvegliante = the watchman, the caretaker (present participle of sorvegliare = to watch over) ...BUT il custode = the caretaker, the guardian (noun from custodire = to keep, watch over) When a present participle is used as a noun or as an adjective, sometimes its meaning changes from that of the original verb, or becomes metaphorical: contante (p.participle of contare = to count) as a masculine noun means cash money; sorgente (p.participle of sorgere = to rise) as a feminine noun means spring, source (of a river); pulsante (p.participle of pulsare = to pulse, throb) as a masculine noun means button (to press); corrente (p.participle of correre = to run) as a feminine noun means draft, air current; passante (p.participle of passare = to pass) as a masculine noun means loop (of a belt).

scattante (p.participle of scattare = to spring, to jump off a spring) as an adjective means fast, ready, full of vigour. In any case, when a participle is used as a noun or as an adjective, it will have singular and plural forms. Both masculine and feminine will be similar, because they are nouns and adjectives ending with ...e, so their plurals will be ...i for both genders. lo spettatore pagante = the paying spectator gli spettatori paganti = the paying spectators la bagnante = the (female) bather, the woman who bathes le bagnanti = the (female) bathers, the women who bathe il cantante = the (male) singer la cantante = the (female) singer i cantanti = the (male) singers le cantanti = the (female) singers

PAST PARTICIPLE

This tense has already been already dealt with in paragraph 6.1 and particularly in paragraph 6.3, because the past participle is needed to form all compound tenses. Therefore, these concepts will be only summarized once again in this page. The most common past participle inflections for the three conjugations are: 1st conjugation: ...ato 2nd conjugation: ...uto 2nd conjugation: ...ito parlare (to talk, speak) - parlato (talked, spoken) volare (to fly) - volato (flown) pensare (to think) - pensato (thought) vendere (to sell) - venduto (sold) cadere (to fall) - caduto (fallen) sedere (to sit down) - seduto (sit) capire (to understand) - capito (understood) seguire (to follow) - seguito (followed) partire (to leave) - partito (left) The auxiliary verb avere (to have) forms a regular past participle, avuto. The other auxiliary verb, essere (to be), does not have its own, and borrows it from the verb stare, recently discussed, whose meaning is similar: stato, which acts as the past participle of both verbs stare and essere. Some verbs (in particular, belonging to the 2nd and 3rd conjugations) do not follow this scheme, since other past participle inflections do exist. A sample of each is shown below, but for more examples see again paragraph 6.3. prendere (to take) - preso (taken) mettere (to put, to place) - messo (put, placed) spingere (to push) - spinto (pushed) leggere (to read) - letto (read) chiedere (to ask) - chiesto (asked) aprire (to open) - aperto (opened)

18.3

VERBS WHOSE INFINITIVE IS CONTRACTED This small group of verbs has a particular infinitive tense, which ends with a double r (i.e. ...-rre) instead of the usual one ...(vowel)-re. They all come from Latin forms, whose inflection was regular (...ere), and whose penultimate and last syllables were contracted into a single one by doubling the last r. These few main verbs form a number of compounds, which have the same inflections: TRARRE = to draw, take from (from Latin traere) contrarre = to contract detrarre = to detract sottrarre = to subtract PORRE = to place, put (from Latin ponere) esporre = to expose, display imporre = to impose deporre = to let down, put down anteporre = to place in front, give preference to posporre = to postpone comporre = to compose, form ...DURRE [see NOTE below] (from Latin ducere = to conduct, lead) condurre = to conduct, lead tradurre = to translate and to transfer indurre = to induce dedurre = to deduct ridurre = to reduce produrre = to produce NOTE - durre does not exist alone, but only in its compounds These verbs basically follow the 2nd conjugation (see paragraph 4.6); the Latin root is used for all tenses, and only the future indicative and present conditional tenses keep the double r, which is a contraction of the Latin ending ...ere The following tables only show the simple tenses (compound tenses use the past participle, and do not have specific inflections). The few irregular inflections are marked in red. TRARRE and its compounds (Latin root: tra-) INDICATIVE PRESENTE singular plural 1st person (io) traggo I draw (noi) traiamo we draw 2nd person (tu) trai you draw (s.) (voi) traete you draw (p.) 3rd person (egli / ella) trae he/she draws (essi / esse) traggono they draw IMPERFETTO all inflections are regular (traevo, traevi, traeva, traevamo, traevate, traevano)

singular

FUTURO plural

1st person (io) trarrò I shall draw (noi) trarremo we shall draw 2nd person (tu) trarrai you will draw (s.) (voi) trarrete you will draw (p.) 3rd person (egli / ella) trarrà he/she will draw (essi / esse) trarranno they will draw

PASSATO REMOTO singular plural 1st person (io) trassi I drew (noi) traemmo we drew 2nd person (tu) traesti you drew (s.) (voi) traeste you drew (p.) 3rd person (egli / ella) trasse he/she drew (essi / esse) trassero they drew SUBJUNCTIVE PRESENTE singular plural 1st person (che io) tragga (that) I draw (che noi) traiamo (that) we draw 2nd person (che tu) tragga (that) you draw (s.) (che voi) traiate (that) you draw (p.) 3rd person (che egli / ella) tragga (that) he/she draws (che essi / esse) traggano (that) they draw IMPERFETTO singular plural 1st person (che io) traessi (that) I drew (che noi) traessimo (that) we drew 2nd person (che tu) traessi (that) you drew (s.) (che voi) traeste (that) you drew (p.) 3rd person (che egli / ella) traesse (that) he/she drew (che essi / esse) traessero (that) they drew CONDITIONAL PRESENTE singular plural 1st person (io) trarrei I would draw (noi) trarremmo we would draw 2nd person (tu) trarresti you would draw (s.) (voi) trarreste you would draw (p.) 3rd person (egli / ella) trarrebbe he/she would draw (essi / esse) trarrebbero they would draw

(tu) trai (voi) traete

IMPERATIVE (you) draw (singular) (you) draw (plural)

PARTICIPLES PRESENTE traente drawer, drawing

PASSATO tratto drawn

GERUND traendo drawing

PORRE and its compounds (Latin root: pon-)

INDICATIVE PRESENTE singular plural 1st person (io) pongo I place (noi) poniamo we place 2nd person (tu) poni you place (s.) (voi) ponete you place (p.) 3rd person (egli / ella) pone he/she places (essi / esse) pongono they place IMPERFETTO all inflections are regular (ponevo, ponevi, poneva, ponevamo, ponevate, ponevano) FUTURO singular plural 1st person (io) porrò I shall place (noi) porremo we shall place 2nd person (tu) porrai you will place (s.) (voi) porrete you will place (p.) 3rd person (egli / ella) porrà he/she will place (essi / esse) porranno they will place PASSATO REMOTO all inflections are regular (posi, ponesti, pose, ponemmo, poneste, posero) SUBJUNCTIVE PRESENTE singular plural 1st person (che io) ponga (that) I place (che noi) poniamo (that) we place 2nd person (che tu) ponga (that) you place (s.) (che voi) poniate (that) you place (p.) 3rd person (che egli / ella) ponga (that) he/she places (che essi / esse) pongano (that) they place IMPERFETTO all inflections are regular (che io / tu ponessi, che ponesse, che ponessimo, che poneste, che ponessero) CONDITIONAL PRESENTE singular plural 1st person (io) porrei I would place (noi) porremmo we would place 2nd person (tu) porresti you would place (s.) (voi) porreste you would place (p.) 3rd person (egli / ella) porrebbe he/she would place (essi / esse) porrebbero they would place

(tu) poni (voi) ponete

IMPERATIVE (you) place (singular) (you) place (plural)

PARTICIPLES PRESENTE ponente (never used; placer, placing actual meaning: the west)

PASSATO posto placed

GERUND ponendo placing

CONDURRE and other compounds of -durre (Latin root: ...duc-) INDICATIVE PRESENTE all inflections are regular (conduco, conduci, conduce, conduciamo, conducete, conducono) IMPERFETTO all inflections are regular (conducevo, conducevi, conduceva, conducevamo, conducevate, conducevano) FUTURO singular plural 1st person (io) condurrò I shall conduct (noi) condurremo we shall conduct 2nd person (tu) condurrai you will conduct (s.) (voi) condurrete you will conduct (p.) 3rd person (egli / ella) condurrà he/she will conduct (essi / esse) condurranno they will conduct PASSATO REMOTO singular plural 1st person (io) condussi I placed (noi) conducemmo we conducted you conducted (p.) 2nd person (tu) conducesti you conducted (s.) (voi) conduceste 3rd person (egli) condusse he/she conducted (essi / esse) condussero they conducted SUBJUNCTIVE PRESENTE all inflections are regular (che io / tu / egli / ella conduca, che conduciamo, che conduciate, che conducano) IMPERFETTO all inflections are regular (che io / tu conducessi, che conducesse, che conducessimo, che conduceste, che conducessero)

CONDITIONAL PRESENTE singular 1st person (io) condurrei I would conduct 2nd person (tu) condurresti you would conduct (s.) 3rd person (egli / ella) condurrebbe he/she would conduct

plural we would conduct (noi) condurremmo you would conduct (p.) (voi) condurreste (essi / esse) condurrebbero they would conduct

IMPERATIVE

(tu) conduci (voi) conducete

conducente

(you) conduct (singular) (you) conduct (plural)

PARTICIPLES PRESENTE conductor, driver (of a bus, train, etc.)

PASSATO condotto conducted

GERUND conducendo conducting

18.4 OTHER IMPORTANT IRREGULAR VERBS The verbs dealt with in this page are very commonly used. The irregular inflections only concern some persons and some tenses, which are marked in red. The irregularities may consist of a change of vowel, or the use of accented vowels in place of simple ones, or the same root may be different. Therefore, before memorizing these verbs be sure you are confident with the ordinary conjugations, described in chapter 4. In some cases two different inflections are possible: in this case they are shown in square brackets. All regular tenses are simply mentioned in a row. Irregular verbs are indeed difficult to memorize, but some of the changes found in their roots are repeated: for instance, the same changes found in the 1st singular person are also found in the 3rd plural one, and all the ones found in the present indicative also belong to present subjunctive, and the future indicative tense has similar changes to the present conditional. Keeping in mind these relations, it should be slightly easier to memorize them. This page shows the following verbs (click on each of them to reach the relevant table): = TO DO ANDARE = TO GO FARE = TO DRINK BERE POTERE = TO BE ABLE TO, CAN = TO GIVE DARE SAPERE = TO KNOW = TO SAY, TO TELL DIRE VENIRE = TO COME DOVERE = TO HAVE TO, MUST VOLERE = TO WANT

ANDARE (to go) This verb is only strongly irregular in its present tenses (indicative and subjunctive), while the others are not too far from the standard conjugation. INDICATIVE

singular 1st person (io) vado 2nd person (tu) vai

PRESENTE plural I go (noi) andiamo you go (sing.) (voi) andate

we go you go (pl.)

3rd person (egli / ella) va he/she goes

(essi / esse) vanno they go

[see the NOTE at the bottom of the section for the verb andare] IMPERFETTO all inflections are regular (andavo, andavi, andava, andavamo, andavate, andavano) FUTURO singular plural 1st person (io) andrò I shall go (noi) andremo we shall go 2nd person (tu) andrai you will go (sing.) (voi) andrete you will go (pl.) 3rd person (egli / ella) andrà he/she will go (essi / esse) andranno they will go PASSATO REMOTO all inflections are regular (andai, andasti, andò, andammo, andaste, andarono) SUBJUNCTIVE TENSES PRESENTE singular 1st person (che io) vada (that) I go 2nd person (che tu) vada (that) you go (sing.) 3rd person (che egli / ella) vada (that) he/she goes

plural (che noi) andiamo (that) we go (that) you go (pl.) (che voi) andiate (che essi / esse) vadano (that) they go

IMPERFETTO all inflections are regular (che io / tu andassi, che andasse, che andassimo, che andaste, che andassero) CONDITIONAL TENSES PRESENTE singular plural 1st person (io) andrei I would go (noi) andremmo we would go 2nd person (tu) andresti you would go (sing.) (voi) andreste you would go (pl.) 3rd person (egli / ella) andrebbe he/she would go (essi / esse) andrebbero they would go

(tu) và (voi) andate

IMPERATIVE (you) go (sing.) (you) go (pl.)

PARTICIPLES PRESENTE andante (rarely used) goer, going GERUND andando going

PASSATO andato gone

NOTE The second singular person of the indicative present tense (và = he / she goes) should use an accented vowel, but it has become a common custom to spell it va, without an accent, also to distinguish this tense from the imperative one, và = go!, when the subject (shown in light grey colour in the following example) is not clearly mentioned. egli / ella va via = he / she goes away tu và via = go away In the spoken language, both the context of the sentence and the voice pitch help to understand which of the two meanings is the right one: è tardi, ora egli / ella va via = it is late, now he / she goes (is going) away questo è un cortile privato, và via! = this is a private yard, go away!

BERE (to drink) This verb is not really irregular; due to the Latin verb it comes from (bevere), traces of the old root remained in most tenses, except the infinitive. Therefore, many of the irregular inflections are regular if referred to the latter form: try to think of the root as bev... and follow the usual 2nd conjugation. Only the future and the present conditional tenses contract the ..ver.. cluster into a double r, which is a true irregularity (i.e. as the verbs discussed in the previous page). INDICATIVE PRESENTE singular 1st person (io) bevo I drink 2nd person (tu) bevi you drink (sing.) 3rd person (egli / ella) beve he/she drinks

plural (noi) beviamo we drink you drink (pl.) (voi) bevete (essi / esse) bevono they drink

IMPERFETTO singular plural 1st person (io) bevevo I drank (noi) bevevamo we drank you drank (pl.) 2nd person (tu) bevevi you drank (sing.) (voi) bevevate 3rd person (egli / ella) beveva he/she drank (essi / esse) bevevano they drank FUTURO singular 1st person (io) berrò I shall drink 2nd person (tu) berrai you will drink (sing.) 3rd person (egli / ella) berrà he/she will drink

plural (noi) berremo we shall drink you will drink (pl.) (voi) berrete (essi / esse) berranno they will drink

PASSATO REMOTO singular plural 1st person (io) bevvi I drank (noi) bevemmo we drank 2nd person (tu) bevesti you gave (sing.) (voi) beveste you drank (pl.) 3rd person (egli / ella) bevve he/she gave (essi / esse)bevvero they drank SUBJUNCTIVE TENSES PRESENTE singular 1st person (che io) beva

(that) I drink

plural (che noi) beviamo

(that) we drink

2nd person (che tu) beva (that) you drink (sing.) (che voi) beviate (that) you drink (pl.) 3rd person (che egli / ella) beva (that) he/she drinks (che essi / esse) bevano (that) they drink IMPERFETTO singular 1st person (che io) bevessi (that) I drank 2nd person (che tu) bevessi (that) you drank (sing.) 3rd person (che egli / ella) bevesse (that) he/she drank

plural (that) we drank (che noi) bevessimo (that) you drank (pl.) (che voi) beveste (che essi / esse) bevessero (that) they drank

CONDITIONAL TENSES PRESENTE singular 1st person (io) berrei I would drink 2nd person (tu) berresti you would drink (sing.) 3rd person (egli / ella) berrebbe he/she would drink

plural (noi) berremmo we would drink you would drink (pl.) (voi) berreste (essi / esse) berrebbero they would drink

IMPERATIVE (you) drink (sing.) (tu) bevi (you) drink (pl.) (voi) bevete PARTICIPLES PRESENTE bevente drinking

PASSATO bevuto drunk GERUND

bevendo drinking

DARE (to give) This verb appears very irregular, but comparing its inflections with the regular ones of the 1st conjugation many of them turn out to have a simple change of vowel. INDICATIVE TENSES PRESENTE singular plural 1st person (io) do I give (noi) diamo we give 2nd person (tu) dai you give (sing.) (voi) date you give (pl.) 3rd person (egli / essa) dà he/she gives (essi / esse) danno they give IMPERFETTO all inflections are regular (dovevo, dovevi, doveva, dovevamo, dovevate, dovevano) FUTURO singular 1st person (io) darò [detti] I shall give 2nd person (tu) darai you will give (sing.) 3rd person (egli / essa) darà he/she will give

plural (noi) daremo we shall give you will give (pl.) (voi) darete (essi / esse) daranno they will give

PASSATO REMOTO

singular 1st person (io) diedi [detti] I gave 2nd person (tu) dasti you gave (sing.) 3rd person (egli / essa) diede [dette] he/she gave

plural (noi) demmo we gave you gave (pl.) (voi) deste (essi / esse) diedero [dettero] they gave

SUBJUNCTIVE TENSES PRESENTE singular 1st person (che io) dia (that) I give 2nd person (che tu) dia (that) you give (sing.) 3rd person (che egli / ella) dia (that) he/she gives

plural (che noi) diamo (that) we give (that) you give (pl.) (che voi) diate (che essi / esse) diano (that) they give

IMPERFETTO singular plural 1st person (che io) dessi (that) I gave (che noi) dessimo (that) we gave 2nd person (che tu) dessi (that) you gave (sing.) (che voi) deste (that) you gave (pl.) 3rd person (che egli / ella) desse (that) he/she gaves (che essi / esse) dessero (that) they gave CONDITIONAL TENSES PRESENTE singular 1st person (io) darei I would give 2nd person (tu) daresti you would give (sing.) 3rd person (egli / ella) darebbe he/she would give

plural (noi) daremmo we would give you would give (pl.) (voi) dareste (essi / esse) darebbero they would give

IMPERATIVE (you) give (sing.) (tu) dà [dai] (you) give (pl.) (voi) date PARTICIPLES PRESENTE dante (rarely used) giver, giving

PASSATO dato given

GERUND dando giving

DIRE (to say, to tell) This is a verb of the 3rd conjugation born as a contraction of the Latin equivalent dicere. As for bere, previously discussed, also in this case many of the irregular inflections are regular ones of the 2nd conjugation which survived the verb's change (i.e. try thinking of the root as dic... instead of d..., and most irregular inflections turn out regular). INDICATIVE TENSES PRESENTE singular 1st person (io) dico 2nd person (tu) dici

plural I say (noi) diciamo you say (sing.) (voi) dite

we say you say (pl.)

3rd person (egli / ella) dice he/she says

(essi / esse) dicono they say

IMPERFETTO singular plural 1st person (io) dicevo I said (noi) dicevamo we said 2nd person (tu) dicevi you said (sing.) (voi) dicevate you said (pl.) 3rd person (egli / ella) diceva he/she said (essi / esse) dicevano they said FUTURO all inflections are regular (dirò, dirai, dirà, diremo, direte, diranno) PASSATO REMOTO singular plural 1st person (io) dissi I said (noi) dicemmo we said 2nd person (tu) dicesti you said (sing.) (voi) diceste you said (pl.) 3rd person (egli / ella) disse he/she said (essi / esse) dissero they said SUBJUNCTIVE TENSES PRESENTE singular 1st person (che io) dica (that) I say 2nd person (che tu) dica (that) you say (sing.) 3rd person (che egli / ella) dica (that) he/she says

plural (che noi) dicessi (that) we say (that) you say (pl.) (che voi) diceste (che essi / esse) dicano (that) they say

IMPERFETTO singular plural 1st person (che io) dicessi (that) I said (che noi) dicessimo (that) we said 2nd person (che tu) dicessi (that) you said (sing.) (che voi) diceste (that) you said (pl.) 3rd person (che egli / ella) dicesse (that) he/she said (che essi / esse) dicessero (that) they said

(tu) dì (voi) dite

IMPERATIVE (you) say (sing.) (you) say (pl.)

PARTICIPLES PRESENTE dicente (rarely used) sayer, saying

PASSATO detto said

GERUND dicendo saying

DOVERE (to have to, must) This is another verb with a few Latin reminiscences. In particular, the letter v often turns into a double b, sometimes with a change of vowel too.

INDICATIVE TENSES PRESENTE singular plural 1st person (io) debbo [devo] I have to (noi) dobbiamo we have to 2nd person (tu) devi you have to (sing.) (noi) dovete you have to (pl.) 3rd person (egli / ella) deve he/she has to (essi / esse) debbono [devono] they have to IMPERFETTO all inflections are regular (dovevo, dovevi, doveva, dovevamo, dovevate, dovevano) FUTURO singular 1st person (io) dovrò I shall have to 2nd person (tu) dovrai you will have to (sing.) 3rd person (egli / ella) dovrà he/she will have to

plural (noi) dovremo we shall have to you will have to (pl.) (voi) dovrete (essi / esse) dovranno they will have to

PASSATO REMOTO singular plural 1st person (io) dovetti I had to (noi) dovemmo we had to 2nd person (tu) dovesti You had to (sing.) (voi) doveste you had to (pl.) 3rd person (egli / ella) dovette he/she had to (essi / esse) dovettero they had to SUBJUNCTIVE TENSES PRESENTE singular 1st person (che io) debba [deva] (that) I have to 2nd person (che tu) debba [deva] (that) you have to (sing.) 3rd person (che egli / ella) debba [deva] (that) he/she has to

plural (that) we have to (che noi) dobbiamo (that) you have to (pl.) (che voi) dobbiate (che essi / esse) debbano (that) they have to

IMPERFETTO all inflections are regular (che io / tu dovessi, che dovesse, che dovessimo, che doveste, che dovessero)

IMPERATIVE (not used) PARTICIPLES PRESENTE dovente (never used) doer, doing GERUND dovendo having to

PASSATO dovuto had to, due

FARE (to do) This verb comes from Latin facere, and some irregularities are explained by the old root (fac...). The future and conditional tenses, instead, are basically regular, but the inflections start with vowel ..a.. instead of the usual ..e... INDICATIVE TENSES PRESENTE singular plural 1st person (io) faccio I do (noi) facciamo we do 2nd person (tu) fai you do (sing.) (voi) fate you do (pl.) 3rd person (egli / ella) fa he/she does (essi / esse) fanno they do IMPERFETTO Singular plural 1st person (io) facevo I did (noi) facevamo we did 2nd person (tu) facevi you did (sing.) (voi) facevate you did (pl.) 3rd person (egli / ella) faceva he/she did (essi / essa) facevano they did FUTURO singular 1st person (io) farò I shall do 2nd person (tu) farai you will do (sing.) 3rd person (egli / ella) farà he/she will do

plural (noi) faremo we shall do you will do (pl.) (voi) farete (essi / esse) faranno they will do

PASSATO REMOTO Singular plural 1st person (io) feci I did (noi) facemmo we did 2nd person (tu) facesti you did (sing.) (voi) faceste you did (pl.) 3rd person (egli / ella) fece he/she did (essi / esse) fecero they did SUBJUNCTIVE TENSES PRESENTE singular 1st person (che io) faccia (that) I do 2nd person (che tu) faccia (that) you do (sing.) 3rd person (che egli / ella) faccia (that) he/she does

plural (che) facciamo (that) we do (che) facciate (that) you do (pl.) (che) facciano (that) they do

IMPERFETTO singular plural 1st person (che io) facessi (that) I did (che noi) facessimo (that) we did 2nd person (che tu) fcessi (that) you did (sing.) (che voi) faceste (that) you did (pl.) 3rd person (che egli / ella) facesse (that) he/she did (che essi / esse) facessero (that) they did CONDITIONAL TENSES PRESENTE singular 1st person (io) farei 2nd person (tu) faresti

plural I would do (noi) faremmo you would do (sing.) (voi) fareste

we would do you would do (pl.)

3rd person (egli / ella) farebbe he/she would do

(tu) fà [fai] (voi) fate

(essi / esse) farebbero they would do

IMPERATIVE (you) do (sing.) (you) do (pl.) PARTICIPLES

PRESENTE facente doer, doing

PASSATO fatto done

GERUND facendo doing

POTERE (to be able to, can) The syllable ..te.. is often modified in different ways, sometimes contracted into a double s, sometimes by dropping the vowel e. INDICATIVE TENSES PRESENTE singular plural 1st person (io) posso I can (noi) possiamo we can 2nd person (tu) puoi you can (sing.) (voi) potete you can (pl.) 3rd person (egli / ella) può he/she can (essi / esse) possono they can IMPERFETTO all inflections are regular (potevo, potevi, poteva, potevamo, potevate, potevano) FUTURO singular 1st person (io) potrò I shall will be able to 2nd person (tu) potrai you will will be able to (sing.) 3rd person (egli / ella) potrà he/she will will be able to

plural we will be able to (noi) potremo you will be able to (pl.) (voi) potrete (essi / esse) potranno they will be able to

PASSATO REMOTO singular plural 1st person (io) potei I could (noi) potemmo we could 2nd person (tu) potesti you could (sing.) (voi) poteste you could (pl.) 3rd person (egli / ella) potè he/she could (essi / esse) poterono they could SUBJUNCTIVE TENSES PRESENTE singular 1st person (che io) possa 2nd person (che tu) possa

plural (that) I can (che noi) possiamo (that) you can (sing.) (che voi) possiate

(that) we can (that) you can (pl.)

3rd person (che egli / ella) possa (that) he/she can

(che essi / esse) possano (that) they can

IMPERFETTO all inflections are regular (che io / tu potessi, che potesse, che potessimo, che poteste, che potessero) CONDITIONAL TENSES PRESENTE singular plural 1st person (io) potrei I could (noi) potremmo we could 2nd person (tu) potresti you could (sing.) (voi) potreste you could (pl.) 3rd person (egli) potrebbe he/she could (essi / esse) potrebbero they could IMPERATIVE (not used) PARTICIPLES PRESENTE potente (never used; actual meaning: powerful, mighty)

PASSATO potuto been able to

able to GERUND

potendo being able to

SAPERE (to know) Sapere has quite a few irregularities in the present indicative tense and, unlike other verbs, they do not match the ones found in the present subjunctive. In several inflections the syllable ..pe.. is contracted into a double p. INDICATIVE TENSES PRESENTE singular plural 1st person (io) so I know (noi) sappiamo we know 2nd person (tu) sai you know (sing.) (voi) sapete you know (pl.) 3rd person (egli / ella) sa he/she knows (essi / esse) sanno they know IMPERFETTO all inflections are regular (sapevo, sapevi, sapeva, sapevamo, sapevate, sapevano) FUTURO singular 1st person (io) saprò I shall know 2nd person (tu) saprai you will know (sing.) 3rd person (egli / ella) saprà he/she will know

plural (noi) sapremo we shall know you will know (pl.) (voi) saprete (essi / esse) sapranno they will know

PASSATO REMOTO

singular 1st person (io) seppi I knew 2nd person (tu) sapesti you knew (sing.) 3rd person (egli / ella) seppe he/she knew

plural (noi) sapemmo we knew you knew (pl.) (voi) sapeste (essi / esse) seppero they knew

SUBJUNCTIVE TENSES PRESENTE singular 1st person (che io) sappia (that) I know 2nd person (che tu) sappia (that) you know (sing.) 3rd person (che egli / ella) sappia (that) he/she knows

plural (che noi) sappiamo (that) we know (that) you know (pl.) (che voi) sappiate (che essi / esse) sappiano (that) they know

IMPERFETTO all inflections are regular (che io / tu sapessi, che sapesse, che sapessimo, che sapeste, che sapessero) CONDITIONAL TENSES PRESENTE singular 1st person (io) saprei I would know 2nd person (tu) sapresti you would know (sing.) 3rd person (egli / ella) saprebbe he/she would know

plural (noi) sapremmo we would know you would know (pl.) (voi) sapreste (essi / esse) saprebbero they would know

IMPERATIVE (not used) PARTICIPLES PRESENTE sapiente knower (never used as a participle) (actual meaning: wise man)

PASSATO saputo known

GERUND sapendo knowing

VENIRE (to do) This verb features a strongly irregular present tense, in which ..n.. sometimes turns into cluster ..ng.., and ..e.. sometimes turns into diphthong ..ie... In some tenses, the syllable ..ni.. is contracted into a double n, or into a double r. INDICATIVE TENSES PRESENTE singular plural 1st person (io) vengo I come (noi) veniamo we come 2nd person (tu) vieni you come (sing.) (voi) venite you come (pl.) 3rd person (egli / ella) viene he/she comes (essi / esse) vengono they come

IMPERFETTO all inflections are regular (venivo, venivi, veniva, venivamo, venivate, venivano) FUTURO singular 1st person (io) verrò I shall come 2nd person (tu) verrai you will come (sing.) 3rd person (egli / ella) verrà he/she will come

plural (noi) verremo we shall come you will come (pl.) (voi) verrete (essi / esse) verranno they will come

PASSATO REMOTO singular plural 1st person (io) venni I came (noi) venimmo we came 2nd person (tu) venisti you came (sing.) (voi) veniste you came (pl.) 3rd person (egli / ella) venne he/she came (essi / esse) vennero they came SUBJUNCTIVE TENSES PRESENTE singular 1st person (che io) venga (that) I come 2nd person (che tu) venga (that) you come (sing.) 3rd person (che egli / ella) venga (that) he/she comes

plural (che noi) veniamo (that) we come (that) you come (pl.) (che voi) veniate (che essi / esse) vengano (that) they come

IMPERFETTO all inflections are regular (che io / tu venissi, che venisse, che venissimo, che veniste, che venissero) CONDITIONAL TENSES PRESENTE singular plural 1st person (io) verrei I would come (noi) verremmo we would come 2nd person (tu) verresti you would come (sing.) (voi) verreste you would come (pl.) 3rd person (egli) verrebbe he/she would come (essi / esse) verrebbero they would come IMPERATIVE (you) come (sing.) (tu) vieni (you) come (pl.) (voi) venite PARTICIPLES PRESENTE venente (never used) comer, coming GERUND venendo coming

PASSATO venuto come

VOLERE (to want) This verb has some similarities with the present verb, venire: a very irregular present tense, in which some inflections curiously change the standard root's l into cluster gli, while others change the vowel o into diphthong uo. Also in this case some tenses have a double l or a double r, as a contaction of the central syllable, ...le.... INDICATIVE TENSES PRESENTE singular plural 1st person (io) voglio I want (noi) vogliamo we want 2nd person (tu) vuoi you want (sing.) (voi) volete you want (pl.) 3rd person (egli / ella) vuole he/she wants (essi / esse) vogliono they want IMPERFETTO all inflections are regular (volevo, volevi, voleva, volevamo, volevate, volevano) FUTURO singular 1st person (io) vorrò I shall want 2nd person (tu) vorrai you will want (sing.) 3rd person (egli / ella) vorrà he/she will want

plural we shall want (noi) vorremo you will want (pl.) (voi) vorrete (essi / esse) vorranno they will want

PASSATO REMOTO singular plural 1st person (io) volli I came (noi) volemmo we came 2nd person (tu) volesti you came (sing.) (voi) voleste you came (pl.) 3rd person (egli / ella) volle he/she came (essi / esse) vollero they came SUBJUNCTIVE TENSES PRESENTE singular 1st person (che io) voglia (that) I want 2nd person (che tu) voglia (that) you want (sing.) 3rd person (che egli / ella) voglia (that) he/she wants

plural (che noi) vogliamo (that) we want (that) you want (pl.) (che voi) vogliate (che essi / esse) vogliano (that) they want

IMPERFETTO all inflections are regular (che io / tu volessi, che volesse, che volessimo, che voleste, che volessero) CONDITIONAL TENSES PRESENTE singular plural 1st person (io) vorrei I would want (noi) vorremmo we would want 2nd person (tu) vorresti you would want (sing.) (voi) vorreste you would want (pl.) 3rd person (egli) vorrebbe he/she would want (essi / esse) vorrebbero they would want IMPERATIVE

(not used) PARTICIPLES PRESENTE volente (rarely used) wanter, wanting

PASSATO voluto wanted

GERUND volendo wanting

19.1 PASSIVE Passive describes an action as seen from the side of whom receives it: i.e. I buy an apple, thus the apple is bought by me; if the bird eats a worm, obviously the worm is eaten by the bird; and so on. The single parts which form the active sentence are reversed in the passive form: in particular, the object of the former sentence becomes the subject of the latter.

In Italian passive is obtained exactly as in English: the verb of the active sentence is turned into to be (with the same tense) + the verb's past participle: active sentence: il bambino lancia la palla = the child throws the ball passive sentence: la palla è lanciata dal bambino = the ball is thrown by the child The verb of the aforesaid active sentence is lancia (3rd singular person from the present tense of lanciare, to throw), so the passive form requires è (3rd singular person from the present tense of essere, to be), and lanciato (past participle of lanciare, i.e. thrown). This is a full sample table of passive tenses of the same verb. NOTE To reduce the bulk of the page's layout, the personal pronouns that in other tables have been shown in brackets, (io), (tu), (egli / ella), etc., have been omitted. INDICATIVE PRESENTE singular plural 1st person sono lanciato/a I am thrown siamo lanciati/e we are thrown 2nd person sei lanciato/a you are thrown (singular) siete lanciati/e you are thrown (plural) 3rd person è lanciato/a he/she is thrown sono lanciati/e they are thrown IMPERFETTO singular plural 1st person ero lanciato/a I was thrown eravamo lanciati/e we were thrown 2nd person eri lanciato/a you were thrown (s.) eravate lanciati/e you were thrown (p.) 3rd person era lanciato/a he/she was thrown erano lanciati/e they were thrown FUTURO singular plural 1st person sarò lanciato/a I shall be thrown saremo lanciati/e we shall be thrown 2nd person sarai lanciato/a you will be thrown (s.) sarete lanciati/e you will be thrown (p.) 3rd person sarà lanciato/a he/she/it will be thrown saranno lanciati/e they will be thrown PASSATO REMOTO singular plural 1st person fui lanciato/a I was thrown fummo lanciati/e we were thrown 2nd person fosti lanciato/a you were thrown (s.) foste lanciati/e you were thrown (p.) 3rd person fu lanciato/a he/she/it was thrown furono lanciati/e they were thrown PASSATO PROSSIMO singular plural 1st person sono stato/a lanciato/a I have been thrown siamo stati/e lanciati/e we have been thrown 2nd person sei stato/a lanciato/a you have been thrown (s.) siete stati/e lanciati/e you have been thrown (p.) 3rd person è stato/a lanciato/a he/she has been thrown sono stati/e lanciati/e they have been thrown

TRAPASSATO PROSSIMO singular plural 1st person ero stato/a lanciato/a I had been thrown eravamo stati/e lanciati/e we had been thrown 2nd person eri stato/a lanciato/a you had been thrown (s.) eravate stati/e lanciati/e you had been thrown (p.) 3rd person era stato/a lanciato/a he/she had been thrown erano stati/e lanciati/e they had been thrown

TRAPASSATO REMOTO 1st person

singular fui stato/a lanciato/a I had been thrown

plural fummo stati/e lanciati/e we had been thrown

2nd person fosti stato/a lanciato/a you had been thrown (s.) foste stati/e lanciati/e you had been thrown (p.) 3rd person fu stato/a lanciato/a he/she/it had been thrown furono stati/e lanciati/e they had been thrown

FUTURO ANTERIORE singular sarò stato/a 1st person lanciato/a 2nd sarai stato/a person lanciato/a sarà stato/a 3rd person lanciato/a

plural saremo stati/e lanciati/e

I'll have been thrown

we'll have been thrown

you'll have been thrown (s.)

sarete stati/e lanciati/e

you'll have been thrown (p.)

he/she/it will have been thrown

saranno stati/e lanciati/e

they'll have been thrown

SUBJUNCTIVE TENSES PRESENTE singular plural 1st person (che) io sia lanciato/a (that) I am thrown (che) siamo lanciati/e (that) we are thrown 2nd person (che) tu sia lanciato/a (that) you are thrown (s.) (che) siate lanciati/e (that) you are thrown (p.) 3rd person (che) egli/ella sia lanciato/a (that) he/she/it is thrown (che) siano lanciati/e (that) they are thrown

IMPERFETTO singular plural 1st person (che) io fossi lanciato/a (that) I was thrown (che) fossimo lanciati/e (that) we were thrown 2nd person (che) tu fossi lanciato/a (that) you were thrown (s.) (che) foste lanciati/e (that) you were thrown (p.) 3rd person (che) fosse lanciato/a (that) he/she/it was thrown (che) fossero lanciati/e (that) they were thrown

CONDITIONAL TENSES PRESENTE singular plural 1st person sarei lanciato/a I would be thrown saremmo lanciati/e we would be thrown 2nd person saresti lanciato/a you would be thrown (s.) sareste lanciati/e you would be thrown (p.) 3rd person sarebbe lanciato/a he/she would be thrown sarebbero lanciati/e they would be thrown PASSATO 1st person 2nd person 3rd person

singular sarei stato/a lanciato/a saresti stato/a lanciato/a sarebbe stato/a lanciato/a

I would have been thrown you would have been thrown (s.) he/she would have been thrown

plural saremmo stati/e lanciati/e sareste stati/e lanciati/e sarebbero stati/e lanciati/e

we would have been thrown you would have been thrown (p.) they would have been thrown

GERUND essendo lanciato/a/i/e being trown

PRESENTE (none)

PARTICIPLES PASSATO stato/a/i/e lanciato/a/i/e been trown

In forming passive, by adding the auxiliary verb essere (to be), the subject no longer carries out the action, but receives it. Who instead carries out the action, specified in English by preposition by, in Italian is introduced by preposition da, which according to the following noun has to be used either in its simple form or compound form (i.e. either alone, or bound to a definite article, see paragraph 5.2):

il ragazzo lava il cane = the boy washes the dog il cane è lavato dal ragazzo = the dog is washed by the boy essi leggono il libro = they read the book il libro è letto da loro = the book is read by them scriverò un articolo = I'll write an article l'articolo sarà scritto da me = the article will be written by me l'uomo raccolse il sasso = the man picked up the stone il sasso fu raccolto dall'uomo = the stone was picked up by the man Passive does not have specific inflections, because only the past participle of the main verb is used: to obtain the passive form of a verb all you need to do is to add its past participle to the several tenses of the auxiliary verb, essere. Therefore, it is very important to be confident with the latter (see paragraphs 4.3, 6.1, 9.3, 9.5 and 13.1). It has been previously said that Italian past participles are case- and gender-sensitive, which means that they behave exactly as adjectives, and have to be matched with the subject of the sentence. Focus the following examples: il ragazzo lava il cane = the boy washes the dog il cane è lavato dal ragazzo = the dog is washed by the boy la ragazza lava il cane = the girl washes the dog il cane è lavato dalla ragazza = the dog is washed by the girl il ragazzo lava i cani = the boy washes the dogs i cani sono lavati dal ragazzo = the dogs are washed by the boy la ragazza lava i cani = the girl washes the dogs i cani sono lavati dalla ragazza = the dogs are washed by the girl lo scrittore usa la penna = the writer uses the pen la penna è usata dallo scrittore = the pen is used the writer la scrittrice usa la penna = the (woman) writer uses the pen la penna è usata dalla scrittrice = the pen is used the (woman) writer lo scrittore usa le penne = the writer uses the pens le penne sono usate dallo scrittore = the pens are used by the writer la scrittrice usa le penne = the (woman) writer uses the pens le penne sono usate dalla scrittrice = the pens are used by the (woman) writer Note how only the subject affects the verb's inflection, while the object does not. Obviously, only transitive verbs may have a passive form. Intransitive ones, such as to sleep, to laugh, to die, to sit, to come, etc. never have a direct object, so the latter cannot become the subject of the passive sentence. Transitive verbs, instead, can always be turned into passive forms. Passive looks very similar to the same verb's active compound tenses, except that the auxiliary verb used is no longer avere (to have) but essere (to be). The following table is an example comparing the 1st singular person of the verb guardare (to watch) in different tenses, both active and passive; in particular, focus the central column: active - simple tenses guardo = I watch

active - compound tenses ho guardato = I have watched

guardavo = I watched avevo guardato = I had watched guardai = I watched

ebbi guardato = I had watched

guarderò = I'll watch avrò guardato = I'll have watched passive - simple tenses

passive - compound tenses

sono guardato = I am watched

sono stato guardato = I have been watched

ero guardato = I was watched

ero stato guardato = I had been watched

fui guardato = I was watched

fui stato guardato = I had been watched

sarò guardato = I'll be watched

sarò stato guardato = I'll have been watched

The compound tenses of an intransitive verb are even more similar to passive, because they both take essere. However, they can be told by the meaning of the verb. For instance, comparing the passive form of amare (to love, transitive) with andare (to go, intransitive), you will notice that the auxiliary verb is identical, although the meaning leaves little doubt whether the form is active or passive: transitive verb in passive form - simple tenses sono amato = I am loved ero amato = I was loved fui amato = I was loved sarò amato = I'll be loved intransitive verb - simple tenses sono andato = I went / I have gone ero andato = I had gone fui andato = I had gone sarò andato = I'll have gone As a general rule, when essere is followed by a past participle (guardato, andato, amato, etc.), only if the latter verb is transitive, thus it may have a direct object, it is a passive form (sono guardato, sono amato, etc.), otherwise it is an active form (sono andato). Further examples are: è venduto = it is sold is passive (vendere = to sell is a transitive verb) le piante erano morte = the plants had died is active (morire = to die is intransitive) fummo visti = we were seen is passive (vedere = to see is transitive) sono venuti = they have come is active (venire = to come is intransitive) sono riconosciuti = they are recognized is passive (riconoscere = to recognize is transitive) Remember though, that a few verbs are transitive in English and intensitive in Italian, and vice-versa, and this affects the aforesaid rule: sono pagati (they are payed for) is passive, because pagare (to pay for) is transitive eravamo entrati (we had entered) is active, because entrare (to enter) is intransitive

It should be noticed that both in English and in Italian some past participles used with the verb to be, i.e. essere, may act as adjectives. This occurs especially when the present and simple past tenses are used (i.e. with Italian presente and imperfetto tenses). For instance, this paper is crimpled, or the chicken was cooked, or that banknote is torn. Crimpled, cooked and torn might be either considered past participles or adjectives. In such cases, to stress the fact that the sentence describes an action, and not a condition, (i.e. that the paper is being crimpled by somebody, and is not crimpled as a condition, or that the chicken was actually being cooked, etc.), Italian may choose a different auxiliary verb to form passive: venire (see the previous paragraph 18.4), whose actual meaning is to come, in place of auxiliary essere: la luce è spenta = the light is off, or the light is turned off (either as a condition or as an action) la luce viene spenta = the light is (being) turned off (i.e. by somebody, more specifically) la parete era dipinta = the wall was painted (either as a condition or as an action)

la parete veniva dipinta = the wall was (being) painted (only as an action) il libro è pubblicato = the book is published (either as a condition or as an action) il libro viene pubblicato = the book is (being) published (only as an action) il pallone era riempito col gas = the balloon was filled with gas (either a condition or an action) il pallone veniva riempito col gas = the balloon was (being) filled with gas Venire somewhat emphasizes that the subject of the sentence receives or has received the action expressed by the verb. Instead essere is less emphatic, and what follows may be translated either as a past participle (i.e. a passive form), or as an adjective. However, in most cases venire may be chosen also when the use of essere would never cause any doubt: il biologo fu premiato per la sua scoperta = the biologist was awarded for his discovery il biologo venne premiato per la sua scoperta (same as above) l'erba sarà tagliata domani = the grass will be cut tomorrow l'erba verrà tagliata domani (same as above) eravamo aiutati dagli amici = we were helped by friends venivamo aiutati dagli amici (same as above) The use of venire as an auxiliary verb for passive, though, is limited to simple tenses, while compound tenses always require essere: la casa fu costruita nel 1931 = the house was built in 1931 la casa venne costruita nel 1931 (same as above) ...BUT la casa è stata costruita lo scorso mese (only possible form) = the house was built last month il biglietto sarà timbrato alla stazione = the ticket will be stamped at the station il biglietto verrà timbrato alla stazione (same as above) ...BUT il biglietto sarà stato timbrato alla stazione (only possible form) = the ticket might have been stamped at the station egli era curato nel vicino ospedale = he was cured in the nearby hospital egli veniva curato nel vicino ospedale (same as above) ...BUT egli era stato curato nel vicino ospedale (only possible form) = he had been cured in the nearby hospital

19.2 TO BE HUNGRY, THIRSTY, HOT, COLD, SLEEPY These expressions, which describe a condition based on physical sensations, in English require the verb to be followed by the relevant adjective (i.e. I am hungry, you were thirsty, etc.).

Instead, in Italian they require the verb to have (avere), followed by the relevant noun that describes the sensation: i.e. to be hungry turns into to have hunger; to be thirsty into to have thirst, and so on: avere fame = to be hungry (literally: to have hunger) avere sete = to be thirsty (literally: to have thirst) avere caldo = to be hot (literally: to have heat) avere freddo = to be cold (literally: to have cold) avere sonno = to be sleepy (literally: to have sleep) In a similar way, avere ragione = to be right (literally: to have right) avere torto = to be wrong (literally: to have wrong) Any tense of the verb avere can be used with these expressions, therefore: egli avrà fame = he will be hungry (he will have hunger) io ho avuto sonno = I felt sleepy (I have had sleep) noi avemmo sete = we felt thirsty (we had thirst) voi avevate ragione = you were right (you had right) and so on. While to be right and to be wrong are always translated with the verb avere, to be hot and to be cold may also take the verb to feel (i.e. I feel hot, you felt cold, etc.). In Italian this is obtained by using the verb sentire (to feel), followed by the noun: avere caldo, sentire caldo = to be hot, to feel hot (literally: to feel heat) avere freddo, sentire freddo = to be cold, to feel cold (literally: to feel cold) The verb sentire is never used with hungry, thirsty or sleepy. The Italian adjectives affamato (hungry), assetato (thirsty), accaldato (hot), raffreddato or infreddolito (cold), and assonnato (sleepy) may also be used, though more sparingly than in English. In Italian they almost describe a condition, more than a personal feeling. Compare the following examples: essi mangiano un panino perché hanno fame = they eat a sandwich because they are hungry affamati dopo il lungo viaggio, essi si fermarono per un pasto = hungry after the long journey, they stopped for a meal io avevo sonno e andai a letto presto = I was sleepy and I went to bed early egli sembrava assonnato perché non aveva dormito = he seemed sleepy because he had not slept io avevo caldo (or sentivo caldo ) con la giacca, così l'ho tolta = I was hot / felt hot with the jacket, so I took it off io sono accaldato, e sto sudando = I am (feeling) hot, and I'm sweating In most cases both forms would be correct: essi mangiano perché hanno fame = they eat a sandwich because they are hungry essi mangiano perché sono affamati = (same as above) essi dormono perché hanno sonno = they are sleeping because because they are sleepy essi dormono perché sono assonnati = (same as above) However, especially in common speech, the first of the two forms is the one used more often. There is also a difference in meaning when using raffreddato or infreddolito: raffreddato = cooled, cooled up questo è un motore raffreddato ad acqua = this is a water-cooled engine raffreddato = running a cold noi eravamo raffreddati e starnutivamo = we were running a cold and we sneezed infreddolito = feeling cold ella era infreddolita, e indossò un cappotto = she was feeling cold, and she put on a coat Although in the previous examples raffreddato has been used as an adjective, it is the past participle of the verb raffreddare, to cool, cool up. Its reflexive form raffreddarsi, when referred to living creatures has a common meaning of to catch a cold (although the proper way of saying this is prendere un raffreddore). Since they are very common verbs, it is useful to focus well their different use (and meaning):

io raffreddo quest'aqua per ottenere ghiaccio = I cool this water to obtain ice aprendo la finestra l'aria si raffredda = by opening the window the air cools up vieni dentro, o ti raffredderai (colloquial) = come inside, or you will catch a cold (= you will turn cold) vieni dentro, o prenderai un raffreddore (proper form) = (same as above) There is also a similar verb, freddarsi, whose official meaning is to become (too) cold, sometime used in common speech to replace the aforesaid raffreddarsi. Its positive (non-reflexive) form too exists, freddare, always referred to living creatures, with an idiomatic meaning of to shoot someone dead (a rather modern use of this verb): il caffè si è freddato, non berlo = the coffee has turned cold, don't drink it quando ho fatto la doccia l'acqua si era freddata = when I took a shower the water had become cold vieni a mangiare o la minestra si fredderà = come to eat, or the soup will grow cold egli / ella mirò bene, e freddò il nemico al primo colpo = he/she aimed well, and killed the enemy with the first shot As a general rule, freddarsi is preferred to raffreddarsi when a somewhat negative shade of meaning is required, e.g. to become excessively cold, or to become cold (while it shouldn't have), such as speaking of food, hot drinks, water for a shower or a bath, the air in a heated room, etc.

19.3 THE POSTPONED SUBJECT As far as now, in all the sample sentences shown, the subject stood before the verb, and the object followed it (as it always happens in English, as well). il ragazzo apre la porta (transitive verb) subject verb object the boy opens the door l'ospite era partito (intransitive verb) subject verb the guest had left The early stages of this course, for instance paragraph 2.5 about the position of adjectives, mentioned how in Italian the last part of the sentence often carries the emphasis of the concept expressed: abitavano in una grande casa = they lived in a large house (this tells us where they lived) abitavano in una casa grande = they lived in a large house (this tells us how was the house they lived in) When a sentence has no object (a situation that typically occurs with intransitive verbs, but sometimes with transitive ones too), in Italian it is common to shift the subject at the bottom, i.e. after the verb. A few examples: oggi il tuo amico verrà e pranzerà qui = today your friend will come and will have lunch here could be turned into oggi verrà il tuo amico e pranzerà qui = (same as above) fai presto, il treno è arrivato! = be quick, the train has arrived! could be turned into fai presto, è arrivato il treno! = (same as above)

una persona era uscita = one person had come out could be turned into era uscita una persona = (same as above) There is no special reason for postponing a subject, except to place a little more emphasis on the last word. For instance, in the first sentence the usual form puts the emphasis on the fact that your friend will come, while with a postponed subject it means your friend will come. It is not a strong emphasis, i.e. the second form would not mean your friend is coming, not mine, but we are having for lunch your friend, as if the subject (your friend) had not yet been introduced in the conversation. The usual form, instead, would sound like today your friend (who has likely been mentioned already) will come, and have lunch here. In the same way, the second example puts a little stress on the train, rather than on the fact that it has arrived, while the third example tells us that a person (not two or more, not a dog, but a single individual) had come out, while the usual form would slightly emphasize the coming out of the person, i.e. his action. Focusing the inflections of the verbs, in the aforesaid samples we see that: verrà matches il tuo amico; è arrivato matches il treno; era uscita matches una persona. Therefore, the postponed subject could rarely be mistaken with an object, because the inflection of the verb always matches the subject, not the object. This is also clear enough from the meaning of the verb and from the general context of the speech: adesso salirà Paolo = now Paul will go up / climb (i.e. it is Paul's turn to go up) adesso salirà le scale = now he / she will climb the steps In the first example, the action of climbing is quite evidently carried out by Paul, because Paul cannot "be climbed": despite the noun follows the verb, the person is clearly the subject of the sentence. In the second example, instead, the stairs are climbed (i.e. they do not climb themselves), so they are the object. Furthermore, salirà, inflection of the 3rd singular person, does not match scale, a plural noun, but either Paul (in the first sentence) or somebody else not mentioned (in the second). But even if the match had been possible, the meaning of the verb would have been enough to tell the subject from the object. in questo ristorante mangia spesso il mio collega = my colleague often eats in this restaurant in questo ristorante mangia spesso il pesce = in this restaurant he / she often eats fish In this case mangia could match both collega and pesce, but it is obvious that the colleague does the action of eating, i.e. he or she is the subject, while the fish is eaten, thus acts as an object. However, there are a few cases in which the meaning might be doubted. Compare these two sentences: Franco aveva chiamato = Frank had called aveva chiamato Franco = Frank had called, but also he / she had called Frank In the secon example both meanings are possible. In these cases the context or the rest of the sentence will provide more clues; for instance: aveva chiamato Franco, ma tu non eri in casa = Frank had called, but you were not at home aveva chiamato Franco prima di chiamare Elena = he / she had called Frank before calling Helen

The main condition for postponing a subject is that the sentence must NOT have an object. In fact, this form is used more often with intransitive verbs (which never have a direct object), and less often with transitive ones, as well, if the direct object is missing: lo straniero era arrivato = the stranger had arrived, almost meaning he had finally made it there era arrivato lo straniero = (same as above), almost answering the question: who had arrived? l'albero è caduto = the tree fell down, almost meaning it did not stand the wind è caduto l'albero = (same as above), almost answering the question: what happened? presto l'inverno finirà = winter will soon be over, almost meaning it will not last long presto finirà l'inverno = (same as above), almost meaning ...and spring will begin presto lo studente finirà i suoi compiti = the student will soon finish his homework (only possible form, due to the object)

il campione ha vinto = the champion won, almost meaning he did not lose ha vinto il campione = (same as above), almost answering the question: who won the match? il campione ha vinto la sfida = the champion won the challenge (only possible form, due to the object) When the verb used in the sentence is essere (to be), there is no real object, because the verb describes a condition, not an action, therefore the subject may be freely postponed. This occurs very frequently in questions. questa bicicletta è bella = this bycicle is nice è bella questa bicicletta = (same as above) il cappotto era vecchio? = was the coat old? era vecchio il cappotto? = was the coat old? il tempo è buono? = is the weather fine? è buono il tempo? = is the weather fine? non è tutto oro ciò che riluce (proverb) = not all things that shine are gold (the other way is possible, but being a proverb it is only used in this form) When a subject is postponed, the sentence must end there, i.e. either a full stop must close the period, or a further sentence should be introduced by means of a comma and/or a conjunction (e.g. and, or, so, thus, etc.). In the following examples the spot where the sentence breaks is shown in yellow, and what breaks it is shown in red. presto finirà l'inverno || e il tempo migliorerà = winter will soon be over and the weather will improve ha vinto il campione , || quindi la folla ora esulta = the champion won, therefore the crowd now rejoyces è caduto l'albero || perché il vento era forte = the tree fell because the wind was strong è arrivato il treno ; || prendi i bagagli = the train has arrived; take the luggage In order to postpone the subject, other parts of the same sentence may sometimes be moved from their original position; compare the following examples: un cane entrò nella stanza = a dog came into the room (the action is slightly emphasized) È nella stanza entrò un cane = (same as above, though now the dog is more emphasized) entrò nella stanza un cane = (same, but less common than the previous one) l'insegnante tornò a scuola = the teacher returned to school (slight emphasis on the action) È a scuola tornò l'insegnante = (same as above, though now the teacher is more emphasized) tornò a scuola l'insegnante = (same, but less common than the previous one) uno specialista verrà dall'estero = a specialist will come from abroad (emphasis on from abroad) È verrà uno specialista dall'estero = (same; both the specialist and from abroad are emphasized) dall'estero verrà uno specialista = (same; now the specialist is more emphasized) Since this particular form does not follow a standard rule, and not all parts of the sentence may be shifted in a similar way, there is no need for the student to memorize every possible disposition, and leave it with its "classic" arrangement (subject + verb + etc. etc.). In particular, the adverbs are usually left in their original position, i.e. next to the verb, because when an adverb is used it often carries the emphasis: il campione ha vinto = the champion won ha vinto il campione = the champion won il campione ha vinto facilmente = the champion won easily l'albero era caduto = the tree had fallen down era caduto l'albero = the tree had fallen down l'albero era caduto spesso = the tree had often fallen down lo straniero arrivò = the stranger arrived

era arrivato lo straniero = the stranger arrived lo straniero arrivò tardi = the stranger arrived late However, also when an adverb is present, the Italian language allows forms similar to the ones discussed so far: ha vinto facilmente il campione... = the champion won easily... era caduto spesso l'albero... = the tree had often fallen... arrivò tardi lo straniero... = the stranger arrived late... This special form helps to keep the emphasis strong enough on both parts of the sentence, i.e. the adverb and the subject. It is used when another sentence follows in the same period, to obtain a particular lingering effect: ha vinto facilmente il campione, e la folla lo esalta = the champion won easily era caduto spesso l'albero, ed era diventato storto = the tree had often fallen down, and it had become crooked arrivò tardi lo straniero, e trovò la porta chiusa = the stranger arrived late, and found the door closed The subject is also postponed so that, after having read the sentence, the reader's attention will somewhat linger on the champion, the tree or the stranger, because the following sentence may likely continue to concern or to describe the same subject. Instead the standard arrangement (subject + verb) does not give the sentence any particular shade nor emphasis, i.e. it simply describes what happens to the subject.

19.4 DOUBLE NEGATIVE In English there are expressions which have a double form according to whether they are used alone or with a negative conjunction. For instance, the two sentences there was nothing and there wasn't anything have the same meaning, although two different adverbs, nothing and anything, have to be used. The same pattern occurs for nobody ~ anybody, never ~ ever, nowhere ~ anywhere and so on. Instead in Italian the equivalent adverbs have only one form, which is the negative one (i.e. they match nothing, nobody, nowhere, etc.). There is only one exception; for the sake of an easier comprehension, this topic will be discussed in the following paragraph 19.5. Provided that in Italian negative sentences always contain the conjunction non (not), the use of the aforesaid pronouns or adverbs turns the sentence two times negative, almost as "I can't see nothing"; "she won't never come"; "we didn't do this neither"; and so on. In Italian this is the only possible (and correct) way of using negative pronouns and adverbs. nessuno (indefinite pronoun) = nobody, no one, none niente (indefinite pronoun) = nothing nulla (indefinite pronoun) = nothing mai (adverb) = never nemmeno (adverb) = not even, neither neanche (adverb) = not even, neither neppure (adverb) = not even, neither Note how the aforesaid words are compounds (except mai and nulla), and begin with the prefix ne- (from the Latin ne = not), although the final word contains some further alteration: ne + uno (one) >> nessuno (nobody, no one, none) ne + ente (archaic for entity, thing) >> niente (nothing) ne + meno (less) >> nemmeno (not even, neither) ne + anche (also, even) >> neanche (not even, neither) ne + pure (also, even) >> neppure (not even, neither)

Instead nowhere has no Italian equivalent, so the expression da nessuna parte (literally: in no place) is used. In fact, nessuno and its feminine nessuna may be also used with any noun, as an adjective, with the meaning of no....

Note that since nessuno is a compound of uno, before masculine nouns it drops its final o, except when the following noun begins with z or with s + consonant (e.g. sc..., sp..., st..., etc.). For this phonetic rule refer to the indefinite article uno, paragraph 2.4). nessun amico = no friend nessun timore = no fear nessun rimorso = no regret ...BUT nessuno scambio = no exchange nessuno strumento = no instrument nessuno zio = no uncle Instead nessuna may undergo an elision and take an apostrophe (nessun') when the following noun begins with the vowel "a". This change is not compulsory, and with other vowels it is usually avoided: nessuna casa = no house nessuna idea = no idea nessuna emergenza = no emergency ...BUT nessun'arma or nessuna arma = no weapon nessun'assenza or nessuna assenza = no absence nessun'attrice or nessuna attrice = no actress The use of nessun and nessuna will be discussed again, further on, in this same paragraph. Meanwhile, these are some examples of double negative sentences: in quel cassetto (egli / ella) non trovò niente = in that drawer he / she didn't find anything da lontano (essi) non vedranno nulla = from afar they won't see anything (essi) non hanno letto nessun libro = they haven't read any book quella persona non conosce nessuno = that person doesn't know anybody il lunedì (io) non mangio mai a casa = on Mondays I never eat at home (io) non lo guarderò nemmeno = I won't even look at him / it perché (tu) non vedrai neppure questo film? = why won't you watch this movie either? (egli / ella) non conosceva neppure l'indirizzo = he / she didn't even know the address (noi) non vogliamo nemmeno quello = we don't want that (one) either Examining these sentences, a first consideration is that the basic structure of double negative expressions is: (subject) + non + (verb) + negative pronoun or negative adverb. e.g. quella persona (subject) + non + conosce (verb) nessuno (negative pronoun). Notice how the negative pronouns and adverbs are simply added after the verb; in fact, by dropping them or by replacing them with a definite noun (shown in green in the following samples), the aforesaid sentences turn out "ordinary" negatives: in quel cassetto (egli / ella) non trovò la penna = in that drawer he / she didn't find the pen da lontano (essi) non vedranno i dettagli = from afar they won't see the details (essi) non hanno letto questo libro = they did not read this book quella persona non conosce tuo fratello = that person does not know your brother When the verb uses a compound tense (passato prossimo, trapassato prossimo, futuro anteriore, etc.), the negative pronouns nessuno, niente and nulla follow the standard pattern shown above: (subject) + non + (verb) + negative adverb or negative pronoun e.g. essi non hanno letto nessun libro. Instead the negative adverbs mai, nemmeno, neanche and neppure may either follow the standard sequence, as above, or they may be inserted between the two parts of the compound tense, i.e. the auxiliary verb and the primary verb: (subject) + non + (auxiliary verb) + negative adverb + (past participle of the primary verb) e.g. essi non hanno letto mai questo libro; alternatively: essi non hanno mai letto questo libro. A few more examples should make this concept clear enough:

il libro non era appartenuto a nessuno (only possible form) = the book had not belonged to anybody in quel cassetto non ha trovato niente (only possible form) = in that drawer he / she didn't find anything da lontano non avranno visto niente (only possible form) = from afar they won't have seen anything non ho mangiato mai a casa = I never ate at home non ho mai mangiato a casa = (same as above) non avevo guardato nemmeno la TV = I hadn't even watched the TV, but also I hadn't watched the TV either non avevo nemmeno guardato la TV = (same as above) non aveva visto nemmeno un film = he / she hadn't even seen a movie, but also he / she hadn't seen a movie either non aveva nemmeno visto un film = (same as above) non avrà letto neppure l'indirizzo = he / she might have not even read the address, but also he / she might have not read the address either non avrà neppure letto neppure l'indirizzo = (same as above) non abbiamo voluto neppure quello = we didn't even want that (one), but also we didn't want that (one) either non abbiamo neppure voluto quello = (same as above) When the alternative form is possible, in most cases to use one or the other is a free choice, although the first of the two would give the negative adverb a slightly more emphatic meaning, especially in spoken language (i.e. the voice pitch would slightly raise in pronouncing the adverb), while the second form is less strong, somewhat more stylish, and would be preferred in writing.

A second consideration about the previous examples is that nemmeno, neanche and neppure have the same meaning. It would sometimes be more stylish to choose a specific one according to the sentence, but in common speech, or for a student's purpose, any of the three may be freely used. non conosceva neppure l'indirizzo = he / she didn't even know the address non conosceva neanche l'indirizzo = (same as above) non conosceva nemmeno l'indirizzo = (same as above) But these adverbs do translate two different English expressions: not even and neither. non conosceva neppure l'indirizzo = he / she didn't even know the address non conosceva neppure l'indirizzo = he / she didn't know the address either In most cases, which of the two is the actual meaning is made clear by the context of the sentence, since neither can only be possible if a first object has already been mentioned (i.e. he didn't know my house - he didn't know my address either). The form we discussed so far may have both meanings (see once again the previous examples), and is stylistically correct. However, in Italian it is still possible to distinguish more clearly the two meanings by using different arrangements of the words. In spoken language, especially in central and southern Italy, to strengthen the meaning of not even it is a common custom to drop the negative conjunction non by replacing it with the negative adverb or pronoun, moved to the front, and to leave the verb at the bottom of the sentence: non conosceva neppure l'indirizzo = he / she didn't even know the address but this may also be translated as: she didn't know the address either neppure l'indirizzo conosceva (very colloquial) = he / she didn't even know the address il treno non ferma neanche a Firenze = the train doesn't even stop in Florence but this may also be translated as: the train doesn't stop in Florence either il treno neanche a Firenze ferma (very colloquial) = the train doesn't even stop in Florence quella scuola non chiude nemmeno d'estate = that school doesn't even close in summer but this may also be translated as: that school doesn't close in summer either quella scuola nemmeno d'estate chiude (very colloquial) = that school doesn't even close in summer

This colloquial form is no longer a double negative, having lost non. But remember: although it is commonly heard, according to the official Italian grammar this form is not correct.

When the object of the sentence is a personal pronoun, the two different meanings not even and neither are more clearly understood. At first, let's see a couple of typical sentences that contain a pronoun as a direct object: non li incontrerò (standard form) = I won't meet them non incontrerò loro (emphatic form) = I won't meet them (i.e. I will meet somebody else) il giudice non lo ha condannato (standard form) = the judge did not sentence him il giudice non ha condannato lui (emphatic form) = the judge did not sentence him (i.e. the judge sentenced somebody else) As explained in paragraph 8.1, forcing the pronoun at the bottom of the sentence gives the latter a stronger emphasis (in the aforesaid example, the pronouns them and him are emphasized). The same form used with neanche, nemmeno or neppure gives them a clear meaning of neither. Instead, the standard form used so far (i.e. non + pronoun + verb + negative adverb) would only have the meaning of not even. Furthermore, in the case of a pronoun used as direct object, the colloquial form explained above is considered correct (i.e. with the adverb moved in front, to replace non), and may be used as an alternative and somewhat stronger expression: non ti guarderò neppure = I will not even look at you neppure ti guarderò = (same as above, but stronger) non guarderò neppure te (emphasized form) = I will not look at you either purtroppo non lo vidi nemmeno = unfortunately I didn't even see him purtroppo nemmeno lo vidi = (same as above, but stronger) purtroppo non vidi nemmeno lui = unfortunately I didn't see him either l'anno scorso non le abbiamo neanche invitate = last year we haven't even invited them l'anno scorso neanche le abbiamo invitate = (same as above, but stronger) l'anno scorso non abbiamo invitato neanche loro = last year we haven't invited them either

Among the the indefinite pronouns discussed so far, niente, nulla and nessuno somewhat differ from ordinary ones, such as personal pronouns, relative pronouns, etc. First of all, they do not have a plural form, due to their respective meaning; this also happens in English. Niente and nulla are both dealt with as masculine singular words. Also nessuno is a masculine singular pronoun; however, as already mentioned at the beginning of this paragraph, when it is followed by a noun it turns into an adjective, whose English equivalent would be no...(noun): (as a pronoun) nessuno ha detto questo = nobody said this (as an adjective) nessun uomo pesa oltre 300 chili = no man weighs over 300 kilograms (as an adjective) nessuna persona comprerebbe questo libro = no person would buy this book Used as a pronoun, nessuno does not change; it is considered a masculine word, also when it evidently refers to feminine individuals. Therefore, if a compound verb's past participle is gender- and numbersensitive (see paragraph 6.4), the pronoun nessuno always requires a masculine inflection. nessuno (pronoun) è entrato nel reparto femminile = nobody entered the women's ward nessuna paziente (adjective) è entrata nel reparto femminile = no (female) patient entered the women's ward Used as an adjective, instead, nessun and nessuna match the gender of the noun they refer to, as any other ordinary adjective. While nessun (+ masculine noun) turns again into nessuno when the following noun begins with z or with s + consonant (see previous examples), nessuna (+ feminine noun) may undergo an elision, i.e. the last a dropped and replaced by an apostrophe, when the following noun begins with the vowel a. This change, though, is facultative, and it rarely occurs when the noun begins with e, i, o, u. nessun vincitore = no winner nessun uomo = no man

nessuno sconto = no discount nessuna domanda = no question nessun'amica or nessuna amica = no (female) friend nessuna imposta (seldom nessun'imposta) = no tax nessun impiegato entrò nell'ufficio = no clerk entered the office nessuno straniero venne in città = no stranger came into town nessun'altra ragazza = no other girl Beware of nouns whose inflection is similar to a typical feminine one, such as atleta (athlete), poeta (poet), artista (artist), omicida (murderer), sosia (lookalike), etc., see paragraph 2.3 Many of them are both masculine and feminine, although a few of them have specific feminine forms (for instance poeta = poet, poetessa = female poet), or are only masculine (for instance programma = program). nessun atleta = no (male) athlete nessun'atleta = no (female) athlete nessun sosia = no (male) lookalike nessuna sosia = no (female) lookalike nessun artista = no (male) artist nessun'artista = no (female) artist nessun poeta = no (male) poet nessuna poetessa = no (female) poet nessun programma = no program nessuno schema = no scheme

19.5 THE USE OF ALCUNO The introduction of the previous paragraph mentioned an exception to the use of non + negative adverbs or adjectives. In fact, the adjective forms nessun and its feminine nessuna are the only expressions among the ones discussed in paragraph 19.4 that have a positive (non-negative) form, which matches the English any. This form is alcuno, more often alcun for phonetic reasons (same as nessun - nessuno), and its feminine alcuna (the latter seldom undergoes an elision, thus turning into alcun' ). The phonetic rules by which the aforesaid changes occur are the same ones concerning nessuno and nessuna (see again the previous paragraph 19.4) The use of alcun and alcuna after non avoids a double negative sentence: (io) non ho alcun compito = I do not have any duty (egli / ella) non possiede alcuna casa = he / she does not own any house il soldato non usò alcun'arma = the soldier did not use any weapon quel negozio non vi farà alcuno sconto = that shop will not give you any discount (voi) non avevate commesso alcun reato = you had not committed any offence questa scuola non insegna alcuna lingua straniera = this school does not teach any foreign language The use of nessun or nessuna after non is still possible, yet rather colloquial. When alcun / alcuna can be used, it is preferrable to avoid a double negative sentence. (io) non ho alcun (colloquially nessun) compito (egli / ella) non possiede alcuna (colloquially nessuna) casa il soldato non usò alcun'arma (nessun'arma) quel negozio non vi farà alcuno (nessuno) sconto (voi) non avevate commesso alcun (nessun) reato questa scuola non insegna alcuna (nessuna) lingua straniera

Instead, when it is used as a pronoun (i.e. not followed by a noun), alcuno does not replace nessuno, therefore the sentence remains twice negative. (essi) non vedono alcuna persona = they don't see any person (essi) non vedono nessuna persona (colloquial) = (same, literally: "they don't see no person") (essi) non vedono nessuno = they don't see anybody (egli / ella) non conta su alcun amico = he / she does not rely on any friend (egli / ella) non conta su nessun amico (colloquial) = (same as above) (egli / ella) non conta su nessuno = he / she does not rely on anybody questa penna non appartiene ad alcuno studente = this pen does not belong to any student questa penna non appartiene a nessuno studente (colloquial) = (same as above) questa penna non appartiene a nessuno = this pen does not belong to anybody The form non vedono alcuno, non conta su alcuno, etc. did actually exist in the past, but now it may be found only in old texts, dating back to the 19th century (or older), therefore it can be considered obsolete. Unlike nessuno, which has a feminine (nessuna) but no plural form, alcuno has the full set of regular inflections for feminine and plural: alcuna, alcuni, alcune. They may be used either with positive or with negative sentences. The plural forms (alcuni, alcune), though, no longer mean any but some. Compare the following examples: (tu) non venderai alcun libro = you will not sell any book (tu) non venderai nessun libro (colloquial) = (same as above) (tu) venderai alcuni libri = you will sell some books (tu) non venderai alcuni libri = you will not sell some books il poliziotto non sparò alcun colpo = the policeman did not fire any shot il poliziotto non sparò nessun colpo (colloquial) = (same as above) il poliziotto sparò alcuni colpi = the policeman fired some shots il poliziotto non sparò alcuni colpi = the policeman did not fire some shots (io) non ho visto alcun gatto in giardino = I did not see any cat in the garden (io) non ho visto nessun gatto in giardino (colloquial) = (same as above) (io) ho visto alcuni gatti in giardino = I saw some cats in the garden (io) non ho visto alcuni gatti in giardino = I did not see some cats in the garden The use of alcuni / alcune also introduces the topic of the following paragraph 19.6.

20.1 PARTITIVE Partitive is the form used for referring to indefinite quantities (of physical objects, time periods, animals, people, etc.) In English, the only two adjectives/pronouns used for partitive are some and any:

USED AS ADJECTIVES

USED AS PRONOUNS

let's have some coffee do you have any ice-cream?

I already had some no, I haven't any

Generally speaking, we may say that some is positive, while any conveys a negative meaning, as it is used after not (although any itself is not really negative). Despite in English their use as adjectives (i.e. followed by a noun) and their use as pronouns (i.e. used alone) are rather similar, the two will be discussed separately. PARTITIVE ADJECTIVES In Italian, partitive works almost as in English, with only a few differences. Instead of an adjective, the preposition di in its compound forms (del, dello, della, dei, degli, delle) translates the English some. ho mangiato del riso e della pasta = I ate some rice and some pasta quella squadra ha degli ottimi giocatori = that team has some excellent players al museo ho visto dei capolavori = at the museum I saw some masterworks raccoglieranno dei fiori e delle foglie = they will gather some flowers and some leaves c'era del fango sul pavimento = there was some mud on the floor Always remember that compound prepositions make a phonetic match with the next following word, which may not be the noun they are referred to. For instance: ho mangiato del riso = I ate some rice ho mangiato dell'ottimo riso = I ate some excellent rice quella squadra ha degli ottimi giocatori = that team has some excellent players quella squadra ha dei giocatori ottimi = (same as above) If you are not confident with all the compound prepositions of di, it would be better to check them again in paragraph 5.2 before going any further. Another difference is that while in English either some or any may be used for questions (e.g. have you some sugar? or have you any sugar?), in Italian the only form is the positive one, which uses del, della, etc., even when the question is turned into negative: vorresti del cioccolato? = would you like some chocolate? non vorresti del cioccolato? = wouldn't you like some chocolate? c'è dell'acqua? = is there some (any) water? non c'è dell'acqua? = isn't there some (any) water? hai degli amici? = do you have some friends? non hai degli amici? = haven't you any friends? In a more colloquial form, the partitive adjectives del, dello, della, etc. are replaced by un po' di... (short for un poco di..., a little, a little bit of..., a speck of..., some, a few), or qualche (a few, some): vorresti del cioccolato? = vorresti un po' di cioccolato? non vorresti del cioccolato? = non vorresti un po' di cioccolato? c'è dell'acqua? = c'è un po' d'acqua? non c'è dell'acqua? = non c'è un po' d'acqua? hai degli amici? = hai qualche amico? non hai degli amici? = non hai qualche amico? Remember that un po' di... is usually followed by a plural, unless the noun it refers to does not have a plural, e.g. air, water, intelligence, history, etc.), while qualche is always followed by a singular noun. However, since the meaning of qualche is plural, as well, it may not be used with nouns that have only a singular form. The following examples should make this concept clear enough: un po' di giornali = qualche giornale = a few newspapers un po' di monete = qualche moneta = a few coins un po' di fiammiferi = qualche fiammifero = a few matches un po' di vestiti = qualche vestito = a few clothes un po' di mele = qualche mela = a few apples un po' di problemi = qualche problema = a few problems

...BUT un po' d'aria (qualche not allowed) = some air un po' di riposo (qualche not allowed) = some rest un po' di coraggio (qualche not allowed) = some courage un po' di pioggia (qualche not allowed) = some rain un po' di sabbia (qualche not allowed) = some sand un po' di luce (qualche not allowed, see note [*]) = some light [*] - Actually, also un po' di luci and qualche luce exist, but they can only be used referring to lights as physical objects, i.e. street-lights, car-lights, lanterns, etc., not to light itself.

Instead, in negative sentences the adjective alcun (see the previous paragraph 19.5) or the more colloquial nessun may be used with a meaning of "nobody, "none" (i.e. a quantity equals to zero). non è uscita alcuna persona = no person came out non è uscita nessuna persona = (same, but more colloquial, forming a double negative sentence) qui non vediamo alcun (nessun) negozio = we don't see any shop here non c'era alcuna (nessuna) via d'uscita = there was no way out non ha firmato alcun (nessun) documento = he/she did not sign any document In a similar way, questions whose reply is likely to be "no", "nobody", "none", etc. may be turned into this same form. non hai alcun parente? = don't you have any relative? (the reply is likely "no") non hai nessun parente? = (same, but more colloquial, double negative) non ha trovato alcuna (nessuna) soluzione? = hasn't he/she found any solution? non mangiamo alcun (nessun) dolce? = are we not eating any dessert? alla festa non è venuto alcun (nessun) ospite? = didn't any guest come to the party? Note that with alcun or nessun, the object's quantity "zero" or "none" is always treated as a singular noun (either masculine or feminine, according to the object's gender). A different way of turning this kind of sentence is to drop alcun (or nessun), and to use the noun in its plural form. In a few cases this kind of sentence may be literally translated into English, but more often it would sound strange. qui non vedo alcun negozio = I don't (can't) see any shop here qui non vedo negozi = (same, literally: I don't see shops here) non c'era alcuna via d'uscita = there was no way out non c'erano vie d'uscita = (same, literally: there were no ways out) non hai alcun parente? = don't you have any relative? non hai parenti? = don't you have relatives? non ha trovato alcuna soluzione? = hasn't he/she found any solution? non ha trovato soluzioni? = (same, literally: hasn't he/she found solutions?) alla festa non venne alcun ospite? = didn't any guest come to the party? alla festa non vennero ospiti? = (same, literally: didn't guests come to the party?)

When asking a question (i.e. in interrogative sentences), a good Italian speaker would use del, dello, della, etc. when expecting a positive reply. The partitive adjectives may be simply dropped without causing a substantial change of meaning, although in this case the expected reply would probably be negative. non ha trovato delle soluzioni? = hasn't he/she found some solutions? (expectedly, yes) non ha trovato soluzioni? = hasn't he/she found any solution? (expectedly, no) alla festa non vennero degli ospiti? = didn't some guests come to the party? (expectedly, yes) alla festa non vennero ospiti? = didn't any guest come to the party? (expectedly, no) non hai della birra in casa? = don't you have some beer at home? (expectedly, yes) non hai birra in casa? = don't you have any beer at home? (expectedly, no)

non hai dei vestiti? = don't you have some clothes? (expectedly, yes) non hai vestiti? = don't you have any clothes? (expectedly, no)

THE PRONOUN NE When either some or any act as pronouns, i.e. they refer to a noun which is not mentioned in the sentence (such as I would like some) the latter is replaced by the pronoun particle ne (of this, of that, of what has been mentioned). This particle works exactly as other similar short pronouns, i.e. mi, me, ti, te, lo, glie, la, le, si, etc.: it can be used either as a direct object, or in dative case, or in reflexive forms (see again the three paragraphs of chapter 8). Briefly summarizing again the use of such particles, they bind to the verb as suffixes in three tenses: infinitive, imperative and gerund; in any other tense they come before the verb, as an individual word. For instance, adding ne to the verb mangiare, to eat, we obtain the following inflections (the red colour shows the use of ne as a suffix): (infinitive) mangiarne (present indicative) ne mangio, ne mangi, ne mangia, etc. (imperfect indicative) ne mangiavo, ne mangiavi, ne mangiava, etc. (simple past) ne mangiai, ne mangiasti, ne mangiò, etc. (future indicative) ne mangerò, ne mangerai, ne mangerà, etc. (present perfect) ne ho mangiato, ne hai mangiato, ne ha mangiato, etc. (past perfect) ne avevo mangiato, ne avevi mangiato, ne aveva mangiato, etc. (remote pluperfect) ne ebbi mangiato, ne avesti mangiato, ne ebbe mangiato, etc. (future perfect) ne avrò mangiato, ne avrai mangiato, ne avrà mangiato, etc. (present subjunctive) (che) ne mangi (1st, 2nd, 3rd singular), (che) ne mangiamo, etc. (past subjunctive) (che) ne mangiassi (1st, 2nd singular), (che) ne mangiasse, etc. (perfect subjunctive) (che) ne abbia mangiato (1st, 2nd, 3rd singular), (che) ne abbiamo mangiato, etc. (pluperfect subjunctive) (che) ne avessi mangiato (1st, 2nd singular), (che) ne avesse mangiato, etc. (present conditional) ne mangerei, ne mangeresti, ne mangerebbe, etc. (past conditional) ne avrei mangiato, ne avresti mangiato, ne avrebbe mangiato, etc. (imperative) mangiane, mangiatene (gerund) mangiandone Ne always refers to what is the main theme of the context, which is understood having already been mentioned in a previous sentence, or is pointed at by the speaker, etc.: questo è un vino speciale; ne vuoi? = this is a special wine; would you like some (of it)? no, grazie, ne ho già bevuto = no, thanks, I already drank some (of it) c'è del riso: se vuoi, prendine. = there is some rice: if you wish, have some (of it) grazie, ne prenderò più tardi = thanks, I will have some (of it) later on (showing a bottle to somebody) ne vuoi? = do you want some? hai della limonata? - no, non ne ho = do you have some lemonade? - no, I haven't any io ne ho, ma non è fredda = I have some, but it's not cold Evidently, ne does not translate literally some and any, but ...of it, ...of them. In fact, a closer translation of some and any would be un po' (i.e. a little, a little bit of something), which has been previously dealt with. However, un po' cannot be used as a pronoun, while ne can; therefore, the partitive pronoun is ne, not un po'. Compare these examples: vorresti della pizza? = would you like some pizza? vorresti un po' di pizza? (more colloquial) = would you like some pizza / a little pizza?

grazie, ne ho già preso = thanks, I already had some (literally: I already had of it) grazie ne ho già preso un po' = thanks, I already had some of it / a little Had the sentence been grazie, ho già preso un po' (literally: thanks, I already had a little, without ne) it would sound incomplete: although "pizza" is clearly mentioned in the offer, the reply would likely cause the other person to ask of what did you already have a little?.

Extra care should be taken not to mistake the pronoun particle ne with né, which carries an acute accent over the vowel (sometimes it is also wrongly spelt ne', with an apostrophe): né means neither, nor, and has nothing to do with ne.

20.2 MORE WAYS OF USING THE PRONOUN NE Besides being used in the specific case of the English pronouns some and any, as described in the previous paragraph, ne may turn useful in a few more cases, but its shades of meaning are never too different from the one we met so far. In first place, ne may be used for translating its actual English equivalents: ...of it, ...of them. c'erano molti giornali; ne presi uno = there were many newspapers; I took one of them (in a shop, pointing at some goods) ne vorrei cinque = I'd like five of them ho comprato un melone, ne vorresti una metà? = I bought a melon, would you like a half of it? non trovo i miei gatti; non ne hai visto nessuno? = I can't find my cats; haven't you seen any of them? sono nomi quasi sconosciuti, ma ne ricordo qualcuno = they are almost obscure names, but I remember a few of them Ne is used also in many cases in which the English form drops of it, of them: questa carne è ottima, ma ne vorrei un po' meno = this meat is excellent, but I would like a little less [of it] prendine la parte centrale, è più morbida = have the central part [of it], it's softer no grazie, ne ho mangiata abbastanza = no, thanks, I ate enough [of it] quanti libri! Ti dispiace se ne prendo qualcuno? = how many books! Do you mind if I take a few [of them]? questo è un magnifico cane, ma in passato ne ho già avuti altri = this is a wonderful dog, but in the past I already had others [of them] grazie alla nuova promozione, pago un articolo e ne prendo due = thanks to the new promotion, I pay for one item and I take two [of them] Note that in Italian ne cannot be omitted as in English.

In some cases ne translates the possessive pronouns his, her, its, their. This happens when his, her, its and their refer either to the subject or to the object of the previous sentence. Does this sound complicated? Focus this example: questo attore è diventato famoso, ne leggo spesso il nome = this actor has become famous, I often read his name

The subject of the first sentence is the actor; in the second sentence, his refers to the same person, therefore ne may be used with a meaning of his. Obviously, a literal translation of the English form is also possible: questo attore è diventato famoso, leggo spesso il suo nome = this actor has become famous, I often read his name But the first of the two forms is used more often. Here are a few more examples: c'è una palestra qui vicino, ne conosco l'indirizzo = there is a gym nearby, I know its address Marco è arrivato, ne ho riconosciuto la voce = Mark has arrived, I recognized his voice quello è un nuovo studente, ne ho conosciuto i genitori = that one is a new student, I met his parents il gatto si nascondeva sotto il letto, ma ne vedevo la coda = the cat was hiding under the bed, but I could see her tail visitai quel paese anni fa; ne ricordo il municipio = I visited that village years ago; I remember its town hall

In the next paragraph we shall examine a verb, andarsene (to go away), which contains at the same time the reflexive pronoun si and ne.

20.3 THE VERB ANDARSENE In paragraph 8.2 and paragraph 8.3 we learned how to bind two different pronoun particles to the same verb. This may occur also with ne, which is one of them. Should a verb take ne along with another pronoun particle, ne always comes in second position: comprartene = to buy you (-te-) some (-ne) (of what has been previously mentioned) rubarcene = to steal from us (-ce-) some (-ne) (of what has been previously mentioned) portamene quattro = bring me (-me-) four of them (-ne) sarà difficile dimenticarsene = it will be difficult to forget (-se-, reflexive) about it (-ne) mangiatevene un paio = eat (-se-, yourselves, emphatic reflexive) a couple of them (-ne) This paragraph focuses one of these verbs, andarsene (to go away), which contains the pronoun particles si and ne. In this case, both of them are merely emphatic: si does not have a true reflexive meaning (i.e. doing an action towards oneself), nor ne means ...of it, ...of them. Actually, another verb, andare via (literally, to go away), may be used as a synonym; but between the two, andarsene is the one more often chosen, especially in the spoken language. Since it may be a particularly tricky verb to inflect, due to the two pronouns, this paragraph will explore its use in every possible tense, and show every phonetic change. The plain verb, andare (to go), is already an irregular one (see paragraph 18.4); therefore it is strongly advisable for the student to practice and memorize all the inflections before going any further. According to the phonetic rule mentioned in paragraph 8.2 and paragraph 8.3, when si is followed by any other particle, it turns into ...se-, whence andarsene (not "andarsine"). Although this si is only emphatic, it normally changes into mi, ti, etc., according to the person whom the verb's inflection refers to (1st, 2nd, etc.), as in any reflexive verb, see again paragraph 8.3. Furthermore, since the first pronoun is followed by ne, the aforesaid mi, ti, etc. phonetically turn into me-, te-, etc., respectively. The pronoun ne, instead, remains constant, not being affected by the person. As a result, the combination of the two pronoun particles appears different according to the person they refer to:

...mene (1st singular) ...tene (2nd singular) ...sene (3rd singular and plural, and impersonal tenses) ...cene (1st plural) ...vene (2nd plural) Due to the presence of the first of the two pronoun particles, also tenses which are normally fully impersonal, may be addressed to a specific person: andarsene = to go away, infinitive, fully impersonal andarmene = to go away, infinitive, yet referred only to ME (1st singular) andartene = to go away, infinitive, yet referred only to YOU (2nd singular) andarcene = to go away, infinitive, yet referred only to US (1st plural) andarvene = to go away, infinitive, yet referred only to YOU (2nd plural) For the 3rd singular and plural person, the same impersonal andarsene is used. We may think of these as semi-impersonal infinitives, since they reject any personal pronoun (I, you, he, she, etc.) as any other infinitive does, yet unlike a plain infinitive they do refer to a specific person. Focus again the same infinitives, in a given context: andarsene da casa è stato difficile = to go away from home has been difficult (impersonal) andarmene da casa è stato difficile = to go away from home has been difficult (for me) andartene da casa è stato difficile = to go away from home has been difficult (for you) andarsene da casa è stato difficile = to go away from home has been difficult (for him / her) andarcene da casa è stato difficile = to go away from home has been difficult (for us) andarvene da casa è stato difficile = to go away from home has been difficult (for you [plur.]) andarsene da casa è stato difficile = to go away from home has been difficult (for them)

The use of these particles as suffixes, i.e. bound at the end of the verb, only occurs with the infinitive, imperative and gerund tenses (the previous paragraph too mentions this), while with any other tense they come as individual words before the verb: io me ne vado = I go away (I am going away) tu te ne vai = you go away (you are going away) egli / ella se ne andò = he/she went away noi ce ne andremo = we'll go away voi ve ne andrete = you'll go away [plur.]

Since andare is an intransitive verb, in forming compound tenses the auxiliary verb used is essere; therefore, care should be taken in using the appropriate past participle, which becomes number- and gendersensitive: me ne sono andato = I went away [masculine] (literally: I have gone away) me ne sono andata = (same as above) [feminine] te ne sei andato = you went away [masculine] te ne sei andata = (same as above) [feminine] te ne eri andato = you had gone away see note [*] below te ne eri andata = you [fem.] had gone away see note [*] below domani ce ne saremo andati = tomorrow we'll be gone domani ce ne saremo andate = tomorrow we'll [fem.] be gone domani ve ne sarete andati = tomorrow you'll [plur.] be gone domani ve ne sarete andate = tomorrow you'll [fem. plur] be gone [*] - A simple phonetic change takes place when pronoun ne is followed by inflections of the verb essere that begin with e: the pronoun drops its own vowel, so the cluster ne e... turns into n'e.... se ne è andato = se n'è andato = he went away te ne eri andata = te n'eri andata = you [fem.] had gone away se ne erano andati = se n'erano andati = they had gone away

This change is not compulsory, so that leaving ne and e... separate is not really a mistake; but since it is customary to do so, both in the written and in the spoken language, the student should become fully confident with it. Here is a synopsis of the inflections of all the tenses: andarsene (infinitive) me ne vado; te ne vai; se ne va; etc. (present indicative) me ne andavo; te ne andavi; se ne andava; etc. (imperfect indicative) me ne andai; te ne andasti; se ne andò; etc. (simple past) me ne andrò; te ne andrai; se ne andrà; etc. (future) me ne sono andato/a; te ne sei andato/a; se n'è andato/a; etc. (present perfect) me ne ero andato/a; te ne eri andato/a; se n'era andato/a; etc. (past perfect) me ne fui andato/a; te ne fosti andato/a; se ne fu andato/a; etc. (remote pluperfect) me ne sarò andato/a; te ne sarai andato/a; se ne sarà andato/a; etc. (future perfect) me ne vada; te ne vada; se ne vada; etc. (present subjunctive) me ne andassi; te ne andassi; se ne andasse; etc. (past subjunctive) me ne sia andato/a; te ne sia andato/a; se ne sia andato/a; etc. (perfect subjunctive) me ne fossi andato/a; te ne fossi andato/a; se ne fosse andato/a; etc. (pluperfect subjunctive) me ne andrei; te ne andresti; se ne andrebbe; etc. (present conditional) me ne sarei andato/a; te ne saresti andato/a; se ne sarebbe andato/a; etc. (past conditional) vattene (the t is doubled) ; andatevene (imperative) andandomene (1st sing. p.); andandotene (2nd sing. p.); andandosene (3rd sing., 3rd pl. and impersonal); etc. (gerund) Although this verb may seem complicated, it is very commonly used, and generally preferred to its nonemphatic equivalent, andare via. Be careful not to mistake the emphatic ne appended to this verb with the ne described in the previous paragraph, meaning of it, about it, i.e. either referred to the subject or to the object of the previous sentence, or in any case to the main topic of the speech.

Appendix 1 ROMAN NUMERALS

Roman numerals are based on capital (or uppercase) letters of the western alphabet, each of which has a specific value: I=1 V=5 X = 10 L = 50 C = 100 D = 500 M = 1000 All numbers can be spelled by using a combination of these letters. This system, though, did not have a letter for 0: the same concept of this digit and its use in mathematics was unknown to the western world, until Arabs introduced it with their own system, in mediaeval times. In roman numbers, letters come together according to these basic rules: • small values to the right of a greater number are added to the latter: XV = 15 (10+5) ; LI = 51 (50+1) ; ML = 1050 (1000+50) ; etc. • small values to the left of a greater number are subtracted from the latter, thus acting as negative numbers in algaebric calculations: IX = 9 (-1+10) ; XL = 40 (-10+50); CM = 900 (-100+1000) ; etc. • in "classic" notation, no more than three identical values can follow a greater one: I = 1 ; II = 2 ; III = 3 ...but IV = 4 VI = 6 ; VII = 7 ; VIII = 8 ...but IX = 9 • numbers should be obtained by adding small ones as much as possible to a given number before subtracting them to a greater one: 13 is spelled XIII (i.e. 10 + 3), but to obtain 14 no further addition can be made to 10, so 1 is subtracted from 15 (spelling it as 10-1+5): XIV.

Therefore, as a general rule, numbers ending with 0 and 5 (5, 10, 15, 20, 25, 30, etc.) can be used as main quantities, to which a maximum of three digits may be added, or one subtracted, in order to obtain all the remaining ones. the mediaeval style notation, instead, allows four values to the right of a greater one: I = 1 ; II = 2 ; III = 3 ; IIII = 4 VI = 6 ; VII = 7 ; VIII = 8 ; VIIII = 9 XX = 20 ; XXX = 30 ; XXXX = 40

Here is a table of numbers from 1 to 100 (in "classic" form): 1 - 10

I

II

III

IV

V

VI

VII

VIII

IX

X

11 - 20

XI

XII

XIII

XIV

XV

XVI

XVII

XVIII

XIX

XX

21 - 30

XXI

XXII

XXIII

XXIV

XXV

XXVI

XXVII

XXVIII

XXIX

XXX

31 - 40

XXXI

XXXII

XXXIII

XXXIV

XXXV

XXXVI

XXXVII

XXXVIII

XXXIX

XL

41 - 50

XLI

XLII

XLIII

XLIV

XLV

XLVI

XLVII

XLVIII

XLIX

L

51 - 60

LI

LII

LIII

LIV

LV

LVI

LVII

LVIII

LIX

LX

61 - 70

LXI

LXII

LXIII

LXIV

LXV

LXVI

LXVII

LXVIII

LXIX

LXX

71 - 80

LXXI

LXXII

LXXIII

LXXIV

LXXV

LXXVI

LXXVII

LXVIII

LXXIX

LXXX

81 - 90 91 - 100

LXXXI LXXXII LXXXIII LXXXIV LXXXV LXXXVI LXXXVII LXXXVIII LXXXIX XCI

XCII

XCIII

XCIV

XCV

XCVI

XCVII

XCVIII

XCIX

XC C

When working with large numbers, it is easier to split them into thousands, hundreds, etc. before converting them: 1963 = 1000 + 900 + 60 + 3 1000 = M; 900 = CM; 60= LX; 3 = III · · · · · final sequence: MCMLXIII 849 = 800 + 40 + 9 800 = DCCC; 40 = XL; 9 = IX · · · · · final sequence: DCCCXLIX To turn roman numerals into western ones, it is sufficient to write down (or memorize) the value of each single letter, considering as negative numbers all the ones which are followed by a greater value: MCDLXXIX M = 1000 ; C = -100 because followed by D = 500 (greater than C); L = 50; X = 10 ; X = 10; I = -1 because followed by X = 10: the final sum is 1000+(-100+500)+50+10+10+(-1+10) = 1479

CMXCIV C = -100 because followed by M = 1000 ; X = -10 because followed by C = 100 ; I = -1 because followed by V = 5: (-100+1000)+(-10+100)+(-1+5) = 994 Some numbers may cause a little confusion: number 999, for example, can be spelled in two ways: IM which means -1+1000, and DCCCIC which means 500+100+100+100-1+100. This happens because all numbers such as 999, 9999, 99999, etc. may be theoretically spelled both as the following number minus one, or as a longer sum of previous values. The easiest form (higher number minus one) is generally considered the more correct version.

To deal with very large numbers, romans used strokes: • one stroke above the numeral multiplies its value by 1,000 __ _____ V = 5,000 MM = 2,000,000 • •

three strokes all around the numeral multiply its value by 100,000 __ ______ |X| = 1,000,000 |MM| = 200,000,000 Also by effect of this spelling, in some cases two versions are possible: ____ |III| = 3,000 but also MMM = 3,000 But such large numbers were rarely used. Romans used their numeral system especially for daily life purposes (i.e. for stating prices of goods at the market, or distances on mile-stones, or to indicate seat numbers in circuses and theaters, etc.). Obviously, roman numerals were not practical at all for higher calculations. The simple operations which they were used for, instead, could be easily understood also by illiterate people, who counted by using their fingers: I = one finger = 1

V = one hand = 5

X = two hands (double V) = 10

Italian Grammar Teach Yourself Italian - PDFCOFFEE.COM (2024)
Top Articles
Latest Posts
Recommended Articles
Article information

Author: Arielle Torp

Last Updated:

Views: 6547

Rating: 4 / 5 (61 voted)

Reviews: 84% of readers found this page helpful

Author information

Name: Arielle Torp

Birthday: 1997-09-20

Address: 87313 Erdman Vista, North Dustinborough, WA 37563

Phone: +97216742823598

Job: Central Technology Officer

Hobby: Taekwondo, Macrame, Foreign language learning, Kite flying, Cooking, Skiing, Computer programming

Introduction: My name is Arielle Torp, I am a comfortable, kind, zealous, lovely, jolly, colorful, adventurous person who loves writing and wants to share my knowledge and understanding with you.